Location via proxy:   [ UP ]  
[Report a bug]   [Manage cookies]                

S9700 Series Switches Hardware Description

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 706

S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches

Hardware Description

Issue 27
Date 2019-05-10

HUAWEI TECHNOLOGIES CO., LTD.


Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 2019. All rights reserved.
No part of this document may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means without prior written
consent of Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Trademarks and Permissions

and other Huawei trademarks are trademarks of Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
All other trademarks and trade names mentioned in this document are the property of their respective
holders.

Notice
The purchased products, services and features are stipulated by the contract made between Huawei and the
customer. All or part of the products, services and features described in this document may not be within the
purchase scope or the usage scope. Unless otherwise specified in the contract, all statements, information,
and recommendations in this document are provided "AS IS" without warranties, guarantees or
representations of any kind, either express or implied.

The information in this document is subject to change without notice. Every effort has been made in the
preparation of this document to ensure accuracy of the contents, but all statements, information, and
recommendations in this document do not constitute a warranty of any kind, express or implied.

Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.


Address: Huawei Industrial Base
Bantian, Longgang
Shenzhen 518129
People's Republic of China

Website: http://e.huawei.com

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. i


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description About This Document

About This Document

Intended Audience
This document is intended for network engineers responsible for network design and
deployment. You should understand your network well, including the network topology and
service requirements.

Symbol Conventions
The symbols that may be found in this document are defined as follows.

Symbol Description

Indicates a potentially hazardous situation


which, if not avoided, could result in
equipment damage, data loss, performance
deterioration, or unanticipated results.
NOTICE is used to address practices not
related to personal injury.

NOTE Calls attention to important information,


best practices and tips.
NOTE is used to address information not
related to personal injury, equipment
damage, and environment deterioration.

Command Conventions
The command conventions that may be found in this document are defined as follows.

Convention Description

Boldface The keywords of a command line are in boldface.

Italic Command arguments are in italics.

[] Items (keywords or arguments) in brackets [ ] are optional.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. ii


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description About This Document

Convention Description

{ x | y | ... } Optional items are grouped in braces and separated by


vertical bars. One item is selected.

[ x | y | ... ] Optional items are grouped in brackets and separated by


vertical bars. One item is selected or no item is selected.

{ x | y | ... }* Optional items are grouped in braces and separated by


vertical bars. A minimum of one item or a maximum of all
items can be selected.

[ x | y | ... ]* Optional items are grouped in brackets and separated by


vertical bars. Several items or no item can be selected.

&<1-n> The parameter before the & sign can be repeated 1 to n


times.

# A line starting with the # sign is comments.

Disclaimer
l This document is designed as a reference for you to configure your devices. Its contents,
including web pages, command line input and output, are based on laboratory conditions.
It provides instructions for general scenarios, but does not cover all use cases of all
product models. The examples given may differ from your use case due to differences in
software versions, models, and configuration files. When configuring your device, alter
the configuration depending on your use case.
l The specifications provided in this document are tested in lab environment (for example,
a certain type of cards have been installed on the tested device or only one protocol is
run on the device). Results may differ from the listed specifications when you attempt to
obtain the maximum values with multiple functions enabled on the device.
l In this document, public IP addresses may be used in feature introduction and
configuration examples and are for reference only unless otherwise specified.

Device Dimension Conventions


The dimensions described in this document are theoretically typical dimensions and do not
include dimension tolerances.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. iii


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description Contents

Contents

About This Document.....................................................................................................................ii


1 Using the Hardware Query Tool and the Hardware Configuration Tool.......................... 1
2 Version Requirements for Components................................................................................... 3
3 Cabinets........................................................................................................................................... 4
3.1 N66E Cabinet................................................................................................................................................................. 4
3.1.1 Appearance of an N66E Cabinet................................................................................................................................. 4
3.1.2 Specifications of an N66E Cabinet..............................................................................................................................5
3.1.3 Components of an N66E Cabinet................................................................................................................................ 8
3.1.4 Structural Features of an N66E Cabinet...................................................................................................................... 8
3.2 N68E Cabinet............................................................................................................................................................... 12
3.2.1 Appearance of an N68E Cabinet............................................................................................................................... 12
3.2.2 Specifications of an N68E Cabinet............................................................................................................................12
3.2.3 Components of an N68E cabinet............................................................................................................................... 15
3.2.4 Structural Features of an N68E Cabinet.................................................................................................................... 15

4 Chassis........................................................................................................................................... 20
4.1 S9703............................................................................................................................................................................ 20
4.2 S9706............................................................................................................................................................................ 33
4.3 S9712............................................................................................................................................................................ 52

5 Power Supply Facilities..............................................................................................................74


5.1 Power Module...............................................................................................................................................................74
5.1.1 2200 W DC Power Module....................................................................................................................................... 74
5.1.2 800 W AC Power Module......................................................................................................................................... 79
5.1.3 2200 W AC Power Module....................................................................................................................................... 84
5.1.4 3000 W AC Power Module....................................................................................................................................... 90
5.2 Power Distribution Box................................................................................................................................................ 95
5.2.1 2200 W DC Power Distribution Box.........................................................................................................................95
5.2.2 800 W AC Power Distribution Box...........................................................................................................................98
5.2.3 2200 W AC Power Distribution Box.......................................................................................................................100

6 Fan Module................................................................................................................................. 105


6.1 EH1M00FBX000 Fan Module................................................................................................................................... 105

7 Cards............................................................................................................................................ 109

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. iv


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description Contents

7.1 Naming Conventions.................................................................................................................................................. 109


7.2 Card Types.................................................................................................................................................................. 117
7.3 Card Structure and Dimensions.................................................................................................................................. 144
7.4 Interface Numbering...................................................................................................................................................146
7.5 Main Control Units and Subcards.............................................................................................................................. 147
7.5.1 EH1D2SRUC000-S9706/S9712 Main Control Unit C (Optional Clock)............................................................... 148
7.5.2 EH1D2SRUDC00-S9706/S9712 Main Control Unit D (Optional Clock).............................................................. 154
7.5.3 EH1D2SRUDC01-S9706/S9712 Main Control Unit D (Optional Clock).............................................................. 161
7.5.4 EH1D2MCUAC00-S9703 Main Control Unit A (Optional Clock)........................................................................ 167
7.5.5 LE0D00CKMA00 Clock Pinch Board,-1588..........................................................................................................173
7.5.6 EH1D2VS08000-8-Port 10G Cluster Switching System Service Unit (SFP+)...................................................... 177
7.6 EH1D200CMU00-Centralized Monitoring Unit........................................................................................................182
7.7 LE0D0VAMPA00-Value-Added Service Unit........................................................................................................... 186
7.8 EH1D2PS00P00-Open Service Platform Unit........................................................................................................... 189
7.9 100M Interface Cards................................................................................................................................................. 196
7.9.1 EH1D2F48TEA0-48-Port 10/100BASE-T Interface Card (EA, RJ45).................................................................. 196
7.9.2 EH1D2F48TEC0-48-Port 10/100BASE-T Interface Card (EC, RJ45)...................................................................199
7.9.3 EH1D2F48TFA0-48-Port 10/100BASE-T Interface Card (FA, RJ45)................................................................... 202
7.9.4 EH1D2F48SEA0-48-Port 100BASE-X Interface Card (EA, SFP).........................................................................205
7.9.5 EH1D2F48SEC0-48-Port 100BASE-X Interface Card (EC, SFP)......................................................................... 208
7.10 1000M Interface Cards............................................................................................................................................. 211
7.10.1 EH1D2G24SSA0-24-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card (SA, SFP)..............................................................211
7.10.2 ET1D2G24SEC0-24-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card (EC, SFP).............................................................. 215
7.10.3 EH1D2G24SEC0-24-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card (EC, SFP)............................................................. 219
7.10.4 EH1D2G24SED0-24-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card (ED, SFP)............................................................. 223
7.10.5 EH1D2S24CSA0-24-Port 100/1000BASE-X and 8-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Combo Interface Card (SA, SFP/
RJ45).................................................................................................................................................................................227
7.10.6 EH1D2S24CEA0-24-Port 100/1000BASE-X and 8-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Combo Interface Card(EA, SFP/
RJ45, 1588).......................................................................................................................................................................232
7.10.7 ET1D2G24SX5E-24-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card (X5E, SFP)........................................................... 238
7.10.8 ET1D2T36SEA0-36-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T and 12-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card (EA, RJ45/SFP)
.......................................................................................................................................................................................... 242
7.10.9 EH1D2T36SEA0-36-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T and 12-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card (EA, RJ45/SFP)
.......................................................................................................................................................................................... 246
7.10.10 ET1D2G48TEA0-48-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Interface Card (EA, RJ45)..................................................... 251
7.10.11 EH1D2G24TFA0-24-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Interface Card (FA, RJ45)......................................................254
7.10.12 EH1D2G48TEA0-48-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Interface Card (EA, RJ45).....................................................257
7.10.13 ET1D2G48TEC0-48-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Interface Card (EC, RJ45)..................................................... 260
7.10.14 EH1D2G48TEC0-48-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Interface Card (EC, RJ45)..................................................... 263
7.10.15 EH1D2G48TED0-48-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Interface Card (ED, RJ45).....................................................266
7.10.16 EH1D2G48TFA0-48-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Interface Card (FA, RJ45)......................................................269
7.10.17 ET1D2G48TX1E-48-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Interface Card (X1E, RJ45)................................................... 272
7.10.18 EH1D2G48TX1E-48-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Interface Card (X1E, RJ45)...................................................276

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. v


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description Contents

7.10.19 EH1D2G48TBC0-48-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Interface Card (BC, RJ45).....................................................279


7.10.20 ET1D2G48TX5E-48-port 100/1000BASE-T interface card (X5E, RJ45)..........................................................283
7.10.21 ET1D2G48TX5H-48-port 100/1000BASE-T interface card (X5H, RJ45).........................................................287
7.10.22 ET1D2G48TX5S-48-port 100/1000BASE-T interface card (X5S, RJ45).......................................................... 290
7.10.23 ET1D2G48SEA0-48-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card (EA, SFP)........................................................... 293
7.10.24 EH1D2G48SEA0-48-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card (EA, SFP)........................................................... 297
7.10.25 ET1D2G48SEC0-48-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card (EC, SFP)............................................................ 301
7.10.26 EH1D2G48SED0-48-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card (ED, SFP)........................................................... 305
7.10.27 EH1D2G48SFA0-48-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card (FA, SFP)............................................................ 309
7.10.28 EH1D2G48SBC0-48-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card (BC, SFP)........................................................... 313
7.10.29 ET1D2G48SX1E-48-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card (X1E, SFP)......................................................... 318
7.10.30 EH1D2G48SX1E-48-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card (X1E, SFP)......................................................... 322
7.10.31 ET1D2G48SX5E-48-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card (X5E, SFP)......................................................... 326
7.10.32 ET1D2G48SX5H-48-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card (X5H, SFP).........................................................330
7.10.33 ET1D2G48SX5S-48-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card (X5S, SFP).......................................................... 334
7.11 GE/10GE Interface Cards......................................................................................................................................... 338
7.11.1 EH1D2T24XEA0-24-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T and 2-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (EA, RJ45/XFP)...... 338
7.11.2 EH1D2S24XEA0-24-Port 100/1000BASE-X and 2-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (EA, SFP/XFP).............342
7.11.3 EH1D2S24XEC0-24-Port 100/1000BASE-X and 2-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (EC, SFP/XFP)............. 347
7.11.4 ET1D2S04SX1E-4-Port 10GBASE-X and 24-Port 100/1000BASE-X and 8-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Combo
Interface Card (X1E, RJ45/SFP/SFP+)............................................................................................................................ 351
7.11.5 EH1D2S04SX1E-4-Port 10GBASE-X and 24-Port 100/1000BASE-X and 8-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Combo
Interface Card (X1E, RJ45/SFP/SFP+)............................................................................................................................ 357
7.11.6 ET1D2S04SX5E-4-port 10GE SFP+ and 44-port GE SFP interface card (X5E, SFP+)...................................... 363
7.11.7 ET1D2S08SX1E-8-Port 10GBASE-X and 8-Port 100/1000BASE-X and 8-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Combo
Interface Card (X1E, RJ45/SFP/SFP+)............................................................................................................................ 369
7.11.8 EH1D2S08SX1E-8-Port 10GBASE-X and 8-Port 100/1000BASE-X and 8-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Combo
Interface Card (X1E, RJ45/SFP/SFP+)............................................................................................................................ 374
7.11.9 ET1D2S24SX2E-24-Port 10GE SFP+ Interface and 8-Port GE SFP Interface Card (X2E, SFP+)..................... 379
7.11.10 ET1D2S24SX2S-24-Port 10GE SFP+ Interface and 8-Port GE SFP Interface Card (X2S, SFP+)....................384
7.11.11 ET1D2S16SX2E-16-Port 10GE SFP+ Interface and 16-Port GE SFP Interface Card (X2E, SFP+)..................389
7.11.12 ET1D2S16SX2S-16-Port 10GE SFP+ Interface and 16-Port GE SFP Interface Card (X2S, SFP+)..................395
7.12 10GE Interface Cards............................................................................................................................................... 400
7.12.1 EH1D2X02XEA0-2-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (EA, XFP)...................................................................... 400
7.12.2 EH1D2X02XEC0-2-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (EC, XFP)...................................................................... 403
7.12.3 EH1D2X02XEC1-2-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (EC, XFP)...................................................................... 407
7.12.4 ET1D2X04XEA0-4-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (EA, XFP)...................................................................... 410
7.12.5 EH1D2X04XEA0-4-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (EA, XFP)...................................................................... 413
7.12.6 ET1D2X04XEC1-4-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (EC, XFP).......................................................................416
7.12.7 EH1D2X04XEC0-4-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (EC, XFP)...................................................................... 419
7.12.8 ET1D2X08SX5E-8-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (X5E, SFP+)................................................................... 422
7.12.9 ET1D2X08SX5H-8-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (X5H, SFP+)...................................................................426
7.12.10 EH1D2X04XEC1-4-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (EC, XFP).................................................................... 430

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. vi


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description Contents

7.12.11 EH1D2X04XED0-4-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (ED, XFP).................................................................... 434


7.12.12 EH1D2X08SED4-8-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (ED, SFP+)................................................................... 437
7.12.13 EH1D2X08SED5-8-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (ED, SFP+)................................................................... 441
7.12.14 ET1D2X12SSA0-12-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (SA, SFP+)..................................................................444
7.12.15 EH1D2X12SSA0-12-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (SA, SFP+)................................................................. 448
7.12.16 ET1D2X16SSC0-16-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (SC, SFP+).................................................................. 451
7.12.17 EH1D2X16SFC0-16-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (FC, SFP+)..................................................................455
7.12.18 ET1D2X16SSC2-16-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (SC, SFP+).................................................................. 460
7.12.19 EH1D2X16SSC2-16-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (SC, SFP+)..................................................................464
7.12.20 ET1D2X32SSC0-32-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (SC, SFP+).................................................................. 469
7.12.21 EH1D2X32SSC0-32-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (SC, SFP+)..................................................................473
7.12.22 ET1D2X32SX2E-32-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (X2E, SFP+)............................................................... 477
7.12.23 ET1D2X32SX2S-32-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (X2S, SFP+)................................................................482
7.12.24 ET1D2X32SX2H-32-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (X2H, SFP+)...............................................................486
7.12.25 EH1D2X40SFC0-40-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (FC, SFP+)..................................................................490
7.12.26 ET1D2X48SEC0-48-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (EC, SFP+)..................................................................495
7.12.27 EH1D2X48SEC0-48-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (EC, SFP+)................................................................. 500
7.12.28 ET1D2X48SX2S-48-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (X2S, SFP+)................................................................505
7.13 40GE Interface Cards............................................................................................................................................... 509
7.13.1 ET1D2L02QSC0-2-Port 40GBASE-X Interface Card (SC, QSFP+)................................................................... 509
7.13.2 EH1D2L02QFC0-2-Port 40GBASE-X Interface Card (FC, QSFP+)...................................................................514
7.13.3 ET1D2L08QSC0-8-Port 40GBASE-X Interface Card (SC, QSFP+)................................................................... 519
7.13.4 EH1D2L08QFC0-8-Port 40GBASE-X Interface Card (FC, QSFP+)...................................................................524
7.13.5 EH1D2L08QX2E-8-Port 40GBASE-X Interface Card (X2E, QSFP+)................................................................ 529
7.14 40GE/100GE Interface Cards................................................................................................................................... 534
7.14.1 ET1D2H02QX2S-2-Port 100GE QSFP28 Interface and 2-Port 40GE QSFP+ Interface Card (X2S, QSFP28).. 534
7.14.2 ET1D2H02QX2E-2-Port 100GE QSFP28 Interface and 2-Port 40GE QSFP+ Interface Card (X2E, QSFP28). 538
7.15 100GE Interface Cards............................................................................................................................................. 542
7.15.1 ET1D2C02FEE0-2-Port 100GBASE-X Interface Card (EE, CFP)...................................................................... 542
7.15.2 EH1D2C02FEE0-2-Port 100GBASE-X Interface Card (EE, CFP)...................................................................... 546
7.15.3 ET1D2C04HX2E-4-Port 100GE QSFP28 Interface Card (X2E, QSFP28)..........................................................550
7.15.4 ET1D2C04HX2S-4-Port 100GE QSFP28 Interface Card (X2S, QSFP28).......................................................... 553
7.16 POS Interface Card................................................................................................................................................... 557
7.16.1 EH1D2WM00000 - WAN Interface Service Process Card................................................................................... 557
7.16.2 P1UF-1-Port OC-48c/STM-16c POS-SFP Flexible Card..................................................................................... 560
7.16.3 P4HF-4-Port OC-12c/STM-4c POS-SFP Flexible Card....................................................................................... 564
7.16.4 P4CF-4-Port OC-3c/STM-1c POS-SFP Flexible Card......................................................................................... 568
7.17 User Manuals For ACU2, NGFW Module, and IPS Module (S9700).....................................................................572

8 Cables...........................................................................................................................................575
8.1 DC Power Cable......................................................................................................................................................... 575
8.2 AC Power Cable......................................................................................................................................................... 576
8.3 Ground Cable..............................................................................................................................................................579

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. vii


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description Contents

8.4 Console Cable.............................................................................................................................................................580


8.5 Clock Cable................................................................................................................................................................ 581
8.6 Ethernet Cable............................................................................................................................................................ 583
8.7 High-Speed Cable.......................................................................................................................................................585
8.8 Optical Fiber............................................................................................................................................................... 589

9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces.......................................................................................... 606


9.1 Important Notes About Using Optical Modules Certified for Huawei Switches....................................................... 607
9.1.1 How to Identify Huawei-Certified Switch Optical Modules...................................................................................607
9.1.2 Risks of Using Non-Huawei-Certified Switch Optical Modules............................................................................ 608
9.2 Understanding Optical Modules................................................................................................................................. 609
9.2.1 What Is an Optical Module......................................................................................................................................609
9.2.2 Types of Optical Modules........................................................................................................................................615
9.2.3 Parameter Description............................................................................................................................................. 616
9.2.4 How to View Optical Module Parameters............................................................................................................... 617
9.2.5 Rules for Optical Module Interoperation.................................................................................................................618
9.3 Understanding Copper Modules................................................................................................................................. 620
9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules...................................................................................................................................621
9.4.1 SFP-FE-SX-MM1310..............................................................................................................................................621
9.4.2 eSFP-FE-LX-SM1310............................................................................................................................................. 622
9.4.3 S-SFP-FE-LH40-SM1310....................................................................................................................................... 622
9.4.4 S-SFP-FE-LH80-SM1550....................................................................................................................................... 623
9.4.5 SFP-FE-LX-SM1310-BIDI (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional Module).......................................................................... 624
9.4.6 SFP-FE-LX-SM1550-BIDI (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional Module).......................................................................... 624
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules..........................................................................................................................................625
9.5.1 eSFP-GE-SX-MM850............................................................................................................................................. 625
9.5.2 SFP-GE-LX-SM1310.............................................................................................................................................. 626
9.5.3 S-SFP-GE-LH40-SM1310.......................................................................................................................................627
9.5.4 S-SFP-GE-LH40-SM1550.......................................................................................................................................627
9.5.5 S-SFP-GE-LH80-SM1550.......................................................................................................................................628
9.5.6 eSFP-GE-ZX100-SM1550...................................................................................................................................... 629
9.5.7 SFP-GE-LX-SM1310-BIDI (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional Module)......................................................................... 629
9.5.8 SFP-GE-LX-SM1490-BIDI (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional Module)......................................................................... 630
9.5.9 LE2MGSC40DE0 (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional Module)........................................................................................ 631
9.5.10 LE2MGSC40ED0 (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional Module)...................................................................................... 631
9.5.11 SFP-GE-ZBXD1 (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional Module).........................................................................................632
9.5.12 SFP-GE-ZBXU1 (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional Module)........................................................................................ 633
9.5.13 SFP-GE-BXU1-SC (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional Module).....................................................................................634
9.6 POS eSFP Optical Modules........................................................................................................................................634
9.6.1 eSFP-SM1310-155M-2.5G-15km........................................................................................................................... 634
9.6.2 eSFP-1310nm-L-16.1.............................................................................................................................................. 635
9.6.3 eSFP-1550nm-L-16.2.............................................................................................................................................. 636
9.7 GE-CWDM eSFP Optical Modules........................................................................................................................... 637

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. viii


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description Contents

9.7.1 CWDM-SFPGE-1471..............................................................................................................................................637
9.7.2 CWDM-SFPGE-1491..............................................................................................................................................637
9.7.3 CWDM-SFPGE-1511..............................................................................................................................................638
9.7.4 CWDM-SFPGE-1531..............................................................................................................................................639
9.7.5 CWDM-SFPGE-1551..............................................................................................................................................639
9.7.6 CWDM-SFPGE-1571..............................................................................................................................................640
9.7.7 CWDM-SFPGE-1591..............................................................................................................................................641
9.7.8 CWDM-SFPGE-1611..............................................................................................................................................641
9.8 GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules........................................................................................................................... 642
9.8.1 DWDM-SFPGE-1560-61........................................................................................................................................ 642
9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules........................................................................................................................................... 642
9.9.1 SFP-1000BaseT....................................................................................................................................................... 643
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules................................................................................................................................... 643
9.10.1 SFP-10G-USR....................................................................................................................................................... 643
9.10.2 OSXD22N00......................................................................................................................................................... 644
9.10.3 OMXD30000......................................................................................................................................................... 644
9.10.4 SFP-10G-iLR.........................................................................................................................................................645
9.10.5 OSX010000........................................................................................................................................................... 646
9.10.6 OSX040N01.......................................................................................................................................................... 646
9.10.7 SFP-10G-ER-1310.................................................................................................................................................647
9.10.8 SFP-10G-ZR.......................................................................................................................................................... 648
9.10.9 SFP-10G-BXU1 (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional Module)......................................................................................... 648
9.10.10 SFP-10G-BXD1 (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional Module)....................................................................................... 649
9.10.11 SFP-10G-ER-SM1330-BIDI (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional Module).................................................................... 650
9.10.12 SFP-10G-ER-SM1270-BIDI (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional Module).................................................................... 651
9.11 10GE-CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules..................................................................................................................... 651
9.11.1 SFP-10G-ZCW1471.............................................................................................................................................. 651
9.11.2 SFP-10G-ZCW1491.............................................................................................................................................. 652
9.11.3 SFP-10G-ZCW1511.............................................................................................................................................. 653
9.11.4 SFP-10G-ZCW1531.............................................................................................................................................. 653
9.11.5 SFP-10G-ZCW1551.............................................................................................................................................. 654
9.11.6 SFP-10G-ZCW1571.............................................................................................................................................. 655
9.11.7 SFP-10G-ZCW1591.............................................................................................................................................. 655
9.11.8 SFP-10G-ZCW1611.............................................................................................................................................. 656
9.12 10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical Modules.....................................................................................................................657
9.12.1 SFP-10G-ZDWT................................................................................................................................................... 657
9.13 10GE XFP Optical Modules.....................................................................................................................................657
9.13.1 XFP-SX-MM850................................................................................................................................................... 657
9.13.2 XFP-STM64-LX-SM1310.....................................................................................................................................658
9.13.3 XFP-STM64-LH40-SM1550.................................................................................................................................659
9.13.4 XFP-STM64-SM1550-80km.................................................................................................................................660
9.14 10GE-CWDM XFP Optical Modules.......................................................................................................................660

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. ix


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description Contents

9.14.1 CWDM-XFP10G-1471......................................................................................................................................... 660


9.14.2 CWDM-XFP10G-1491......................................................................................................................................... 661
9.14.3 CWDM-XFP10G-1511..........................................................................................................................................662
9.14.4 CWDM-XFP10G-1531......................................................................................................................................... 662
9.14.5 CWDM-XFP10G-1551......................................................................................................................................... 663
9.14.6 CWDM-XFP10G-1571......................................................................................................................................... 663
9.14.7 CWDM-XFP10G-1591......................................................................................................................................... 664
9.14.8 CWDM-XFP10G-1611..........................................................................................................................................665
9.15 10GE-DWDM XFP Optical Modules...................................................................................................................... 665
9.15.1 DWDM-XFP10G-1533-47.................................................................................................................................... 665
9.15.2 DWDM-XFP10G-1534-25.................................................................................................................................... 666
9.15.3 DWDM-XFP10G-1535-04.................................................................................................................................... 667
9.15.4 DWDM-XFP10G-1552-52.................................................................................................................................... 667
9.15.5 DWDM-XFP10G-1553-33.................................................................................................................................... 668
9.15.6 DWDM-XFP10G-1554-13.................................................................................................................................... 669
9.15.7 DWDM-XFP10G-1530-33.................................................................................................................................... 669
9.15.8 DWDM-XFP10G-1549-32.................................................................................................................................... 670
9.15.9 DWDM-XFP10G-1531-12.................................................................................................................................... 671
9.15.10 DWDM-XFP10G-1531-90.................................................................................................................................. 671
9.15.11 DWDM-XFP10G-1550-12.................................................................................................................................. 672
9.15.12 DWDM-XFP10G-1550-92.................................................................................................................................. 672
9.15.13 DWDM-XFP10G-1532-68.................................................................................................................................. 673
9.15.14 DWDM-XFP10G-1551-72.................................................................................................................................. 674
9.15.15 DWDM-XFP10G-1529-55.................................................................................................................................. 674
9.15.16 DWDM-XFP10G-1548-51.................................................................................................................................. 675
9.16 40GE QSFP+ Optical Modules................................................................................................................................ 676
9.16.1 QSFP-40G-SR4..................................................................................................................................................... 676
9.16.2 QSFP-40G-iSR4.................................................................................................................................................... 676
9.16.3 QSFP-40G-eSR4................................................................................................................................................... 677
9.16.4 QSFP-40G-iSM4................................................................................................................................................... 678
9.16.5 QSFP-40G-eSM4...................................................................................................................................................679
9.16.6 QSFP-40G-LX4.....................................................................................................................................................680
9.16.7 QSFP-40G-LR4..................................................................................................................................................... 680
9.16.8 QSFP-40G-ER4..................................................................................................................................................... 681
9.16.9 QSFP-40G-SR-BD................................................................................................................................................ 682
9.16.10 QSFP-40G-SDLC-PAM...................................................................................................................................... 682
9.16.11 QSFP-40G-eSDLC-PAM.....................................................................................................................................683
9.17 40GE CFP Optical Modules..................................................................................................................................... 684
9.17.1 CFP-40G-SR4........................................................................................................................................................684
9.17.2 CFP-40G-LR4....................................................................................................................................................... 685
9.17.3 CFP-40G-ER4....................................................................................................................................................... 685
9.17.4 CFP-40G-ZR4....................................................................................................................................................... 686

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. x


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description Contents

9.18 100GE CFP Optical Modules................................................................................................................................... 687


9.18.1 CFP-100G-SR10....................................................................................................................................................687
9.18.2 CFP-100G-LR4..................................................................................................................................................... 687
9.18.3 CFP-100G-ER4..................................................................................................................................................... 688
9.19 100GE QSFP28 Optical Modules.............................................................................................................................689
9.19.1 QSFP28-100G-LR4............................................................................................................................................... 689
9.19.2 QSFP28-100G-10KM............................................................................................................................................690
9.19.3 QSFP28-100G-PSM4............................................................................................................................................ 690
9.19.4 QSFP28-100G-SR4............................................................................................................................................... 691
9.19.5 QSFP-100G-eSR4................................................................................................................................................. 691
9.19.6 QSFP-100G-CLR4................................................................................................................................................ 692
9.19.7 QSFP-100G-CWDM4........................................................................................................................................... 693
9.19.8 QSFP-100G-ER4-Lite........................................................................................................................................... 693

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. xi


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches 1 Using the Hardware Query Tool and the Hardware
Hardware Description Configuration Tool

1 Using the Hardware Query Tool and the


Hardware Configuration Tool

Figure 1-1 shows the interface of the Hardware Query Tool. You can use this tool to query
the power modules, fan modules, optical modules, and cards supported by each switch model,
as well as specifications of switches and modules. You can search switch products or modules
by part number, product model, or module type.

Figure 1-1 Web page of the Hardware Query Tool

Figure 1-2 shows the web page of the Hardware Configuration Tool. You can use this tool
to calculate the power consumption of a switch.

NOTE

The heat consumption of a device can be calculated as follows based on its power consumption:
Heat consumption (BTUs per hour) = Power consumption (W) x 3.412

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches 1 Using the Hardware Query Tool and the Hardware
Hardware Description Configuration Tool

Figure 1-2 Web page of the Hardware Configuration Tool

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 2


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 2 Version Requirements for Components

2 Version Requirements for Components

NOTE

l This document describes all the device models and modules supported in a version. To obtain
accurate subscription information, visit http://e.huawei.com or contact Huawei local sales offices.
You can also pay attention to the product change notices (PCNs) and lifecycle management bulletins
on this website.
l The figures in this document are for reference only.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 3


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 3 Cabinets

3 Cabinets

About This Chapter

3.1 N66E Cabinet


3.2 N68E Cabinet

3.1 N66E Cabinet

3.1.1 Appearance of an N66E Cabinet


Figure 3-1 shows an N66E cabinet. An N66E cabinet complies with the Dimensions of
Mechanical Structures of the 482.6 mm (19 Inch) Series (IEC 60297-2 Standard). It uses a
modular structure, which facilitates expansion and maintenance. The surface of the cabinet
and the rack is NC purplish grey.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 4


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 3 Cabinets

Figure 3-1 N66E cabinet

3.1.2 Specifications of an N66E Cabinet


Table 3-1 lists specifications of an N66E cabinet.

Table 3-1 N66E cabinet specifications

Item Specification

Empty cabinet weight 73 kg±1 kg


NOTE
Empty cabinet weight is the weight of a cabinet
with a front door, a rear door, and two side
panels.

Dimensions (W x D x H) 600 mm x 600 mm x 2200 mm

24 in. x 24 in. x 87 in.

Mounting holes on the top l Position (W x D): 450 mm x 400 mm


l Nuts: six M8 weld nuts

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 5


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 3 Cabinets

Item Specification

Mounting holes on the bottom l Position (W x D): 413 mm x 487 mm


l Hole diameter: φ18 (four holes)
l Nuts: four M12 expansion bolts and
matching nuts

Available space 46 U

Angle opening width 450 mm

Space for a chassis (distance between axes 465 mm


of mounting holes)

Distance between a front mounting rail and 95 mm


interior of the front door

Figure 3-2 shows the dimensions of an N66E cabinet.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 6


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 3 Cabinets

Figure 3-2 N66E cabinet dimensions

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 7


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 3 Cabinets

3.1.3 Components of an N66E Cabinet


N66E cabinets are classified into front-serviceable cabinets and rear-serviceable cabinets.
Figure 3-3 shows the components of a rear-serviceable cabinet. An N66E cabinet consists of
a front door, a rear door, two side panels and a rack.

Figure 3-3 Components of a rear-serviceable N66E cabinet


3

1. Front door 2. Rack 3. Rear door 4. Side panels

3.1.4 Structural Features of an N66E Cabinet

Cabinet Material
An N66E cabinet is made of welded electro-galvanized steel sheets and cold-rolled steel
sheets. The fireproof performance of the internal materials complies with the Underwriter
Laboratories (UL) standards.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 8


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 3 Cabinets

Cabling Mode
Cable apertures are reserved on the top and at the bottom of the N66E cabinet, so that the
N66E cabinet supports overhead cabling and underfloor cabling. The following describe the
two cabling modes:

l In the overhead cabling mode, external cables enter the cabinet through the top of the
cabinet. Figure 3-4 shows the cable apertures.
l In the underfloor cabling mode, external cables enter the cabinet through the bottom of
the cabinet.
NOTE

The devices described in this document use the overhead cabling mode.

Figure 3-4 Cable apertures on the cabinet top


52mm 52mm

Network Network
cable/fiber cable/fiber

175mm×22mm
Reserved holes
500mm 500mm

Power cable hole


Power cable
Front Door

Heat Dissipation
The front door, rear door, and top plate of an N66E cabinet have high-density air vents.
Therefore, the cabinet supports front air intake, rear air exhaust, and upper air exhaust, and
provides good heat dissipation performance.

NOTE

l The devices described in this document adopt left-to-back airflow for heat dissipation and have fans
installed at the rear of the chassis.
l The airflow of devices described in this document in the cabinet is: front of the cabinet -> left side of
the device -> inside the device -> rear of the device -> rear of the cabinet, as shown in Figure 3-5.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 9


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 3 Cabinets

Figure 3-5 Airflow in the cabinet

Protection Performance
The protection performance of an N66E cabinet is described as follows:
l The cabinet design takes full account of electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) to ensure
an excellent electromagnetic shielding performance.
l The air vents on the bottom plate of the cabinet have air filters installed, which enhance
the dust-proof capability of the N66E cabinet.
l The grounding resistance of the N66E cabinet does not exceed 0.1 ohm.

ESD Jack
When wearing an ESD wrist strap, connect the connector of the wrist strap to the ESD jack in
the middle of the N66E cabinet, as shown in Figure 3-6.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 10


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 3 Cabinets

Figure 3-6 ESD jack on the N66E cabinet

Installation Scenarios
An N66E cabinet can be installed on:

l Concrete floor
l ESD floor, in which case the N6X series supports are required

Cabinet Combination
N66E cabinets can be installed side by side. When installing N66E cabinets side by side,
connect them using connecting plates, as shown in Figure 3-7. Connecting plates are
delivered with the cabinet.

Figure 3-7 Combined N66E cabinets

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 11


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 3 Cabinets

3.2 N68E Cabinet

3.2.1 Appearance of an N68E Cabinet


Figure 3-8 shows the appearance of an N68E cabinet. An N68E cabinet complies with the
Dimensions of Mechanical Structures of the 482.6 mm (19 Inch) Series (IEC 60297-2
Standard). It uses a modular structure, which facilitates expansion and maintenance. The
surface of the cabinet and the rack is NC purple grey.

Figure 3-8 Appearance of an N68E cabinet

3.2.2 Specifications of an N68E Cabinet


Table 3-2 lists specifications of an N68E cabinet.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 12


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 3 Cabinets

Table 3-2 N68E cabinet specifications


Item Specification

Empty cabinet weight 100 kg


NOTE
Empty cabinet weight is the weight of a cabinet
with a front door, a rear door, and two side
panels.

Dimensions (W x D x H) 600 mm x 800 mm x 2200 mm

24 in. x 31 in. x 87 in.

Mounting holes on the top l Position (W x D): 450 mm x 750 mm


l Nuts: 16 M8 self-clinching nuts

Mounting holes on the bottom l Position (W x D): 413 mm x 687 mm


l Hole diameter: φ18 (four holes)
l Nuts: four M12 expansion bolts and
matching nuts

Available space 46 U

Angle opening width 450 mm

Space for a chassis (distance between axes 465 mm


of mounting holes)

Distance between a front mounting rail and 100 mm


interior of the front door

Figure 3-9 shows the dimensions of an N68E cabinet.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 13


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 3 Cabinets

Figure 3-9 N68E cabinet dimensions

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 14


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 3 Cabinets

3.2.3 Components of an N68E cabinet

Figure 3-10 shows the structure of an N68E cabinet. An N68E cabinet consists of a front
door, a rear door, two side panels, and a rack.

Figure 3-10 Structure of the N68E cabinet

33 4
4

22

11
3
3

1. Front door 2. Rear door 3. Side panels 4. Rack

3.2.4 Structural Features of an N68E Cabinet

Cabinet Material
The N68E cabinet is made of electro-galvanized steel sheets and cold-rolled steel sheets
assembled by screws. The fireproof performance of internal materials complies with the
standards of the Underwriter Laboratories (UL).

Cabling Mode
Cable apertures are reserved on the top and at the bottom of the N68E cabinet, so that the
N68E cabinet supports overhead cabling and underfloor cabling. The following describe the
two cabling modes:

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 15


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 3 Cabinets

l In the overhead cabling mode, external cables enter the cabinet through the top of the
cabinet. Figure 3-11 shows the cable apertures.
l In the underfloor cabling mode, external cables enter the cabinet through the bottom of
the cabinet.
NOTE

The devices described in this document use the overhead cabling mode.

Figure 3-11 Cable apertures on the cabinet top


52mm 52mm

Network Network
cable/fiber cable/fiber

312mm 312mm

130mm×15mm 130mm×15mm

312mm 312mm

145mm×65mm 145mm×65mm

Reserved holes
Power cable
Front Door

ESD Jack
Before installing the N68E cabinet, wear an ESD wrist strap and insert connector of the ESD
wrist strap into the ESD jack in the middle of the N68E cabinet, as shown in Figure 3-12.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 16


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 3 Cabinets

Figure 3-12 ESD jack in the middle of the N68E cabinet

Heat Dissipation
The front door, rear door, and top plate of the N68E cabinet have high-density air vents.
Therefore, the N68E cabinet supports front air intake, rear air exhaust, and upper air exhaust
and provides good heat dissipation performance.

NOTE

l The devices described in this document adopt left-to-back airflow for heat dissipation and have fans
installed at the rear of chassis.
l The airflow of devices described in this document in the cabinet is: front of the cabinet -> left side of
the equipment -> inside the equipment -> rear of the equipment -> rear of the cabinet, as shown in
Figure 3-13.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 17


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 3 Cabinets

Figure 3-13 Airflow in the cabinet

Protection Performance
The protection performance of an N68E cabinet is described as follows:

l The cabinet design takes full account of electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) to ensure
an excellent electromagnetic shielding performance.
l The air vents on the bottom plate of the cabinet have air filters installed, which enhance
the dust-proof capability of the N68E cabinet.
l The grounding resistance of the N68E cabinet does not exceed 0.1 ohm.

Installation Scenarios
An N68E cabinet can be installed on:

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 18


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 3 Cabinets

l Concrete floor
l ESD floor, in which case the N6X series supports are required

Cabinet Combination
N68E cabinets can be installed side by side. When installing N68E cabinets side by side,
connect them using connecting plates, as shown in Figure 3-14. Connecting plates are
delivered with the cabinet.

Figure 3-14 Combined N68E cabinets

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 19


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

4 Chassis

About This Chapter

Table 4-1 S9700 Chassis models


Chassis Description
Model

S9703 Supports two Main Control Units (MCUs), three Line Processing Units
(LPUs), and AC or DC power modules in N+N/N+1/N+0 (no
redundancy) backup mode.

S9706 Supports two Switching and Routing Units (SRUs), six LPUs, and AC
or DC power modules in N+N/N+1/N+0 (no redundancy) backup mode.

S9712 Supports two SRUs, twelve LPUs, and AC or DC power modules in N


+N/N+1/N+0 (no redundancy) backup mode.

NOTE

S9700 chassis include FCC-certified chassis and common chassis.

4.1 S9703
4.2 S9706
4.3 S9712

4.1 S9703

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 20


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Version Mapping

Table 4-2 Mapping between the S9703 chassis and software versions
Chassis Version

S9703 chassis V200R001C00 to V200R013C00 versions

S9703 chassis, FCC certified V200R001C00 to V200R013C00 versions

Appearance and Structure


NOTE
The figures in this document are for reference only.

The S9703 chassis is 4 U high (1 U = 44.45 mm). When the chassis has no cable management
frame installed, the dimensions are 442 mm x 489 mm x 175 mm (W x D x H). When the
chassis has cable management frames installed, the dimensions are 442 mm x 585 mm x 175
mm (W x D x H). Figure 4-1 and Figure 4-2 show the S9703 chassis.

Figure 4-1 S9703 chassis (front view)

RUN/ALM S9703

03
EH1D2
G48TEA0

4647
44 45
42 43
40 41 RUN/ALM
38 39
36 37
34 35
32 33
26 27
28 29
30 31
02
24 25
EH1D2

22 23
20 21
G48TEA0

18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647
EH1D2

8 9 44 45
G48TEA0

6 7 42 43
4 5 40 41 RUN/ALM
2 3 38 39
1 36 37
34 35
28 29
30 31
32 33
01
26 27
24 25
EH1D2

22 23
20 21
G48TEA0

18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647
EH1D2

8 9 44 45 04
G48TEA0

6 7 42 43
4 5 40 41 05
2 3 38 39
1 36 37
EH1D2MCUAC00

34 35
32 33
30 31
28 29
26 27 ACT RUN/ALM
24 25 RST
22 23 ETH
20 21
16 17
18 19 CONSOLE
14 15 MON
12 13 RS485
EH1D2 MCUAC00

10 11 CLK2
EH1D2

8
EH1D2MCUAC00

9 CLK1
G48TEA0

6 7
4 5
FAULT

2 3
1 RUN/ALM
ALM
RUN

RST ACT
ETH
CONSOLE
MON
RS485
FAULT

OFF
EH1D2 MCUAC00

CLK2
ALM

CLK1
RUN

ON

≤25
kg(55
lb)
P
W
OFF

R
2
ON

P
W
R
1

Figure 4-2 S9703 chassis (rear view)


Clean periodically
ᇐᵕ␻ᢡ

fingers
keeping
moving parts,
Hazardous
away.
body parts
and other ਬ⡽έ
᧛䀜
᡽ᰁ䖢ᰬ
ћ⾷൞伄

RUN/ALM

≤25
kg(55
lb)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 21


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

NOTE

The S9703 chassis include FCC-certified chassis and common chassis.

Figure 4-3 shows the front structure of the S9703 chassis.

Figure 4-3 S9703 chassis structure (front view)


RUN/ALM

S9703

EH1D2
EH1D2

G48TEA0
G48TEA0

03
RUN/ALM

EH1D2
EH1D2

02

G48TEA0
G48TEA0

RUN/ALM
7

EH1D2
EH1D2

01

G48TEA0
G48TEA0
EH1D2

EH1D2

EH1D2

EH1D2
2 2
04
MCUA00

MCUA00

MCUA00

MCUA00
SYNC
RST
ACT RUN/ALM SYNC
RST
ACT RUN/ALM 05
CLK1 CLK2 RS485 MON CONSOLE ETH CLK1 CLK2 RS485 MON CONSOLE ETH

FAULT

FAULT
RUN

RUN
ALM

ALM
100-120V-;200-240V-;50/60Hz;15.5A 100-120V-;200-240V-;50/60Hz;15.5A

P
W
OFF P
W
6

OFF
R R
ON

ON
3
1 2

3
4 5

1. Three of the following service cards can 2. Two MPUs 3. A pair of mounting
be installed: brackets
l Value-Added Service Unit NOTE

l Open Service Platform Unit The mounting brackets are used


to secure the chassis in the
l 100M Interface Card cabinet.
l 1000M Interface Card
l GE/10GE Interface Card
l 10GE Interface Card
l 40GE Interface Card
l 40GE/100GE Interface Card
l 100GE Interface Card
NOTE
The cards supported by a switch depend on the
software version. For details, see Hardware
Query Tool.

4. Two power modules 5. Reserved 6. Front ESD jack


slot
NOTE NOTE

Install a filler The ground terminal of an ESD


panel in the wrist strap can be inserted into
reserved slot. this jack. The ESD wrist strap
can provide ESD protection
when the chassis is reliably
grounded.

7. Cable management frames - -


NOTE
Cable management frames are used to route
cables.

Figure 4-4 shows the rear structure of the S9703 chassis.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 22


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Figure 4-4 S9703 chassis structure (rear view)

Hazardous moving parts, keeping fingers


and other body parts away.

Ϲ⽕೼亢᠛ᮟ䕀ᯊ᥹㾺৊⠛ʽ
4

1
RUN/ALM

3 2

1. One 6 Fan Module 2. Rear ESD jack 3. JG ground terminal


NOTE NOTE
The ground terminal of an ESD wrist strap
The JG ground terminal
can be inserted into this jack. The ESD
is used to ground the
wrist strap can provide ESD protection
chassis.
when the chassis is reliably grounded.

4. Air filter - -

NOTE
The air filter prevents dust
from entering the chassis.

Related Content
Interactive 3D views

Slot Configuration on the Chassis


The S9703 chassis provides 3 LPU slots, 2 MCU slots, and 2 power supply slots.
Figure 4-5 shows the slot layout at the front of the S9703 chassis, and Figure 4-6 shows the
slot layout at the rear of the S9703 chassis.

Figure 4-5 Slot layout on the S9703 chassis (front)

SLOT03-LPU

SLOT02-LPU

SLOT01-LPU
SLOT04-MCU SLOT05-MCU
PWR1 PWR2

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 23


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Figure 4-6 Slot layout on the S9703 chassis (rear)

FAN1

Table 4-3 describes the slot configuration in a chassis.

Table 4-3 S9703 slot configuration


Slot Type Slot ID Module Remarks
Supported

MCU slot SLOT04 and MPUs The MCUs work in


SLOT05 active/standby
mode.

LPU slot SLOT01 to SLOT03 l Value-Added NOTE


Service Unit The cards supported
by a switch depend
l Open Service on the software
Platform Unit version. For details,
see 2 Version
l 100M Interface Requirements for
Card Components.
l 1000M Interface
Card
l GE/10GE
Interface Card
l 10GE Interface
Card
l 40GE Interface
Card
l 40GE/100GE
Interface Card
l 100GE Interface
Card

Power slot PWR1 and PWR2 power modules -

Fan module slot FAN1 6 Fan Module -

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 24


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Power Supply Slot Configuration


NOTE

If a switch is running a version prior to V200R010C00, it does not allow combining the use of AC and DC
power modules or power modules of different wattages. If the switch is running V200R010C00 or a later
version, it allows combining the use of 2200 W AC and DC power modules. If the switch is running
V200R012C00 or a later version, it allows combining the use of 2200 W AC, 2200 W DC, and 3000 W AC
power modules.

The S9703 provides slots PWR1 and PWR2 for DC or AC power modules, as shown in Slot
layout on the S9703 chassis (front).

The S9703 series switches support two redundancy modes of power modules: N+N, and N+0.
The value of N depends on the maximum power actually required by the system. Ensure that
the total maximum output power of N power modules (N x maximum output power of each
power module) is larger than the maximum power actually required by the system. For
example, the maximum power required by the system is 4000 W. If two 2200 W power
modules are installed in the chassis, they work in 2+0 mode. The system can identify the
power redundancy mode, and you do not need to manually configure the power redundancy
mode. Table 4-4 describes the three power redundancy modes and the specific redundancy
modes supported by the S9703 series switches.

Table 4-4 Description of power redundancy modes


Redundancy Description Product Support
Mode

N+N l System power supply is not affected if no 1+1 redundancy


more than N power modules are removed or
fail.
l The maximum output power of the system is
the total maximum output power of N power
modules.
l The first N represents mandatory power
modules, and the second N represents
optional power modules.
NOTE
The N+N redundancy mode is often used when two
power supply systems are available. In this case, the
first N represents mandatory power modules for the
first power supply system, and the second N
represents mandatory power modules for the second
power supply system. The use of double power
supply systems provides redundancy for both power
modules and power supply systems.

N+0 (no l System power supply is affected once any 1+0, and 2+0
redundancy) power module is removed or fails.
l The maximum output power of the system is
the total maximum output power of N power
modules.
l N power modules are mandatory, and there
are no optional power modules.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 25


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

NOTE

l When using the N+N redundancy mode, equally divide the power modules into two groups and
connect the two groups of power modules to two independent power supply systems. This
configuration provides redundancy of power supply systems to enhance system reliability.
l When using the N+N redundancy mode, you are advised to install N power modules (as specified by
the first N) in the power supply slots at the left side and install N power modules (as specified by the
second N) in the power supply slots at the right side. Power slots are marked PWR.
l If the system power consumption exceeds 50% of a single power module's power, all power modules
equally share the power consumption. This reduces the load of a single power module and improves
the system reliability.

The following describes the power module configuration for an S9703 switch with different
power supplies:

l If DC power input is provided, configure power modules according to DC power input.


l If 220 V single-phase AC input or 110 V dual-live-wire AC input is provided, configure
power modules according to AC power input (220 V single-phase or 110 V dual-live-
wire input).
l If 110 V single-live-wire AC input is provided, configure power modules according to
AC power input (110 V single-live-wire input).

DC power input

Table 4-5 describes the power module configuration for the S9703 series switches when DC
power input is provided.

Table 4-5 Power module configuration (DC power input)

Power Module Type Redundancy Maximum Output Power


Mode

2200 W DC power module N+N A maximum of 2 (1+1) 2200 W DC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
2200 W.

N+0 (no A maximum of 2 (2+0) 2200 W DC


redundancy) power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
4400 W.

AC power input (220 V single-phase or 110 V dual-live-wire input)

NOTE

If the input voltage is 110 V, the dual-live-wire input mode is recommended. In this case, the maximum
output power of a 3000 W AC power module is 3000 W, the maximum output power of a 2200 W AC
power module is 2200 W, and the maximum output power of an 800 W AC power module is 800 W.

Table 4-6 describes the power module configuration for the S9703 series switches when 220
V single-phase or 110 V dual-live-wire AC power input is provided.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 26


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Table 4-6 Power module configuration (220 V single-phase or 110 V dual-live-wire AC


power input)
Power Module Type Redundancy Maximum Output Power
Mode

3000 W AC power module N+N A maximum of 2 (1+1) 3000 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
3000 W.

N+0 (no A maximum of 2 (2+0) 3000 W AC


redundancy) power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
4400 W.

2200 W AC power module N+N A maximum of 2 (1+1) 2200 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
2200 W.

N+0 (no A maximum of 2 (2+0) 2200 W AC


redundancy) power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
4400 W.

800 W AC power module N+N A maximum of 2 (1+1) 800 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
800 W.

N+0 (no A maximum of 2 (2+0) 800 W AC


redundancy) power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
1600 W.

AC power input (110 V single-live-wire input)

NOTE

When 110 V single-live-wire AC power input is provided, the maximum output power of a 3000 W AC
power module is 1500 W, the maximum output power of a 2200 W AC power module is 1100 W, and
the maximum output power of an 800 W AC power module is 400 W. In this case, it is recommended
that you use the N+1 or N+0 redundancy mode to increase the maximum output power of the system.

Table 4-7 describes the power module configuration for the S9703 series switches when 110
V single-live-wire AC power input is provided.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 27


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Table 4-7 Power module configuration (110 V single-live-wire AC power input is provided)
Power Module Type Redundancy Maximum Output Power
Mode

3000 W AC power module N+N A maximum of 2 (1+1) 3000 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
1500 W.

N+0 (no A maximum of 2 (2+0) 3000 W AC


redundancy) power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
3000 W.

2200 W AC power module N+N A maximum of 2 (1+1) 2200 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
1100 W.

N+0 (no A maximum of 2 (2+0) 2200 W AC


redundancy) power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
2200 W.

800 W AC power module N+N A maximum of 2 (1+1) 800 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
400 W.

N+0 (no A maximum of 2 (2+0) 800 W AC


redundancy) power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
800 W.

Heat Dissipation
NOTE

It is recommended that you replace the air filter of a device every six months.

The S9703 cooling system consists of fan modules and air filters. A fan module is located
behind the air exhaust vent (rear of the chassis), and an air filter is located outside the air
intake vent (left side of the chassis).
l The S9703 has one fan module, located at the rear of the chassis. The fan module draws
cold air into the chassis to dissipate heat generated by working components, ensuring
that the chassis operates within a normal temperature range. For details about the
performance and attributes of a fan module, see 6 Fan Module.
l The air filter prevents dust from entering the chassis with the airflow.
Airflow

NOTE

The S9703, S9706, and S9712 use the same airflow design.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 28


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

The S9703 chassis uses a left-to-back airflow design. Cold air is drawn into the chassis from
the left side, dissipates heat in the chassis, and is exhausted from the rear of the chassis.
Figure 4-7 shows the airflow in the chassis.

Figure 4-7 Airflow in the chassis

RUN/ALM

06

EH1D2
G48TEA0
4647
44 45
42 43
40 41 RUN/ALM

S9706
38 39
36 37
34 35
32 33
28 29
30 31 05
26 27
24 25

EH1D2
22 23
20 21

G48TEA0
18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647

EH1D2
8 9 44 45

G48TEA0
6 7 42 43
2
4 5 38 39
40 41 RUN/ALM
3 36 37
1
34 35
32 33
30 31
26 27
28 29 04
24 25

EH1D2
22 23
20 21

G48TEA0
18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647
EH1D2

8 9 44 45
G48TEA0

6 7 42 43
4 5 40 41
2 3 38 39
1 36 37
34 35
32 33
30 31
26 27
28 29 ETH 08

EH1D2
24 25 CON

SRUDC00
22 23 M
20 21 CLK2 ACT RUN/AL
18 19 CLK1
16 17
14 15
12 13 RST
10 11
EH1D2

8 9
G48TEA0

6 7 SYNC
4 5
2 3
1

ETH 07

EH1D2
CON

SRUDC00
M
CLK2 ACT RUN/AL
CLK1
RST
EH1D2
SRUDC00

SYNC RUN/ALM

03

EH1D2
G48TEA0
4647
EH1D2

44 45
42 43
SRUDC00

40 41 RUN/ALM
38 39
36 37
34 35
32 33
30 31
28 29
24 25
26 27 02

EH1D2
22 23
20 21

G48TEA0
18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647
EH1D2

8 9 44 45
G48TEA0

6 7 42 43
4 40 41
2 3
5 38 39 RUN/ALM
1 36 37
34 35
32 33
30 31
26 27
28 29 01
24 25

EH1D2
22 23
20 21

G48TEA0
18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11
EH1D2

8 4647
9 44 45
G48TEA0

6 7 42 43
4 5 40 41
2 3 38 39
1 36 37
34 35
32 33
30 31
28 29
26 27
24 25
22 23
20 21
18 19
16 17 CMU
14 15
12 13
10 11 PWR4
EH1D2

8 9
G48TEA0

6 7
2 3
4 5 PWR3
1
PWR2
RUN/ALM
RUN/ALM

PWR1
ACT
ACT

MON
MON

≤45
kg(99
lb)
RS485
RS485

CMUA
CMUA

ON
RUN
ON
RUN
ALM 2
ON
RUN 1
ON ALM
RUN FAULT
ALM
FAULT OFF
ALM
FAULT OFF
FAULT OFF
OFF

Air Filter

NOTE

The switches may use honeycomb air filters or non-honeycomb air filters. The switches with
honeycomb air filters installed in all air filter slots comply with Federal Communications Commission
(FCC) standards.

The S9703 uses either a sponge air filter or a honeycomb air filter. An FCC-certified chassis
must use a honeycomb air filter. Figure 4-8 shows a sponge air filter, and Figure 4-9 shows a
honeycomb air filter.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 29


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Figure 4-8 Sponge air filter

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 30


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Figure 4-9 Honeycomb air filter

Specifications

Table 4-8 S9703 chassis specifications


Item Description

LPU slots 3

MCU slots 2

Fan slots 1

Power slots 2

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 31


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Item Description

Maximum port density l V200R001C00: 144xFE, 144xGE,


120x10GE
l V200R002C00 and V200R003C00:
144xFE, 144xGE, 120x10GE, 24x40GE
l V200R005C00 to V200R007C10:
144xFE, 144xGE, 144x10GE, 24x40GE
l V200R008C00 to V200R009C00:
144xFE, 144xGE, 144x10GE, 24x40GE,
6x100GE
l V200R010C00 to V200R013C00:
144xFE, 144xGE, 144x10GE, 24x40GE,
12x100GE

Installation In an N66E or N68E cabinet

CSS Not supported

Maximum power consumption (fully 1185 W


loaded)
NOTE
The heat dissipation value of a chassis equals the
current power consumption of the chassis.

Power specifications l DC input voltage


Rated voltage: -48 V DC/-60 V DC
Maximum voltage range: -40 V DC to
-72 V DC
l AC input voltage
Rated voltage: 110 V AC/220 V AC,
50/60 Hz
Maximum voltage range: 90 V AC to
290 V AC; 47 Hz to 63 Hz (The output
power reduces to half of the maximum
output when the input voltage is in the
range of 90 V AC to 175 V AC.)
l HVDC input voltage (3000 W AC)
Rated voltage: 240 V DC
Maximum voltage range: 190 V DC to
290 V DC

Dimensions (W x D x H, excluding rack- l With cable management frames: 442 mm


mounting brackets) x 585 mm x 175 mm (17.4 in. x 23.0 in.
x 6.89 in. (4 U))
l Without cable management frames: 442
mm x 489 mm x 175 mm (17.4 in. x
19.3 in. x 6.89 in. (4 U))

Weight (empty/fully loaded) 11 kg/32.6 kg (24.3 lb/71.9 lb)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 32


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Item Description

Reliability and availability l Mean time between failures (MTBF):


33.8 years
l Mean time to repair (MTTR): 64
minutes
l Availability: 0.9999964
NOTE
The preceding values are calculated based on the
typical configuration of the product. The actual
values will vary depending on the modules
installed on the product.

Environment specifications l Operating temperature and altitude:


-60 m to +1800 m (197 ft. to 5906 ft.):
0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)
1800 m to 4000 m (5906 ft. to 13123
ft.): Operating temperature decreases by
1°C (1.8°F) every time the altitude
increases 220 m (722 ft.).
4000 m (13123 ft.): 0°C to 35°C (32°F
to 95°F)
l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to
95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C
(-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage altitude: < 5000 m (16404 ft.)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to
95% RH (noncondensing)

Noise at normal temperature (acoustic ≤ 72 dB(A)


power)

Certification l EMC certification


l Safety certification
l Manufacturing certification

Part number l S9703 chassis: 02113547


l S9703 chassis, FCC certified: 02113611

4.2 S9706

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 33


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Version Mapping

Table 4-9 Mapping between the S9706 chassis and software versions
Chassis Version

S9706 chassis V200R001C00 to V200R013C00 versions

S9706 chassis, FCC certified V200R001C00 to V200R013C00 versions

Appearance and Structure


NOTE
The figures in this document are for reference only.

The S9706 chassis is 10 U high (1 U = 44.45 mm). When the chassis has no cable
management frame installed, the dimensions are 442 mm x 489 mm x 441.7 mm (W x D x
H). When the chassis has cable management frames installed, the dimensions are 442 mm x
585 mm x 441.7 mm (W x D x H). Figure 4-10 and Figure 4-11 show the S9706 chassis.

Figure 4-10 S9706 chassis (front view)

RUN/ALM

06
EH1D2
G48TEA0

4647
44 45
42 43
40 41 RUN/ALM

S9706
38 39
36 37
34 35
32 33
26 27
28 29
30 31 05
24 25
EH1D2

22 23
20 21
G48TEA0

18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647
EH1D2

8 9 44 45
G48TEA0

6 7 42 43
2
4 5 38 39
40 41 RUN/ALM
3 36 37
1
34 35
32 33
30 31
26 27
28 29 04
24 25
EH1D2

22 23
20 21
G48TEA0

18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647
EH1D2

8 9 44 45
G48TEA0

6 7 42 43
4 5 40 41
2 3 38 39
1 36 37
34 35
32 33
30 31
26 27
28 29 ETH 08
EH1D2

24 25 CON
SRUDC00

22 23 M
20 21 CLK2 ACT RUN/AL
18 19 CLK1
16 17
14 15
12 13 RST
10 11
EH1D2

8 9
G48TEA0

6 7 SYNC
4 5
2 3
1

ETH 07
EH1D2

CON
SRUDC00

M
CLK2 ACT RUN/AL
CLK1
RST
EH1D2
SRUDC00

SYNC RUN/ALM

03
EH1D2
G48TEA0

4647
EH1D2

44 45
42 43
SRUDC00

40 41 RUN/ALM
38 39
36 37
34 35
32 33
30 31
28 29
24 25
26 27 02
EH1D2

22 23
20 21
G48TEA0

18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647
EH1D2

8 9 44 45
G48TEA0

6 7 42 43
4 40 41
2 3
5 38 39 RUN/ALM
1 36 37
34 35
32 33
30 31
26 27
28 29 01
24 25
EH1D2

22 23
20 21
G48TEA0

18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11
EH1D2

8 4647
9 44 45
G48TEA0

6 7 42 43
4 5 40 41
2 3 38 39
1 36 37
34 35
32 33
30 31
28 29
26 27
24 25
22 23
20 21
18 19
16 17 CMU
14 15
12 13
10 11 PWR4
EH1D2

8 9
G48TEA0

6 7
2 3
4 5 PWR3
1
PWR2
RUN/ALM
RUN/ALM

PWR1
ACT
ACT

MON
MON

≤45
kg(99
lb)
RS485
RS485

CMUA
CMUA

ON
RUN
ON
RUN
ALM 2
ON
RUN 1
ON ALM
RUN FAULT
ALM
FAULT OFF
ALM
FAULT OFF
FAULT OFF
OFF

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 34


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Figure 4-11 S9706 chassis (rear view)

fingers
keeping
moving parts,
Hazardous
away.
body parts
and other ਬ⡽έ
᧛䀜
᡽ᰁ䖢ᰬ
ћ⾷൞伄

Clean periodically
ᇐᵕ␻ᢡ
RUN/ALM

fingers
keeping
moving parts,
Hazardous
away.
body parts
and other ਬ⡽έ
᧛䀜
᡽ᰁ䖢ᰬ
ћ⾷൞伄

RUN/ALM

≤75
kg(16
5 lb)

NOTE

S9706 chassis include FCC-certified chassis and common chassis.

Figure 4-12 shows the front structure of the S9706 chassis.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 35


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Figure 4-12 S9706 chassis structure (front view)


S9706
RUN/ALM

EH1D2
EH1D2

G48TEA0
G48TEA0
RUN/ALM

EH1D2
EH1D2

G48TEA0
G48TEA0
RUN/ALM

EH1D2
EH1D2

G48TEA0
G48TEA0
CLK1 CLK2 CON ETH

EH1D2
08

EH1D2
SRUDC00

SRUDC00
SYNC

8
ACT RUN/ALM

2
RST

CLK1 CLK2 CON ETH


07
EH1D2

EH1D2
SRUDC00

SRUDC00
SYNC
ACT RUN/ALM
RST

RUN/ALM

EH1D2
EH1D2

G48TEA0
G48TEA0

RUN/ALM

EH1D2
EH1D2

G48TEA0
G48TEA0

RUN/ALM

EH1D2
EH1D2

G48TEA0
G48TEA0

100-120V-;200-240V-;50/60Hz;15.5A

100-120V-;200-240V-;50/60Hz;15.5A

100-120V-;200-240V-;50/60Hz;15.5A

100-120V-;200-240V-;50/60Hz;15.5A

3 3
ON ON ON ON
RUN RUN RUN RUN

ALM ALM ALM ALM

FAULT FAULT FAULT FAULT


OFF OFF OFF OFF

4 5 6

1. Six of the following service cards can 2. Two MPUs 3. A pair of


be installed: mounting brackets
l Value-Added Service Unit NOTE

l Open Service Platform Unit The mounting


brackets are used to
l 100M Interface Card secure the chassis in
l 1000M Interface Card the cabinet.

l GE/10GE Interface Card


l 10GE Interface Card
l 40GE Interface Card
l 40GE/100GE Interface Card
l 100GE Interface Card
NOTE
The cards supported by a switch depend on
the software version. For details, see
Hardware Query Tool.

4. Four power modules 5. Two 7.6 6. Reserved slot


EH1D200CMU00- NOTE
Centralized Monitoring Install a filler panel
Unit in the reserved slot.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 36


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

7. Front ESD jack 8. Cable management -


frames
NOTE NOTE
The ground terminal of an ESD wrist strap Cable management frames
can be inserted into this jack. The ESD wrist are used to route cables.
strap can provide ESD protection when the
chassis is reliably grounded.

Figure 4-13 shows the rear structure of the S9706 chassis.

Figure 4-13 S9706 chassis structure (rear view)


5

FAN1
FAN2
Hazardous moving parts, keeping fingers
and other body parts away.

ћ⾷൞伄᡽ᰁ䖢ᰬ᧛䀜ਬ⡽έ

RUN/ALM

4
1
Hazardous moving parts, keeping fingers
and other body parts away.

ћ⾷൞伄᡽ᰁ䖢ᰬ᧛䀜ਬ⡽έ

RUN/ALM

1. Two 6 Fan Module 2. Rear ESD jack 3. JG ground


terminal
NOTE
The ground terminal of an ESD wrist strap can be NOTE
inserted into this jack. The ESD wrist strap can The JG ground
provide ESD protection when the chassis is terminal is used to
reliably grounded. ground the chassis.

4. Air filter -
5. A pair of removable handles
NOTE NOTE
The air filter prevents
You can install these handles on two sides of the
dust from entering the
chassis to lift the chassis.
chassis.

Related Content

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 37


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Interactive 3D views

Slot Configuration on the Chassis


The S9706 chassis provides 6 LPU slots, 2 SRU slots, 2 CMU slots, and 4 power supply slots.
Figure 4-14 shows the slot layout at the front of the S9706 chassis, and Figure 4-15 shows
the slot layout at the rear of the S9706.

Figure 4-14 Slot layout on the S9706 chassis (front)

SLOT06-LPU
SLOT05-LPU
SLOT04-LPU
SLOT08-SRU

SLOT07-SRU
SLOT03-LPU

SLOT02-LPU
SLOT01-LPU
PWR1

PWR2

PWR3

PWR4
CMU1
CMU2

Figure 4-15 Slot layout on the S9706 chassis (rear)

FAN1

FAN2

Table 4-10 describes the slot configuration in a chassis.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 38


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Table 4-10 S9706 slot configuration


Slot Type Slot ID Module Remarks
Supported

MPU slot SLOT07 and MPUs The SRUs work in


SLOT08 active/standby
mode.

LPU slot SLOT01 to SLOT06 l Value-Added NOTE


Service Unit The cards supported
by a switch depend
l Open Service on the software
Platform Unit version. For details,
see 2 Version
l 100M Interface Requirements for
Card Components.
l 1000M Interface
Card
l GE/10GE
Interface Card
l 10GE Interface
Card
l 40GE Interface
Card
l 40GE/100GE
Interface Card
l 100GE Interface
Card

Power slot PWR1 to PWR4 power modules -

CMU slot CMU1 and CMU2 EH1D200CMU00 The CMUs work in


active/standby
mode.

Fan module slot FAN1, FAN2 6 Fan Module -

Power Supply Slot Configuration


NOTE

If a switch is running a version prior to V200R010C00, it does not allow combining the use of AC and DC
power modules or power modules of different wattages. If the switch is running V200R010C00 or a later
version, it allows combining the use of 2200 W AC and DC power modules. If the switch is running
V200R012C00 or a later version, it allows combining the use of 2200 W AC, 2200 W DC, and 3000 W AC
power modules.

The S9706 provides slots PWR1 to PWR4 for DC or AC power modules, as shown in Slot
layout on the S9706 chassis (front).
The S9706 series switches support three redundancy modes of power modules: N+N, N+1,
and N+0. The value of N depends on the maximum power actually required by the system.
Ensure that the total maximum output power of N power modules (N x maximum output
power of each power module) is larger than the maximum power actually required by the

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 39


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

system. For example, the maximum power required by the system is 4000 W. If two 2200 W
power modules are installed in the chassis, they work in 2+0 mode. If three 2200 W power
modules are installed, they work in 2+1 redundancy mode. If four 2200 W power modules are
installed, they work in 2+2 redundancy mode. The system can identify the power redundancy
mode, and you do not need to manually configure the power redundancy mode. Table 4-11
describes the three power redundancy modes and the specific redundancy modes supported by
the S9706 series switches.

Table 4-11 Description of power redundancy modes


Redu Description Scenario Product Support
ndanc
y
Mode

N+N l System power - 1+1, and 2+2 redundancy


supply is not
affected if no more
than N power
modules are
removed or fail.
l The maximum
output power of the
system is the total
maximum output
power of N power
modules.
l The first N
represents
mandatory power
modules, and the
second N represents
optional power
modules.
NOTE
The N+N redundancy
mode is often used when
two power supply
systems are available. In
this case, the first N
represents mandatory
power modules for the
first power supply
system, and the second N
represents mandatory
power modules for the
second power supply
system. The use of
double power supply
systems provides
redundancy for both
power modules and
power supply systems.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 40


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Redu Description Scenario Product Support


ndanc
y
Mode

N+1 l System power The 800 W AC power 1+1, 2+1, and 3+1
supply is not module is configured redundancy
affected if one for 220 V AC input or
power module is 110 V dual-live-wire
removed or fails. AC input.
l The maximum l The 2200 W AC or 1+1, and 2+1 redundancy
output power of the 3000 W AC power
system is the total module is
maximum output configured for 220
power of N power V AC input or 110
modules. V dual-live-wire AC
l N power modules input.
are mandatory, and l The 2200 W DC
one power module power module is
is optional. configured for DC
input.

The 800 W AC, 2200 1+1, 2+1, and 3+1


W AC, or 3000 W AC redundancy
power module is
configured for 110 V
single-live-wire AC
input.

N+0 l System power The 800 W AC power 1+0, 2+0, 3+0, and 4+0
(no supply is affected module is configured
redund once any power for 220 V AC input or
ancy) module is removed 110 V dual-live-wire
or fails. AC input.
l The maximum l The 2200 W AC or 1+0, and 2+0
output power of the 3000 W AC power
system is the total module is
maximum output configured for 220
power of N power V AC input or 110
modules. V dual-live-wire AC
l N power modules input.
are mandatory, and l The 2200 W DC
there are no optional power module is
power modules. configured for DC
input.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 41


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Redu Description Scenario Product Support


ndanc
y
Mode

The 800 W AC or 2200 1+0, 2+0, 3+0, and 4+0


W AC or 3000 W AC
power module is
configured for 110 V
single-live-wire AC
input.

NOTE

l When using the N+N redundancy mode, equally divide the power modules into two groups and
connect the two groups of power modules to two independent power supply systems. This
configuration provides redundancy of power supply systems to enhance system reliability.
l When using the N+N redundancy mode, you are advised to install N power modules (as specified by
the first N) in the power supply slots at the left side and install N power modules (as specified by the
second N) in the power supply slots at the right side. Power slots are marked PWR.
l If the system power consumption exceeds 50% of a single power module's power, all power modules
equally share the power consumption. This reduces the load of a single power module and improves
the system reliability.

The following describes the power module configuration for an S9706 switch with different
power supplies:
l If DC power input is provided, configure power modules according to DC power input.
l If 220 V single-phase AC input or 110 V dual-live-wire AC input is provided, configure
power modules according to AC power input (220 V single-phase or 110 V dual-live-
wire input).
l If 110 V single-live-wire AC input is provided, configure power modules according to
AC power input (110 V single-live-wire input).
DC power input
Table 4-12 describes the power module configuration for the S9706 series switches when DC
power input is provided.

Table 4-12 Power module configuration (DC power input)


Power Module Type Redundancy Maximum Output Power
Mode

2200 W DC power module N+N A maximum of 4 (2+2) 2200 W DC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
4400 W.

N+1 A maximum of 3 (2+1) 2200 W DC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
4400 W.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 42


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Power Module Type Redundancy Maximum Output Power


Mode

N+0 (no A maximum of 2 (2+0) 2200 W DC


redundancy) power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
4400 W.

AC power input (220 V single-phase or 110 V dual-live-wire input)

NOTE

If the input voltage is 110 V, the dual-live-wire input mode is recommended. In this case, the maximum
output power of a 3000 W AC power module is 3000 W, the maximum output power of a 2200 W AC
power module is 2200 W, and the maximum output power of an 800 W AC power module is 800 W.

Table 4-13 describes the power module configuration for the S9706 series switches when 220
V single-phase or 110 V dual-live-wire AC power input is provided.

Table 4-13 Power module configuration (220 V single-phase or 110 V dual-live-wire AC


power input)
Power Module Type Redundancy Maximum Output Power
Mode

3000 W AC power module N+N A maximum of 4 (2+2) 3000 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
4400 W.

N+1 A maximum of 3 (2+1) 3000 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
4400 W.

N+0 (no A maximum of 2 (2+0) 3000 W AC


redundancy) power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
4400 W.

2200 W AC power module N+N A maximum of 4 (2+2) 2200 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
4400 W.

N+1 A maximum of 3 (2+1) 2200 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
4400 W.

N+0 (no A maximum of 2 (2+0) 2200 W AC


redundancy) power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
4400 W.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 43


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Power Module Type Redundancy Maximum Output Power


Mode

800 W AC power module N+N A maximum of 4 (2+2) 800 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
1600 W.

N+1 A maximum of 4 (3+1) 800 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
2400 W.

N+0 (no A maximum of 4 (4+0) 800 W AC


redundancy) power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
3200 W.

AC power input (110 V single-live-wire input)

NOTE

When 110 V single-live-wire AC power input is provided, the maximum output power of a 3000 W AC
power module is 1500 W, the maximum output power of a 2200 W AC power module is 1100 W, and
the maximum output power of an 800 W AC power module is 400 W. In this case, it is recommended
that you use the N+1 or N+0 redundancy mode to increase the maximum output power of the system.

Table 4-14 describes the power module configuration for the S9706 series switches when 110
V single-live-wire AC power input is provided.

Table 4-14 Power module configuration (110 V single-live-wire AC power input is provided)
Power Module Type Redundancy Maximum Output Power
Mode

3000 W AC power module N+N A maximum of 4 (2+2) 3000 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
3000 W.

N+1 A maximum of 4 (3+1) 3000 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
4400 W.

N+0 (no A maximum of 3 (3+0) 3000 W AC


redundancy) power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
4400 W.

2200 W AC power module N+N A maximum of 4 (2+2) 2200 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
2200 W.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 44


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Power Module Type Redundancy Maximum Output Power


Mode

N+1 A maximum of 4 (3+1) 2200 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
3300 W.

N+0 (no A maximum of 4 (4+0) 2200 W AC


redundancy) power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
4400 W.

800 W AC power module N+N A maximum of 4 (2+2) 800 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
800 W.

N+1 A maximum of 4 (3+1) 800 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
1200 W.

N+0 (no A maximum of 4 (4+0) 800 W AC


redundancy) power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
1600 W.

Heat Dissipation
NOTE

It is recommended that you replace the air filter of a device every six months.

The S9706 cooling system consists of fan modules and air filters. A fan module is located
behind the air exhaust vent (rear of the chassis), and an air filter is located outside the air
intake vent (left side of the chassis).
l The S9706 has two fan modules respectively, located at the rear of the chassis. The fan
modules absorb cold air into the chassis to dissipate heat generated by working
components, ensuring that the chassis operates within a normal temperature range. For
details about the performance and attributes of a fan module, see 6 Fan Module.
l The air filter prevents dust from entering the chassis with the airflow.
The S9706 chassis are divided into multiple zones. If there are empty slots in a zone, the fans
corresponding to that zone operate at a low speed, which reduces power consumption and
noise.
As shown in Figure 4-16, two fan modules of the S9706 serve two zones, with four cards in
each zone.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 45


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Figure 4-16 S9706 fan zones

SLOT6-LPU
SLOT5-LPU
Zone 1
SLOT4-LPU
SLOT8-SRU

SLOT7-SRU
SLOT3-LPU
Zone 2
SLOT2-LPU
SLOT1-LPU
CMU1
CMU2

Airflow
The S9706 chassis uses a left-to-back airflow design. Cold air is drawn into the chassis from
the left side, dissipates heat in the chassis, and is exhausted from the rear of the chassis.
Figure 4-17 shows the airflow in the chassis.

Figure 4-17 Airflow in the chassis

RUN/ALM

06
EH1D2
G48TEA0

4647
44 45
42 43
40 41 RUN/ALM

S9706
38 39
36 37
34 35
32 33
28 29
30 31 05
26 27
24 25
EH1D2

22 23
20 21
G48TEA0

18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647
EH1D2

8 9 44 45
G48TEA0

6 7 42 43
2
4 5 38 39
40 41 RUN/ALM
3 36 37
1
34 35
32 33
30 31
26 27
28 29 04
24 25
EH1D2

22 23
20 21
G48TEA0

18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647
EH1D2

8 9 44 45
G48TEA0

6 7 42 43
4 5 40 41
2 3 38 39
1 36 37
34 35
32 33
30 31
26 27
28 29 ETH 08
EH1D2

24 25 CON
SRUDC00

22 23 M
20 21 CLK2 ACT RUN/AL
18 19 CLK1
16 17
14 15
12 13 RST
10 11
EH1D2

8 9
G48TEA0

6 7 SYNC
4 5
2 3
1

ETH 07
EH1D2

CON
SRUDC00

M
CLK2 ACT RUN/AL
CLK1
RST
EH1D2
SRUDC00

SYNC RUN/ALM

03
EH1D2
G48TEA0

4647
EH1D2

44 45
42 43
SRUDC00

40 41 RUN/ALM
38 39
36 37
34 35
32 33
30 31
28 29
24 25
26 27 02
EH1D2

22 23
20 21
G48TEA0

18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647
EH1D2

8 9 44 45
G48TEA0

6 7 42 43
4 40 41
2 3
5 38 39 RUN/ALM
1 36 37
34 35
32 33
30 31
26 27
28 29 01
24 25
EH1D2

22 23
20 21
G48TEA0

18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11
EH1D2

8 4647
9 44 45
G48TEA0

6 7 42 43
4 5 40 41
2 3 38 39
1 36 37
34 35
32 33
30 31
28 29
26 27
24 25
22 23
20 21
18 19
16 17 CMU
14 15
12 13
10 11 PWR4
EH1D2

8 9
G48TEA0

6 7
2 3
4 5 PWR3
1
PWR2
RUN/ALM
RUN/ALM

PWR1
ACT
ACT

MON
MON

≤45
kg(99
lb)
RS485
RS485

CMUA
CMUA

ON
RUN
ON
RUN
ALM 2
ON
RUN 1
ON ALM
RUN FAULT
ALM
FAULT OFF
ALM
FAULT OFF
FAULT OFF
OFF

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 46


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Air Filter

NOTE

The switches may use honeycomb air filters or non-honeycomb air filters. The switches with
honeycomb air filters installed in all air filter slots comply with Federal Communications Commission
(FCC) standards.

The S9706 uses sponge air filters or honeycomb air filters. An FCC-certified chassis must use
honeycomb air filters. Figure 4-18 shows a sponge air filter, and Figure 4-19 shows a
honeycomb air filter.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 47


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Figure 4-18 Sponge air filter

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 48


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Figure 4-19 Honeycomb air filter

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 49


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Specifications

Table 4-15 S9706 chassis specifications


Item Description

LPU slots 6

MCU slots 2

Fan slots 2

Power slots 4

Maximum port density l V200R001C00: 288xFE, 288xGE,


240x10GE
l V200R002C00 and V200R003C00:
288xFE, 288xGE, 240x10GE, 48x40GE
l V200R005C00 to V200R007C10:
288xFE, 288xGE, 288x10GE, 48x40GE
l V200R008C00 to V200R009C00:
288xFE, 288xGE, 288x10GE, 48x40GE,
12x100GE
l V200R010C00 to V200R013C00:
288xFE, 288xGE, 288x10GE, 48x40GE,
24x100GE

Installation In an N66E or N68E cabinet, one or two


chassis in a cabinet

CSS Service port or CSS card clustering

Maximum power consumption (fully 2640 W


loaded)
NOTE
The heat dissipation value of a chassis equals the
current power consumption of the chassis.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 50


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Item Description

Power specifications l DC input voltage


Rated voltage: -48 V DC/-60 V DC
Maximum voltage range: -40 V DC to
-72 V DC
l AC input voltage
Rated voltage: 110 V AC/220 V AC,
50/60 Hz
Maximum voltage range: 90 V AC to
290 V AC; 47 Hz to 63 Hz (The output
power reduces to half of the maximum
output when the input voltage is in the
range of 90 V AC to 175 V AC.)
l HVDC input voltage (3000 W AC)
Rated voltage: 240 V DC
Maximum voltage range: 190 V DC to
290 V DC

Dimensions (W x D x H, excluding rack- l With cable management frames: 442 mm


mounting brackets) x 585 mm x 441.7 mm (17.4 in. x 23.0
in. x 17.39 in. (10 U))
l Without cable management frames: 442
mm x 489 mm x 441.7 mm (17.4 in. x
19.3 in. x 17.39 in. (10 U))

Weight (empty/fully loaded) 29 kg/75.8 kg (63.9 lb/167.1 lb)

Reliability and availability l Mean time between failures (MTBF):


24.2 years
l Mean time to repair (MTTR): 52
minutes
l Availability: 0.9999959
NOTE
The preceding values are calculated based on the
typical configuration of the product. The actual
values will vary depending on the modules
installed on the product.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 51


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Item Description

Environment specifications l Operating temperature and altitude:


-60 m to +1800 m (197 ft. to 5906 ft.):
0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)
1800 m to 4000 m (5906 ft. to 13123
ft.): Operating temperature decreases by
1°C (1.8°F) every time the altitude
increases 220 m (722 ft.).
4000 m (13123 ft.): 0°C to 35°C (32°F
to 95°F)
l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to
95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C
(-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage altitude: < 5000 m (16404 ft.)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to
95% RH (noncondensing)

Noise at normal temperature (acoustic ≤ 72 dB(A)


power)

Certification l EMC certification


l Safety certification
l Manufacturing certification

Part number l S9706 chassis: 02113548


l S9706 chassis, FCC certified: 02113612

4.3 S9712

Version Mapping

Table 4-16 Mapping between the S9712 chassis and software versions
Chassis Version

S9712 chassis V200R001C00 to V200R013C00 versions

S9712 chassis, FCC certified V200R001C00 to V200R013C00 versions

Appearance and Structure


NOTE
The figures in this document are for reference only.

The S9712 chassis is 15 U high (1 U = 44.45 mm). When the chassis has no cable
management frame installed, the dimensions are 442 mm x 489 mm x 663.95 mm (W x D x

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 52


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

H). When the chassis has cable management frames installed, the dimensions are 442 mm x
585 mm x 663.95 mm (W x D x H). Figure 4-20 and Figure 4-21 show the S9712 chassis.

Figure 4-20 S9712 chassis (front view)

RUN/ALM

12

EH1D2
G48TEA0
S9712
4647
44 45
42 43
38 39
40 41 RUN/ALM
36 37
34 35
30 31
32 33 11
28 29
26 27
24 25

EH1D2
22 23
20 21

G48TEA0
18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647

EH1D2
8 9 44 45

G48TEA0
6 7 42 43
4 5 40 41 RUN/ALM
2 3 38 39
1 36 37
34 35
32 33
28 29
30 31 10
26 27
24 25

EH1D2
22 23
20 21

G48TEA0
18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647

EH1D2
8 9 44 45

G48TEA0
6 7 42 43
4 5 40 41 RUN/ALM
2 3 38 39
1 36 37
34 35
32 33
28 29
30 31 09
26 27
24 25

EH1D2
22 23
20 21

G48TEA0
18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647
EH1D2

8 9 44 45
G48TEA0

6 7 42 43
4 5 40 41 RUN/ALM
2 3 38 39
1 36 37
34 35
30 31
32 33 08
28 29
26 27
24 25

EH1D2
22 23
20 21

G48TEA0
18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647
EH1D2

8 9 44 45
G48TEA0

6 7 42 43
4 5 40 41 RUN/ALM
2 3 38 39
1 36 37
34 35
28 29
30 31
32 33
07
26 27
24 25

EH1D2
22 23
20 21

G48TEA0
18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647
EH1D2

8 9 44 45
G48TEA0

6 7 42 43
4 5 40 41
2 3 38 39
1 36 37
32 33
34 35 14
30 31
28 29 ETH
26 27

EH1D2
24 25 CON

SRUDC00
22 23 M
20 21 CLK2 ACT RUN/AL
18 19 CLK1
16 17
14 15
12 13 RST
10 11
EH1D2

8 9
G48TEA0

6 7 SYNC
4 5
2 3
1
13
ETH

EH1D2
CON

SRUDC00
M
CLK2 ACT RUN/AL
CLK1
RST
EH1D2
SRUDC00

SYNC RUN/ALM

06

EH1D2
G48TEA0
4647
EH1D2

44 45
SRUDC00

42 43
38 39
40 41 RUN/ALM
36 37
34 35
32 33
28 29
30 31 05
26 27
24 25

EH1D2
22 23
20 21

G48TEA0
18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647
EH1D2

8 9 44 45
G48TEA0

6 7 42 43
4 5 40 41 RUN/ALM
2 3 38 39
1 36 37
34 35
32 33
28 29
30 31 04
26 27
24 25

EH1D2
22 23
20 21

G48TEA0
18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647
EH1D2

8 9 44 45
G48TEA0

6 7 42 43
4 5 40 41 RUN/ALM
2 3 38 39
1 36 37
34 35
32 33
28 29
30 31 03
26 27
24 25

EH1D2
22 23
20 21

G48TEA0
18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647
EH1D2

8 9 44 45
G48TEA0

6 7 42 43
4 5 40 41 RUN/ALM
2 3 38 39
1 36 37
34 35
32 33
30 31
26 27
28 29 02
24 25
22 23 EH1D2
20 21
G48TEA0
18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647
EH1D2

8 9 44 45
G48TEA0

6 7 42 43
4 5 40 41 RUN/ALM
2 3 38 39
1 36 37
34 35
32 33
28 29
30 31 01
26 27
24 25
EH1D2

22 23
20 21
G48TEA0

18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647
EH1D2

8 9 44 45
G48TEA0

6 7 42 43
4 5 40 41
2 3 38 39
1 36 37
34 35
32 33
30 31
28 29 PWR6
26 27
24 25
22 23 PWR5
20 21
18 19
16 17 CMU
14 15
12 13
10 11 PWR4
EH1D2

8 9
G48TEA0

6
2
4 5
7 PWR3
3
1
PWR2
RUN/ALM
RUN/ALM

PWR1
ACT
ACT

MON
MON

≤75
kg(16
5 lb)
RS485
RS485

ON
CMUA RUN
CMUA ON
RUN
ALM

ALM
ON FAULT
RUN
ON FAULT OFF
RUN
2
ON
RUN
ALM
1 OFF
ALM
ON FAULT
RUN
ALM
FAULT OFF
ALM
FAULT OFF
FAULT OFF
OFF

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 53


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Figure 4-21 S9712 chassis (rear view)

fingers
keeping
moving parts,
Hazardous
away.
body parts
and other ਬ⡽έ
᧛䀜
᡽ᰁ䖢ᰬ
ћ⾷൞伄

Clean periodically
ᇐᵕ␻ᢡ
RUN/ALM

fingers
keeping
moving parts,
Hazardous
away.
body parts
and other ਬ⡽έ
᧛䀜
᡽ᰁ䖢ᰬ
ћ⾷൞伄

RUN/ALM

fingers
keeping
moving parts,
Hazardous
away.
body parts
and other ਬ⡽έ
᧛䀜
᡽ᰁ䖢ᰬ
ћ⾷൞伄

RUN/ALM

fingers
keeping
moving parts,
Hazardous
away.
body parts
and other ਬ⡽έ
᧛䀜
᡽ᰁ䖢ᰬ
ћ⾷൞伄

RUN/ALM

≤75
kg(16
5 lb)

NOTE

S9712 chassis include FCC-certified chassis and common chassis.

Figure 4-22 shows the front structure of the S9712 chassis.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 54


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Figure 4-22 S9712 chassis structure (front view)

RUN/ALM

EH1D2
EH1D2

G48TEA0
G48TEA0
RUN/ALM

EH1D2
EH1D2

G48TEA0
G48TEA0
RUN/ALM

EH1D2
EH1D2

G48TEA0
G48TEA0 RUN/ALM

EH1D2
EH1D2

G48TEA0
G48TEA0

RUN/ALM

EH1D2
EH1D2

G48TEA0
G48TEA0

RUN/ALM

EH1D2
EH1D2

G48TEA0
G48TEA0

CLK1 CLK2 CON ETH


EH1D2

EH1D2
SRUDC00

SRUDC00
SYNC
ACT RUN/ALM

2
RST

CLK1 CLK2 CON ETH 8


EH1D2

EH1D2
SRUDC00

SRUDC00
SYNC
ACT RUN/ALM
RST

RUN/ALM

EH1D2
EH1D2

G48TEA0
G48TEA0

RUN/ALM

EH1D2
EH1D2

G48TEA0
G48TEA0

RUN/ALM

EH1D2
EH1D2

G48TEA0
G48TEA0

RUN/ALM

EH1D2
EH1D2

G48TEA0
G48TEA0

RUN/ALM

EH1D2
EH1D2

G48TEA0
G48TEA0

RUN/ALM

EH1D2
EH1D2

G48TEA0
G48TEA0

100-120V-;200-240V-;50/60Hz;15.5A

100-120V-;200-240V-;50/60Hz;15.5A

100-120V-;200-240V-;50/60Hz;15.5A

100-120V-;200-240V-;50/60Hz;15.5A

100-120V-;200-240V-;50/60Hz;15.5A

100-120V-;200-240V-;50/60Hz;15.5A

3 3

ON ON ON ON ON ON
RUN RUN RUN RUN RUN RUN

ALM ALM ALM ALM ALM ALM

FAULT FAULT FAULT FAULT FAULT FAULT


OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF

4 5 4 6

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 55


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

1. Twelve of the following service cards 2. Two MPUs 3. A pair of


can be installed: mounting brackets
l Value-Added Service Unit NOTE

l Open Service Platform Unit The mounting


brackets are used to
l 100M Interface Card secure the chassis in
l 1000M Interface Card the cabinet.

l GE/10GE Interface Card


l 10GE Interface Card
l 40GE Interface Card
l 40GE/100GE Interface Card
l 100GE Interface Card
NOTE
The cards supported by a switch depend on
the software version. For details, see
Hardware Query Tool.

4. Six power modules 5. Two 7.6 6. Reserved slot


EH1D200CMU00- NOTE
Centralized Monitoring Install a filler panel
Unit in the reserved slot.

7. Front ESD jack 8. Cable management -


frames
NOTE NOTE
The ground terminal of an ESD wrist strap Cable management frames
can be inserted into this jack. The ESD wrist are used to route cables.
strap can provide ESD protection when the
chassis is reliably grounded.

Figure 4-23 shows the rear structure of the S9712 chassis.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 56


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Figure 4-23 S9712 chassis structure (rear view)


5

FAN1
FAN2
Hazardous moving parts, keeping fingers
and other body parts away. FAN3
ћ⾷൞伄᡽ᰁ䖢ᰬ᧛䀜ਬ⡽έ

FAN4

RUN/ALM

Hazardous moving parts, keeping fingers


and other body parts away.

ћ⾷൞伄᡽ᰁ䖢ᰬ᧛䀜ਬ⡽έ

RUN/ALM

1
4
Hazardous moving parts, keeping fingers
and other body parts away.

ћ⾷൞伄᡽ᰁ䖢ᰬ᧛䀜ਬ⡽έ

RUN/ALM

Hazardous moving parts, keeping fingers


and other body parts away.

ћ⾷൞伄᡽ᰁ䖢ᰬ᧛䀜ਬ⡽έ

RUN/ALM

1. Four 6 Fan Module 2. Rear ESD jack 3. JG ground


terminal
NOTE
The ground terminal of an ESD wrist strap can be NOTE
inserted into this jack. The ESD wrist strap can The JG ground
provide ESD protection when the chassis is terminal is used to
reliably grounded. ground the chassis.

4. Air filter -
5. A pair of removable handles
NOTE NOTE
The air filter prevents
You can install these handles on two sides of the
dust from entering the
chassis to lift the chassis.
chassis.

Related Content
Interactive 3D views

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 57


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Slot Configuration on the Chassis


The S9712 chassis provides 12 LPU slots, 2 SRU slots, 2 CMU slots, and 6 power supply
slots.
Figure 4-24 shows the slot layout at the front of the S9712 chassis, and Figure 4-25 shows
the slot layout at the rear of the S9712 chassis.

Figure 4-24 Slot layout on the S9712 chassis (front)

SLOT12-LPU

SLOT11-LPU
SLOT10-LPU

SLOT09-LPU
SLOT08-LPU
SLOT07-LPU
SLOT14-SRU
SLOT13-SRU
SLOT06-LPU
SLOT05-LPU
SLOT04-LPU
SLOT03-LPU

SLOT02-LPU
SLOT01-LPU
PWR1

PWR2

PWR3

PWR4

PWR5

PWR6
CMU1
CMU2

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 58


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Figure 4-25 Slot layout on the S9712 chassis (rear)

FAN1

FAN2

FAN3

FAN4

Table 4-17 describes the slot configuration in a chassis.

Table 4-17 S9712 slot configuration


Slot Type Slot ID Module Remarks
Supported

MPU slot SLOT13 and MPUs The SRUs work in


SLOT14 active/standby
mode.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 59


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Slot Type Slot ID Module Remarks


Supported

LPU slot SLOT01 to SLOT12 l Value-Added NOTE


Service Unit The cards supported
by a switch depend
l Open Service on the software
Platform Unit version. For details,
see 2 Version
l 100M Interface Requirements for
Card Components.
l 1000M Interface
Card
l GE/10GE
Interface Card
l 10GE Interface
Card
l 40GE Interface
Card
l 40GE/100GE
Interface Card
l 100GE Interface
Card

Power slot PWR1 to PWR6 power modules -

CMU slot CMU1 and CMU2 EH1D200CMU00 The CMUs work in


active/standby
mode.

Fan module slot FAN1 to FAN4 6 Fan Module -

Power Supply Slot Configuration


NOTE

If a switch is running a version prior to V200R010C00, it does not allow combining the use of AC and DC
power modules or power modules of different wattages. If the switch is running V200R010C00 or a later
version, it allows combining the use of 2200 W AC and DC power modules. If the switch is running
V200R012C00 or a later version, it allows combining the use of 2200 W AC, 2200 W DC, and 3000 W AC
power modules.

The S9712 provides slots PWR1 to PWR6 for DC or AC power modules, as shown in Slot
layout on the S9712 chassis (front).
The S9712 series switches support three redundancy modes of power modules: N+N, N+1,
and N+0. The value of N depends on the maximum power actually required by the system.
Ensure that the total maximum output power of N power modules (N x maximum output
power of each power module) is larger than the maximum power actually required by the
system. For example, the maximum power required by the system is 4000 W. If two 2200 W
power modules are installed in the chassis, they work in 2+0 mode. If three 2200 W power
modules are installed, they work in 2+1 redundancy mode. If four 2200 W power modules are
installed, they work in 2+2 redundancy mode. The system can identify the power redundancy
mode, and you do not need to manually configure the power redundancy mode. Table 4-18

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 60


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

describes the three power redundancy modes and the specific redundancy modes supported by
the S9712 series switches.

Table 4-18 Description of power redundancy modes


Redu Description Scenario Product Support
ndanc
y
Mode

N+N l System power - 1+1, 2+2, and 3+3


supply is not redundancy
affected if no more
than N power
modules are
removed or fail.
l The maximum
output power of the
system is the total
maximum output
power of N power
modules.
l The first N
represents
mandatory power
modules, and the
second N represents
optional power
modules.
NOTE
The N+N redundancy
mode is often used when
two power supply
systems are available. In
this case, the first N
represents mandatory
power modules for the
first power supply
system, and the second N
represents mandatory
power modules for the
second power supply
system. The use of
double power supply
systems provides
redundancy for both
power modules and
power supply systems.

N+1 l System power The 800 W AC power 1+1, 2+1, 3+1, 4+1, and
supply is not module is configured 5+1 redundancy
affected if one for 220 V AC input or
power module is 110 V dual-live-wire
removed or fails. AC input.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 61


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Redu Description Scenario Product Support


ndanc
y
Mode
l The maximum l The 3000 W AC or 1+1, 2+1, and 3+1
output power of the 2200 W AC power redundancy
system is the total module is
maximum output configured for 220
power of N power V AC input or 110
modules. V dual-live-wire AC
l N power modules input.
are mandatory, and l The 2200 W DC
one power module power module is
is optional. configured for DC
input.

The 800 W AC, 2200 1+1, 2+1, 3+1, 4+1, and


W AC, or 3000 W AC 5+1 redundancy
power module is
configured for 110 V
single-live-wire AC
input.

N+0 l System power The 800 W AC power 1+0, 2+0, 3+0, 4+0, 5+0,
(no supply is affected module is configured and 6+0
redund once any power for 220 V AC input or
ancy) module is removed 110 V dual-live-wire
or fails. AC input.
l The maximum l The 2200 W AC or 1+0, 2+0, and 3+0
output power of the 3000 W AC power
system is the total module is
maximum output configured for 220
power of N power V AC input or 110
modules. V dual-live-wire AC
l N power modules input.
are mandatory, and l The 2200 W DC
there are no optional power module is
power modules. configured for DC
input.

The 800 W AC, 2200 1+0, 2+0, 3+0, 4+0, 5+0,


W AC, or 3000 W AC and 6+0
power module is
configured for 110 V
single-live-wire AC
input.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 62


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

NOTE

l When using the N+N redundancy mode, equally divide the power modules into two groups and
connect the two groups of power modules to two independent power supply systems. This
configuration provides redundancy of power supply systems to enhance system reliability.
l When using the N+N redundancy mode, you are advised to install N power modules (as specified by
the first N) in the power supply slots at the left side and install N power modules (as specified by the
second N) in the power supply slots at the right side. Power slots are marked PWR.
l If the system power consumption exceeds 50% of a single power module's power, all power modules
equally share the power consumption. This reduces the load of a single power module and improves
the system reliability.
To support power supply for S9712, the 800 W AC power modules must meet the following
requirements:
l 220 V: At least two active 800 W AC power modules
l 110 V: At least three active 800 W AC power modules

The following describes the power module configuration for an S9712 switch with different
power supplies:

l If DC power input is provided, configure power modules according to DC power input.


l If 220 V single-phase AC input or 110 V dual-live-wire AC input is provided, configure
power modules according to AC power input (220 V single-phase or 110 V dual-live-
wire input).
l If 110 V single-live-wire AC input is provided, configure power modules according to
AC power input (110 V single-live-wire input).

DC power input

Table 4-19 describes the power module configuration for the S9712 series switches when DC
power input is provided.

Table 4-19 Power module configuration (DC power input)

Power Module Type Redundancy Maximum Output Power


Mode

2200 W DC power module N+N A maximum of 6 (3+3) 2200 W DC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
6600 W.

N+1 A maximum of 4 (3+1) 2200 W DC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
6600 W.

N+0 (no A maximum of 3 (3+0) 2200 W DC


redundancy) power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
6600 W.

AC power input (220 V single-phase or 110 V dual-live-wire input)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 63


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

NOTE

If the input voltage is 110 V, the dual-live-wire input mode is recommended. In this case, the maximum
output power of a 3000 W AC power module is 3000 W, the maximum output power of a 2200 W AC
power module is 2200 W, and the maximum output power of an 800 W AC power module is 800 W.

Table 4-20 describes the power module configuration for the S9712 series switches when 220
V single-phase or 110 V dual-live-wire AC power input is provided.

Table 4-20 Power module configuration (220 V single-phase or 110 V dual-live-wire AC


power input)
Power Module Type Redundancy Maximum Output Power
Mode

3000 W AC power module N+N A maximum of 6 (3+3) 3000 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
6600 W.

N+1 A maximum of 4 (3+1) 3000 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
6600 W.

N+0 (no A maximum of 3 (3+0) 3000 W AC


redundancy) power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
6600 W.

2200 W AC power module N+N A maximum of 6 (3+3) 2200 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
6600 W.

N+1 A maximum of 4 (3+1) 2200 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
6600 W.

N+0 (no A maximum of 3 (3+0) 2200 W AC


redundancy) power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
6600 W.

800 W AC power module N+N A maximum of 6 (3+3) 800 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
2400 W.

N+1 A maximum of 6 (5+1) 800 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
4000 W.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 64


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Power Module Type Redundancy Maximum Output Power


Mode

N+0 (no A maximum of 6 (6+0) 800 W AC


redundancy) power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
4800 W.

AC power input (110 V single-live-wire input)

NOTE

When 110 V single-live-wire AC power input is provided, the maximum output power of a 3000 W AC
power module is 1500 W, the maximum output power of a 2200 W AC power module is 1100 W, and
the maximum output power of an 800 W AC power module is 400 W. In this case, it is recommended
that you use the N+1 or N+0 redundancy mode to increase the maximum output power of the system.

Table 4-21 describes the power module configuration for the S9712 series switches when 110
V single-live-wire AC power input is provided.

Table 4-21 Power module configuration (110 V single-live-wire AC power input is provided)
Power Module Type Redundancy Maximum Output Power
Mode

3000 W AC power module N+N A maximum of 6 (3+3) 3000 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
4500 W.

N+1 A maximum of 6 (5+1) 3000 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
6600 W.

N+0 (no A maximum of 5 (5+0) 3000 W AC


redundancy) power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
6600 W.

2200 W AC power module N+N A maximum of 6 (3+3) 2200 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
3300 W.

N+1 A maximum of 6 (5+1) 2200 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
5500 W.

N+0 (no A maximum of 6 (6+0) 2200 W AC


redundancy) power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
6600 W.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 65


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Power Module Type Redundancy Maximum Output Power


Mode

800 W AC power module N+N A maximum of 6 (3+3) 800 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
1200 W.

N+1 A maximum of 6 (5+1) 800 W AC


power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
2000 W.

N+0 (no A maximum of 6 (6+0) 800 W AC


redundancy) power modules can be configured,
providing a maximum output power of
2400 W.

Heat Dissipation
NOTE

It is recommended that you replace the air filter of a device every six months.

The S9712 cooling system consists of fan modules and air filters. A fan module is located
behind the air exhaust vent (rear of the chassis), and an air filter is located outside the air
intake vent (left side of the chassis).
l The S9712 has four fan modules respectively, located at the rear of the chassis. The fan
modules absorb cold air into the chassis to dissipate heat generated by working
components, ensuring that the chassis operates within a normal temperature range. For
details about the performance and attributes of a fan module, see 6 Fan Module.
l The air filter prevents dust from entering the chassis with the airflow.
The S9712 chassis are divided into multiple zones. If there are empty slots in a zone, the fans
corresponding to that zone operate at a low speed, which reduces power consumption and
noise.
As shown in Figure 4-26, four fan modules of the S9712 serve four zones, with four cards in
each zone. The cards in slots 4 and 9 each belong to two zones and are cooled by two fan
modules.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 66


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Figure 4-26 S9712 fan zones

SLOT12-LPU

SLOT11-LPU
Zone 1
SLOT10-LPU

SLOT9-LPU
SLOT8-LPU
Zone 2
SLOT7-LPU
SLOT14-SRU
SLOT13-SRU
SLOT6-LPU
Zone 3
SLOT5-LPU
SLOT4-LPU
SLOT3-LPU
Zone 4
SLOT2-LPU
SLOT1-LPU
CMU1
CMU2

Airflow

NOTE

The S9703, S9706, and S9712 use the same airflow design.

The S9712 chassis uses a left-to-back airflow design. Cold air is drawn into the chassis from
the left side, dissipates heat in the chassis, and is exhausted from the rear of the chassis.
Figure 4-27 shows the airflow in the chassis.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 67


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Figure 4-27 Airflow in the chassis

RUN/ALM

06

EH1D2
G48TEA0
4647
44 45
42 43
40 41 RUN/ALM

S9706
38 39
36 37
34 35
32 33
28 29
30 31 05
26 27
24 25

EH1D2
22 23
20 21

G48TEA0
18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647

EH1D2
8 9 44 45

G48TEA0
6 7 42 43
2
4 5 38 39
40 41 RUN/ALM
3 36 37
1
34 35
32 33
30 31
26 27
28 29 04
24 25

EH1D2
22 23
20 21

G48TEA0
18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647

EH1D2
8 9 44 45

G48TEA0
6 7 42 43
4 5 40 41
2 3 38 39
1 36 37
34 35
32 33
30 31
26 27
28 29 ETH 08

EH1D2
24 25 CON

SRUDC00
22 23 M
20 21 CLK2 ACT RUN/AL
18 19 CLK1
16 17
14 15
12 13 RST
10 11

EH1D2
8 9

G48TEA0
6 7 SYNC
4 5
2 3
1

ETH 07

EH1D2
CON

SRUDC00
M
CLK2 ACT RUN/AL
CLK1
RST

EH1D2
SRUDC00
SYNC RUN/ALM

03

EH1D2
G48TEA0
4647
EH1D2

44 45
42 43
SRUDC00

40 41 RUN/ALM
38 39
36 37
34 35
32 33
30 31
28 29
24 25
26 27 02

EH1D2
22 23
20 21

G48TEA0
18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11 4647
EH1D2

8 9 44 45
G48TEA0

6 7 42 43
4 40 41
2 3
5 38 39 RUN/ALM
1 36 37
34 35
32 33
30 31
26 27
28 29 01
24 25

EH1D2
22 23
20 21

G48TEA0
18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13
10 11
EH1D2

8 4647
9 44 45
G48TEA0

6 7 42 43
4 5 40 41
2 3 38 39
1 36 37
34 35
32 33
30 31
28 29
26 27
24 25
22 23
20 21
18 19
16 17 CMU
14 15
12 13
10 11 PWR4
EH1D2

8 9
G48TEA0

6 7
2 3
4 5 PWR3
1
PWR2

RUN/ALM
RUN/ALM
PWR1

ACT
ACT

MON
MON
≤45
kg(99
lb)

RS485
RS485

CMUA
CMUA

ON
RUN
ON
RUN
ALM 2
ON
RUN 1
ON ALM
RUN FAULT
ALM
FAULT OFF
ALM
FAULT OFF
FAULT OFF
OFF

Air Filter

NOTE

The switches may use honeycomb air filters or non-honeycomb air filters. The switches with
honeycomb air filters installed in all air filter slots comply with Federal Communications Commission
(FCC) standards.

The S9712 uses sponge air filters or honeycomb air filters. An FCC-certified chassis must use
honeycomb air filters. Figure 4-28 shows a sponge air filter, and Figure 4-29 shows a
honeycomb air filter.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 68


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Figure 4-28 Sponge air filter

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 69


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Figure 4-29 Honeycomb air filter

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 70


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Specifications

Table 4-22 S9712 chassis specifications


Item Description

LPU slots 12

MCU slots 2

Fan slots 4

Power slots 6

Maximum port density l V200R001C00: 576xFE, 576xGE,


480x10GE
l V200R002C00 and V200R003C00:
576xFE, 576xGE, 480x10GE, 96x40GE
l V200R005C00 to V200R007C10:
576xFE, 576xGE, 576x10GE, 96x40GE
l V200R008C00 to V200R009C00:
576xFE, 576xGE, 576x10GE, 96x40GE,
24x100GE
l V200R010C00 to V200R013C00:
576xFE, 576xGE, 576x10GE, 96x40GE,
48x100GE

Installation In an N66E or N68E cabinet, one cabinet


for one chassis

CSS Service port or CSS card clustering

Maximum power consumption (fully 4906 W


loaded)
NOTE
The heat dissipation value of a chassis equals the
current power consumption of the chassis.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 71


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Item Description

Power specifications l DC input voltage


Rated voltage: -48 V DC/-60 V DC
Maximum voltage range: -40 V DC to
-72 V DC
l AC input voltage
Rated voltage: 110 V AC/220 V AC,
50/60 Hz
Maximum voltage range: 90 V AC to
290 V AC; 47 Hz to 63 Hz (The output
power reduces to half of the maximum
output when the input voltage is in the
range of 90 V AC to 175 V AC.)
l HVDC input voltage (3000 W AC)
Rated voltage: 240 V DC
Maximum voltage range: 190 V DC to
290 V DC

Dimensions (W x D x H, excluding rack- l With cable management frames: 442 mm


mounting brackets) x 585 mm x 663.95 mm (17.4 in. x 23.0
in. x 26.1 in. (15 U))
l Without cable management frames: 442
mm x 489 mm x 663.95 mm (17.4 in. x
19.3 in. x 26.1 in. (15 U))

Weight (empty/fully loaded) 37 kg/116 kg (81.6 lb/255.7 lb)

Reliability and availability l Mean time between failures (MTBF):


24.1 years
l Mean time to repair (MTTR): 52
minutes
l Availability: 0.9999959
NOTE
The preceding values are calculated based on the
typical configuration of the product. The actual
values will vary depending on the modules
installed on the product.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 72


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 4 Chassis

Item Description

Environment specifications l Operating temperature and altitude:


-60 m to +1800 m (197 ft. to 5906 ft.):
0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)
1800 m to 4000 m (5906 ft. to 13123
ft.): Operating temperature decreases by
1°C (1.8°F) every time the altitude
increases 220 m (722 ft.).
4000 m (13123 ft.): 0°C to 35°C (32°F
to 95°F)
l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to
95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C
(-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage altitude: < 5000 m (16404 ft.)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to
95% RH (noncondensing)

Noise at normal temperature (acoustic ≤ 72 dB(A)


power)

Certification l EMC certification


l Safety certification
l Manufacturing certification

Part number l S9712 chassis: 02113549


l S9712 chassis, FCC certified: 02113613

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 73


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

5 Power Supply Facilities

About This Chapter

5.1 Power Module


5.2 Power Distribution Box

5.1 Power Module

5.1.1 2200 W DC Power Module

Version Mapping

Table 5-1 Switch chassis and software versions matching a 2200 W DC power module
Model Power Module Name S9700 Chassis

W2PSD2200 2200 W DC power module Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Appearance
A 2200 W DC power module is 3 U in height.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 74


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Figure 5-1 2200 W DC power module

RTN(+)
NEG(-)

RUN

ON ALM

OFF FAULT

V; 60A
-48 -60

Functions
A 2200 W DC power module provides a maximum power of 2200 W for the chassis. Table
5-2 describes the functions of a 2200 W DC power module.

Table 5-2 Functions of a 2200 W DC power module


Function Description

Input protection Input undervoltage In this protection state, the power


protection module is turned off and stops
supplying power. When the system
recovers from input undervoltage,
the power module can automatically
start supplying power again.

Input overcurrent protection In this protection state, the power


module is turned off and stops
supplying power. The power
module cannot automatically start
supplying power again and needs to
be replaced.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 75


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Function Description

Output protection Output overvoltage In this protection state:


protection l If output overvoltage is caused
by the power module itself, the
power module stops supplying
power. When the system
recovers from output
overvoltage, the power module
cannot automatically start
supplying power again.
l If output overvoltage is caused
by increase of the input voltage
received from the external power
source, the power module stops
supplying power. When the
system recovers from output
overvoltage, the power module
can automatically start supplying
power again.

Output overcurrent In this protection state, the output


protection current is limited to a certain value.
When the system recovers from
output overcurrent, the power
module can automatically start
supplying power again.

Output short-circuit In this protection state, the power


protection module supplies power
intermittently, and the output
current is limited to within a range.
When the system recovers from
output short-circuit, the power
module can automatically start
supplying power again.

Overtemperature protection When the temperature of the power


module exceeds a specified
threshold, the power module stops
supplying power. When the
temperature falls into the normal
range, the power module
automatically resumes power
supply.

Hot swapping The power module is hot


swappable.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 76


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Panel Description

Figure 5-2 Panel of a 2200 W DC power module

1 7

-48 -60V; 60A MAX

RUN 5
2 ALM 4
-48
FAULT
-60V; 60A MAX
3

1. NEG terminal 2. Power switch 3. FAULT indicator


NOTE
l ON: The power module is
supplying power.
l OFF: The power module is not
supplying power.

4. ALM indicator 5. RUN indicator 6. Ejector lever


NOTE
Raise the ejector lever to release the
power module from the slot, and lower
the ejector lever to lock the power
module in the slot.

7. RTN terminal - -

Table 5-3 Indicators on a power module panel


Indicator Color Description

FAULT Red Steady on: The power


module has a fault that
cannot be rectified.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 77


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Indicator Color Description

ALM Yellow Steady on: A power output


shutdown alarm,
overtemperature alarm,
output overcurrent alarm,
input overvoltage alarm, or
input undervoltage alarm
has been generated.
Blinking: Communication
with the monitoring device
(MCU or CMU) has been
interrupted.

RUN Green Steady on: The power input


is normal.

Table 5-4 describes the relationship between cables and the terminals on a 2200 W DC power
module.

Table 5-4 Relationship between cables and the terminals on a 2200 W DC power module

Input Terminal Cable Type Cable Color Connected Terminal


Identifier

RTN Power ground Black OT bare crimp terminal


NOTE cable
RTN indicates
return.

NEG Power cable Blue

Specifications

Table 5-5 Technical specifications of a 2200 W DC power module

Item Value

Dimensions (W x D x H) 41 mm x 393 mm x 130 mm (1.6 in.


x 15.5 in. x 5.1 in.)

Weight < 2.5 kg

Input Rated input voltage -48 V DC/-60 V DC

Input voltage range -40 V DC to -72 V DC

Maximum input current 60 A

Output Rated output voltage -53.5 V DC

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 78


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Item Value

Output voltage range -42 V DC to -58 V DC

Maximum output current 42 A

Maximum output power 2200 W

Hot swapping Supported

Environment specifications l Operating temperature: 0°C to


45°C (32°F to 113°F)
l Operating relative humidity: 5%
RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to
+70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH
to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Part number 02270117

5.1.2 800 W AC Power Module

Version Mapping

Table 5-6 Switch chassis and software versions matching an 800 W AC power module
Model Power Module Name S9700 Chassis

W2PSA0800 800 W AC power module Supported in V200R002C00 to


V200R013C00

Appearance
An 800 W AC power module is 3 U in height.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 79


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Figure 5-3 800 W AC power module

100-120V-;200-240V-;50/60Hz;5A
ON
RUN

ALM

FAULT

OFF

Functions
An 800 W AC power module provides a maximum power of 800 W for the chassis. Table 5-7
describes the functions of an 800 W AC power module.

Table 5-7 Functions of an 800 W AC power module


Function Description

Input protection Input undervoltage In this protection state, the power


protection module is turned off and stops
supplying power. When the system
recovers from input undervoltage,
the power module can automatically
start supplying power again.

Input overcurrent protection In this protection state, the power


module is turned off and stops
supplying power. The power
module cannot automatically start
supplying power again and needs to
be replaced.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 80


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Function Description

Output protection Output overvoltage In this protection state:


protection l If output overvoltage is caused
by the power module itself, the
power module stops supplying
power. When the system
recovers from output
overvoltage, the power module
cannot automatically start
supplying power again.
l If output overvoltage is caused
by increase of the input voltage
received from the external power
source, the power module stops
supplying power. When the
system recovers from output
overvoltage, the power module
can automatically start supplying
power again.

Output overcurrent In this protection state, the output


protection current is limited to a certain value.
When the system recovers from
output overcurrent, the power
module can automatically start
supplying power again.

Output short-circuit In this protection state, the power


protection module supplies power
intermittently, and the output
current is limited to within a range.
When the system recovers from
output short-circuit, the power
module can automatically start
supplying power again.

Overtemperature protection When the temperature of the power


module exceeds a specified
threshold, the power module stops
supplying power. When the
temperature falls into the normal
range, the power module
automatically resumes power
supply.

Hot swapping The power module is hot


swappable.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 81


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Panel Description

Figure 5-4 Panel of an 800 W AC power module

100-120V-;200-240V-;50/60Hz;5A
1 7

ON
RUN 5
2 ALM 4
OFF
FAULT 3

1. AC power 2. Power switch 3. FAULT indicator


socket NOTE
l ON: The power module is
supplying power.
l OFF: The power module is not
supplying power.

4. ALM indicator 5. RUN indicator 6. Ejector lever


NOTE
Raise the ejector lever to release the
power module from the slot, and lower
the ejector lever to lock the power
module in the slot.

7. Loose-proof - -
pinch

Table 5-8 Indicators on a power module panel


Indicator Color Description

FAULT Red Steady on: The power


module has a fault that
cannot be rectified.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 82


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Indicator Color Description

ALM Yellow Steady on: A power output


shutdown alarm,
overtemperature alarm,
output overcurrent alarm,
input overvoltage alarm, or
input undervoltage alarm
has been generated.
Blinking: Communication
with the monitoring device
(MCU or CMU) has been
interrupted.

RUN Green Steady on: The power input


is normal.

Specifications

Table 5-9 Technical specifications of an 800 W AC power module


Item Value

Dimensions (W x D x H) 41 mm x 393 mm x 130 mm (1.6 in. x


15.5 in. x 5.1 in.)

Weight < 2.5 kg

Input Rated input voltage 220 V AC/110 V AC; 50/60 Hz

Rated input voltage range 200 V AC to 240 V AC (220 V AC


input)/100 V AC to 120 V AC (110 V
AC input); 47 Hz to 63 Hz

Maximum input voltage range 90 V AC to 290 V AC; 47 Hz to 63


Hz (When the input voltage is in the
range of 90 V AC to 175 V AC, the
power module provides up to half of
the maximum output power.)

Maximum input current 5A

Output Maximum output current 15 A (220 V AC input)/7.5 A (110 V


AC input)

Maximum output power 800 W (220 V AC input)/400 W (110


V AC input)

Hot swapping Supported

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 83


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Item Value

Environment specifications l Operating temperature: 0°C to


45°C (32°F to 113°F)
l Operating relative humidity: 5%
RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to
+70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH
to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Part number 02130979

5.1.3 2200 W AC Power Module

Version Mapping

Table 5-10 Switch chassis and software versions matching a 2200 W AC power module
Model Power Module Name S9700 Chassis

W2PSA2230 2200 W AC power module Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

PAC-2200W 2200 W AC power module Supported in V200R001C00 to


F V200R013C00
NOTE
PAC-2200W
F has
replaced
W2PSA2230
since Feb,
2015.

Appearance
A 2200 W AC power module is 3 U in height.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 84


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Figure 5-5 2200 W AC power module (W2PSA2230)

100-120V-;200-240V-;50/60Hz;15.5A
ON
RUN

ALM

FAULT

OFF

Figure 5-6 2200 W AC power module (PAC-2200WF)

00WF
PAC-22

INPUT

OUTPUT

ALARM

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 85


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

NOTE

Do not insert the power cable locking strap into an air vent on the power module panel, as this will affect
operations of the power module.

Functions
A 2200 W AC power module provides a maximum power of 2200 W for the chassis. Table
5-11 describes the functions of a 2200 W AC power module.

Table 5-11 Functions of a 2200 W AC power module

Function Description

Input protection Input undervoltage In this protection state, the power


protection module is turned off and stops
supplying power. When the system
recovers from input undervoltage,
the power module can automatically
start supplying power again.

Input overcurrent protection In this protection state, the power


module is turned off and stops
supplying power. The power
module cannot automatically start
supplying power again and needs to
be replaced.

Output protection Output overvoltage In this protection state:


protection l If output overvoltage is caused
by the power module itself, the
power module stops supplying
power. When the system
recovers from output
overvoltage, the power module
cannot automatically start
supplying power again.
l If output overvoltage is caused
by increase of the input voltage
received from the external power
source, the power module stops
supplying power. When the
system recovers from output
overvoltage, the power module
can automatically start supplying
power again.

Output overcurrent In this protection state, the output


protection current is limited to a certain value.
When the system recovers from
output overcurrent, the power
module can automatically start
supplying power again.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 86


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Function Description

Output short-circuit In this protection state, the power


protection module supplies power
intermittently, and the output
current is limited to within a range.
When the system recovers from
output short-circuit, the power
module can automatically start
supplying power again.

Overtemperature protection When the temperature of the power


module exceeds a specified
threshold, the power module stops
supplying power. When the
temperature falls into the normal
range, the power module
automatically resumes power
supply.

Hot swapping The power module is hot


swappable.

Panel Description

Figure 5-7 Panel of a 2200 W AC power module (W2PSA2230)


100-120V-;200-240V-;50/60Hz;15.5A

ON
RUN 5
2 ALM 4
OFF
FAULT 3

1. Power 2. Power switch 3. FAULT indicator


socket NOTE
l ON: The power module is
supplying power.
l OFF: The power module is not
supplying power.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 87


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

4. ALM 5. RUN indicator 6. Ejector lever


indicator NOTE
Raise the ejector lever to release the
power module from the slot, and lower
the ejector lever to lock the power module
in the slot.

Figure 5-8 Panel of a 2200 W AC power module (PAC-2200WF)

ON INPUT
6
1 OUTPUT
5
4
OFF ALARM

3
100-120/200-240V;50/60Hz;15.5A

1. Power switch 2. Ejector lever 3. Power


NOTE NOTE socket
l When the power switch is turned ON, the Raise the ejector lever to release the
power module supplies power to the power module from the slot, and
chassis. lower the ejector lever to lock the
l When the power switch is turned OFF, power module in the slot.
the power module does not supply power
to the chassis.

4. ALARM indicator 5. OUTPUT indicator 6. INPUT


indicator

Table 5-12 Indicators on a power module panel (W2PSA2230)


Indicator Color Description

FAULT Red Steady on: The power


module has a fault that
cannot be rectified.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 88


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Indicator Color Description

ALM Yellow Steady on: A power output


shutdown alarm,
overtemperature alarm,
output overcurrent alarm,
input overvoltage alarm, or
input undervoltage alarm
has been generated.
Blinking: Communication
with the monitoring device
(MCU or CMU) has been
interrupted.

RUN Green Steady on: The power input


is normal.

Table 5-13 Indicators on a power module panel (PAC-2200WF)


Indicator Color Description

INPUT Green Steady on: The input power


of the power module is in
the normal range.
Blinking: The power
module is in an input
undervoltage or input
overvoltage condition.
Off: The power module
receives no input power.

OUTPUT Green Steady on: The output


power of the power module
is in the normal range.
Off: The power module
provides no output power.

ALARM Red Steady on: The power


voltage is experiencing
overheating, external short
circuit, output overvoltage,
output overcurrent, or a fan
failure.
Blinking: Communication
between the power module
and CMU has been
interrupted.
Off: The power module is
working normally.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 89


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Specifications

Table 5-14 Technical specifications of a 2200 W AC power module


Item Value

Dimensions (W x D x H) 41 mm x 393 mm x 130 mm (1.6 in.


x 15.5 in. x 5.1 in.)

Weight < 2.5 kg

Input Rated input voltage 220 V AC/110 V AC; 50/60 Hz

Rated input voltage range 200 V AC to 240 V AC (220 V AC


input)/100 V AC to 120 V AC (110
V AC input); 47 Hz to 63 Hz

Maximum input voltage range 90 V AC to 290 V AC; 47 Hz to 63


Hz (The maximum output power
reduces by a half when the input
voltage is in the range of 90 V AC to
175 V AC.)

Maximum input current 15.5 A

Output Maximum output current 42 A (220 V AC input)/21 A (110 V


AC Input)

Maximum output power 2200 W (220 V AC input)/1100 W


(110 V AC input)

Hot swapping Supported

Environment specifications l Operating temperature: 0°C to


45°C (32°F to 113°F)
l Operating relative humidity: 5%
RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to
+70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH
to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Part number W2PSA2230: 02130977


PAC-2200WF: 02131120

5.1.4 3000 W AC Power Module

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 90


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Version Mapping

Table 5-15 Switch chassis and software versions matching a 3000 W AC power module
Model Power Module Name S9700 Chassis

PAC3KS54- 3000 W AC power module (Black) Supported only in V200R012C00


CB and V200R013C00

Appearance
A 3000 W AC power module is 3 U in height.

Figure 5-9 3000 W AC power module

54-CB
PAC3KS

INPUT

OUTPUT

ALARM

240V; 14A
16A or
V; 50/60Hz;
/200-240
-100-130

NOTE

Do not insert the power cable locking strap into an air vent on the power module panel, as this will affect
operations of the power module.

Functions
A 3000 W AC power module provides a maximum power of 3000 W for the chassis. Table
5-16 describes the functions of a 3000 W AC power module.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 91


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Table 5-16 Functions of a 3000 W AC power module


Function Description

Input Input overvoltage In this protection state, the power module is turned
protection protection off and stops supplying power. When the system
recovers from input overvoltage, the power module
can automatically start supplying power again.

Input undervoltage In this protection state, the power module is turned


protection off and stops supplying power. When the system
recovers from input undervoltage, the power
module can automatically start supplying power
again.

Input overcurrent In this protection state, the power module is turned


protection off and stops supplying power. The power module
cannot automatically start supplying power again
and needs to be replaced.

Output Output In this protection state:


protection overvoltage l If output overvoltage is caused by the power
protection module itself, the power module stops supplying
power. When the system recovers from output
overvoltage, the power module cannot
automatically start supplying power again.
l If output overvoltage is caused by increase of
the input voltage received from the external
power source, the power module stops
supplying power. When the system recovers
from output overvoltage, the power module can
automatically start supplying power again.

Output overcurrent In this protection state, the output current is limited


protection to a certain value. When the system recovers from
output overcurrent, the power module can
automatically start supplying power again.

Output short- In this protection state, the power module supplies


circuit protection power intermittently, and the output current is
limited to within a range. When the system
recovers from output short-circuit, the power
module can automatically start supplying power
again.

Overtemperature protection When the temperature of the power module


exceeds a specified threshold, the power module
stops supplying power. When the temperature falls
into the normal range, the power module
automatically resumes power supply.

Hot swapping The power module is hot swappable.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 92


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Panel Description

Figure 5-10 Panel of a 3000 W AC power module

ON INPUT
6
1 OUTPUT
5
4
OFF ALARM

3
-100-130/200-240V;50/60Hz;16A or 240V; 14A

1. Power switch 2. Ejector lever 3. Power


NOTE NOTE socket
l When the power switch is turned ON, the Raise the ejector lever to release the
power module supplies power to the power module from the slot, and
chassis. lower the ejector lever to lock the
l When the power switch is turned OFF, power module in the slot.
the power module does not supply power
to the chassis.

4. ALARM indicator 5. OUTPUT indicator 6. INPUT


indicator

Table 5-17 Indicators on a power module panel


Indicator Color Description

INPUT Green Steady on: The input power


of the power module is in
the normal range.
Blinking: The power
module is in an input
undervoltage or input
overvoltage condition.
Off: The power module
receives no input power.

OUTPUT Green Steady on: The output


power of the power module
is in the normal range.
Off: The power module
provides no output power.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 93


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Indicator Color Description

ALARM Red Steady on: The power


voltage is experiencing
overtemperature, external
short circuit, output
overvoltage, output
overcurrent, or a fan failure.
Blinking: Communication
between the power module
and CMU has been
interrupted.
Off: The power module is
working normally.

Specifications

Table 5-18 Technical specifications of a 3000 W AC power module

Item Value

Dimensions (W x D x H) 41 mm x 417.4 mm x 130 mm (0.2


in. x 16.4 in. x 5.1 in.)

Weight < 3.0 kg

AC input Rated input voltage 220 V AC/110 V AC; 50/60 Hz

Rated input voltage range 200 V AC to 240 V AC (220 V AC


input)/100 V AC to 130 V AC (110
V AC input); 47 Hz to 63 Hz

Maximum input voltage range 90 V AC to 290 V AC; 47 Hz to 63


Hz (The maximum output power
reduces by a half when the input
voltage is in the range of 90 V AC to
175 V AC.)
The maximum current of the power
cable used by the 3000 W AC power
module is 16 A. When the 220 V
input is used, the minimum voltage
cannot be lower than 200 V. When
the 110 V input is used, the minimum
voltage cannot be lower than 100 V.

Maximum input current 16 A

High- Rated input voltage 240 V DC


voltage
DC input Rated input voltage range 190 V DC to 290 V DC

Maximum input voltage range 14 A

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 94


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Item Value

Output Maximum output current 56.1 A (220 V AC input)/28.1 A (110


V AC Input)

Maximum output power 3000 W (220 V AC input or 240 V


DC)/1500 W (110 V AC input)

Hot swapping Supported

Environment specifications l Operating temperature: 0°C to


45°C
l Operating relative humidity: 5%
RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to
+70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH
to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Part number PAC3KS54-CB: 02311XYE


PAC3KS54-CE: 02312FFP

NOTE

When a PAC3KS54-CB power module is used in the following chassis, its maximum output power is
2200 W:
l S9703 chassis running a version between V200R001C00 and V200R011C10
l S9706 chassis running a version between V200R001C00 and V200R011C10
l S9712 chassis running a version between V200R001C00 and V200R011C10

5.2 Power Distribution Box


5.2.1 2200 W DC Power Distribution Box
Figure 5-11 shows a 2200 W DC power distribution box.

Figure 5-11 2200 W DC power distribution box

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 95


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

A 2200 W DC power distribution box can use -48 V two-way short-circuiting bars, each of
which provides JG input terminals. A -48 V two-way short-circuiting bar allows a maximum
of 120 A input current and converts one input into two outputs to circuit breakers. Figure
5-12 shows a -48 V two-way short-circuiting bar.

Figure 5-12 -48 V two-way short-circuiting bar

A 2200 W DC power distribution box provides short-circuit protection and overload


protection.

Table 5-19 lists specifications of a 2200 W DC power distribution box.

Table 5-19 Specifications of a 2200 W DC power distribution box

Item Description

Inpu Rated input -48 V DC/-60 V DC


t voltage

Input voltage -38.4 V DC to -72 V DC

Input mode Eight DC inputs by default (Short-circuiting bars can convert the
eight inputs into four.)

Maximum 60 A per input (120 A per input when short-circuiting bars are
input current used)

Input terminal Cord end terminal, allowing power cables with a maximum of 35
mm2 diameter (When short-circuiting bars are used, M6 OT
terminals are used for -48 V input and cord end terminals are used
for RTN input.)

Outp Rated output -48 V DC to -60 V DC


ut voltage

Output voltage -38.4 V DC to -72 V DC

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 96


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Item Description

Number of Eight
outputs

Current of 63 A
each circuit
breaker

Output Overcurrent protection (Power supply needs to be restored


protection manually once the power distribution box enters the overcurrent
protection state.)

Output Cord end terminal, allowing power cables with a maximum of 35


terminal mm2 diameter

Envi Operating -25°C to +55°C (-13°F to +131°F)


ron temperature
ment
speci Storage -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
ficati temperature
ons Relative ≤ 95%
humidity

Standard 70 kPa to 106 kPa


atmospheric
pressure

Dimensions (W x D x 442 mm x 89.2 mm x 110 mm (17.4 in. x 3.5 in. x 4.4 in.)
H)

Model EH1M00PDBS01

Part number 02355419

Figure 5-13 and Figure 5-14 show power distribution in a 2200 W DC power distribution
box.

Figure 5-13 Power distribution in a 2200 W DC power distribution box (eight inputs and
eight outputs)

A1- A2- A3- A4- A1+A2+A3+A4+ B1+B2+B3+B4+ B1- B2- B3- B4-

Input

Output

A1- A2- A3- A4- A1+A2+A3+A4+ B1+B2+B3+B4+ B1- B2- B3- B4-

Area A Area B

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 97


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Figure 5-14 Power distribution in a 2200 W DC power distribution box (four inputs and eight
outputs)

5.2.2 800 W AC Power Distribution Box

Figure 5-15 shows an 800 W AC power distribution box.

Figure 5-15 800 W AC power distribution box

An 800 W AC power distribution box can convert one power input into eight power outputs,
and it provides short-circuit protection and overload protection.

Table 5-20 lists specifications of an 800 W AC power distribution box.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 98


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Table 5-20 Specifications of an 800 W AC power distribution box


Item Description

Inpu Input voltage Rated voltage: 100 V AC to 240 V AC


t Operating voltage: 90 V AC to 276 V AC

Input terminal Cord end terminal (applicable to 0.75-25 mm2 power cables)

Outp Output Rated voltage: 100 V AC to 240 V AC


ut voltage Operating voltage: 90 V AC to 276 V AC

Number of Eight outputs controlled by eight circuit breakers


outputs

Current of 10 A
each circuit
breaker

Output Overcurrent protection (Power supply needs to be restored


protection manually once the power distribution box enters the overcurrent
protection state.)

Output Cord end terminal (applicable to 1.0 mm2 cables)


terminal

Envi Operating -25°C to +55°C (-13°F to +131°F)


ron temperature
ment
speci Storage -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
ficati temperature
ons Relative ≤ 95%
humidity

Standard 70 kPa to 106 kPa


atmospheric
pressure

Dimensions (W x D x 383 mm x 94.5 mm x 133 mm (15.1 in. x 3.7 in. x 5.2 in.)
H)

Model IN6W18L10A

Part number 02355417

Figure 5-16 shows power distribution in an 800 W AC power distribution box.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 99


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Figure 5-16 Power distribution in an 800 W AC power distribution box

5.2.3 2200 W AC Power Distribution Box

Figure 5-17 shows a 2200 W AC power distribution box.

Figure 5-17 2200 W AC power distribution box

A 2200 W AC power distribution box provides short-circuit protection and overload


protection.

Table 5-21 lists specifications of a 2200 W AC power distribution box.

Table 5-21 Specifications of a 2200 W AC power distribution box


Item Description

Inpu Input voltage Rated voltage: 100 V AC to 240 V AC


t Operating voltage: 90 V AC to 276 V AC

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 100


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Item Description

Input mode Typical application: two AC inputs (1+1). The delivered terminal
block has two AC input terminals (1+1) by default.

Three AC inputs (2+1)

Four AC inputs (2+2)

Maximum Two AC inputs (1+1): 32 A + 32 A (maximum)


input current
Three AC inputs (2+1): 16 A x 2 + 32 A (maximum)

Four AC inputs (2+2): 16 A x 4 (maximum)

Frequency 50/60±3 Hz

Outp Output Rated voltage: 100 V AC to 240 V AC


ut voltage Operating voltage: 90 V AC to 276 V AC

Number of Four outputs, with short-circuit protection function


outputs

Current of 16 A (maximum)
each output

Output Overcurrent protection and short-circuit protection (Power supply


protection needs to be restored manually once the power distribution box
enters a protection state.)

Envi Operating 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


ron temperature
ment
speci Storage -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
ficati temperature
ons Relative 5% to 95%
humidity

Altitude -60 m to +3000 m (-197 ft. to +9483 ft.)

Safety standards EN60950-1, IEC60950-1


compliance

Environmental RoHS, WEEE, Huawei regulation on the 13 hazardous substances


standards compliance

Dimensions (W x D x 436 mm x 94.5 mm x 133 mm (17.2 in. x 3.7 in. x 5.2 in.)
H)

Color NC purple grey

Model IM1W24APD

Part number 02355418

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 101


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Figure 5-18, Figure 5-19, and Figure 5-20 show power distribution in a 2200 W AC power
distribution box.

NOTE

If a 2200 W AC power distribution box is connected to one or two 2200 W AC power modules, only
OUTPUT A and OUTPUT B are used. In this case, only one input is required.

Figure 5-18 Power distribution in a 2200 W AC power distribution box (two inputs)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 102


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Figure 5-19 Power distribution in a 2200 W AC power distribution box (three inputs)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 103


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 5 Power Supply Facilities

Figure 5-20 Power distribution in a 2200 W AC power distribution box (four inputs)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 104


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 6 Fan Module

6 Fan Module

About This Chapter

6.1 EH1M00FBX000 Fan Module

6.1 EH1M00FBX000 Fan Module

A fan module reports an alarm when a fan in it fails. When receiving such an alarm, fix the
fault immediately to ensure effective cooling for the chassis.

Version Mapping
A fan module can be installed in:
l Slot FAN1 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots FAN1 and FAN2 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots FAN1 to FAN4 in an S9712 chassis.

Table 6-1 Switch chassis and software versions matching a fan module
Model Name S9700

EH1M00FBX000 Wide-voltage 74 fan box Supported in V200R001C00


to V200R013C00

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 105


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 6 Fan Module

Appearance

Figure 6-1 Fan module

fingers
parts, keeping
us moving
Hazardo
away.
body parts
and other ʽ
᥹㾺৊⠛
᠛ᮟ䕀ᯊ
Ϲ⽕೼亢

RUN/ALM

Functions

Table 6-2 Functions of fan modules


Function Description

Hot swapping Supported


Other fan modules are not affected when
you install or remove a fan module.

Automatic fan speed adjustment The switch provides intelligent fan speed
adjustment based on temperature in each
zone. The system monitors the temperature
of key components, and adjusts the fan
speed based on temperature changes. This
intelligent fan speed adjustment function
ensures that the system stays within the
proper operating temperature range, and
reduces power consumption and noise.

A fan module has two fans, and a failure of a fan does not immediately affect system
operations. When any fan in a fan module fails, fix the fan module as soon as possible.

Panel Description

Figure 6-2 Fan module panel

Hazardous moving parts, keeping fingers


and other body parts away.

Ϲ⽕೼亢᠛ᮟ䕀ᯊ᥹㾺৊⠛ʽ

1 4
RUN/ALM
3
2

1. Air vent 2. Captive screw 3. Fan status indicator 4. Handle

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 106


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 6 Fan Module

Table 6-3 Indicators on a fan module panel


Indicator Color Description

RUN/ALM Green Slow blinking: The fan


module is working properly,
and the communication is
normal.
Fast blinking: The fan
module is working properly,
but communication has not
been established.

Red Slow blinking: An alarm


was generated. You must
determine whether to
replace the fan module,
depending on the actual
situation.
Steady on: The fan module
has a hardware failure and
needs to be replaced.

Specifications

Table 6-4 Technical specifications of a fan module


Item Value

Dimensions (W x D x H) 323.9 mm x 74.8 mm x 126.6 mm (12.8 in.


x 2.9 in. x 5.0 in.)

Number of fans 2

Weight 1540±20 g

Maximum power consumption 116 W

Maximum wind pressure 692 Pa

Maximum wind rate 245 CFM

Maximum noise 70 dB(A)

Operating voltage range -30 V DC to -73 V DC

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 107


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 6 Fan Module

Item Value

Environment specifications l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C


(32°F to 113°F)
l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to
95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C
(-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to
95% RH (noncondensing)

Part number 02120666

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 108


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

7 Cards

About This Chapter

7.1 Naming Conventions


7.2 Card Types
7.3 Card Structure and Dimensions
7.4 Interface Numbering
7.5 Main Control Units and Subcards
7.6 EH1D200CMU00-Centralized Monitoring Unit
7.7 LE0D0VAMPA00-Value-Added Service Unit
7.8 EH1D2PS00P00-Open Service Platform Unit
7.9 100M Interface Cards
7.10 1000M Interface Cards
7.11 GE/10GE Interface Cards
7.12 10GE Interface Cards
7.13 40GE Interface Cards
7.14 40GE/100GE Interface Cards
7.15 100GE Interface Cards
7.16 POS Interface Card
7.17 User Manuals For ACU2, NGFW Module, and IPS Module (S9700)

7.1 Naming Conventions


A card name contains 12 characters, which are divided into four segments, as shown in
Figure 7-1.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 109


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-1 Card naming conventions

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12

d
c
b
a

a (the first three characters): represents the b (the fourth character): represents the
product series. component type. The letter D represents a
card.

c (the fifth character): represents the card d (the last six characters): represents the card
version, depending on the V version of the type and attributes. See Description of the
product. For example, if a card is available in Last Six Characters in a Card Name for
V200R001C00 and later versions, c is 2. the meaning of each character.

Description of the Last Six Characters in a Card Name


MPU

Figure 7-2 and Table 7-1 explain the last six characters in an MPU name.

Figure 7-2 Last six characters in an MPU name

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12

d
c
b
a

Table 7-1 Description of the last six characters in an MPU name

ID Description

d1 MPU type:
l MCU: Main Control Unit of the S9703
l SRU: Switching and Routing Unit of the
S9706 and S9712

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 110


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

ID Description

d2 l For MCUs, this character is assigned in


alphabetical order to identify MCU
types.
l For SRUs, this character represents the
switching capacity.

d3 Extended attribute. The letter C means that


the MPU has a clock daughter card. This
character is 0 by default.

d4 A number that identifies the MPU type. The


number is assigned to different types of
MPUs in ascending order from 00 to 99.

Single-interface LPU
A single-interface LPU provides only one type of interfaces. For example, an
EH1D2X12SSA0 card provides only 10GE BASE-SFP+ optical interfaces.
Figure 7-3 and Table 7-2 explain the last six characters in the name of a single-interface
LPU.

Figure 7-3 Last six characters in the name of a single-interface LPU

6 7 8 9 10 11 12

d6
d5
d4
d3
d2
d1

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 111


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-2 Description of the last six characters in the name of a single-interface LPU
ID Description

d1 Interface speed:
l F: 100M interface
l G: GE interface
l X: 10GE interface
l L: 40GE interface
l C: 100GE interface

d2 Number of interfaces on the LPU. The value


ranges from 00 to 99.

d3 Interface type:
l T: electrical interface
l S: SFP/SFP+ optical interface
l X: XFP optical interface
l Q: QSFP+ optical interface

d4 Card series:
l S: standard series. This series does not
support MPLS or extension of table
entries.
l F: common series. This series supports
MPLS but does not support extension of
table entries.
l E: enhanced series. This series supports
MPLS and extension of routing, ACL,
and MAC address entries.
l B: large buffer series. This series has a
large buffer and supports MPLS and
extension of routing, ACL, and MAC
address entries.
l X: X series. This series provides
programmability, and supports MPLS
and extension of routing, ACL, and
MAC address entries.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 112


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

ID Description

d5 When d4 is X, this field indicates the


generation programmable card.
When d4 is not X, this field indicates the
MAC table capacity of the card:
l A: a maximum of 32K MAC address
entries and 32K FIB entries
l C: a maximum of 128K MAC address
entries and 128K FIB entries
l D: a maximum of 512K MAC address
entries and 512K FIB entries
l E: a maximum of 1M MAC address
entries and 1M FIB entries

d6 When d4 is X, this field indicates the


configuration level:
l L: lightweight configuration
l S: standard configuration
l E: enhanced configuration
l H: high-level configuration
When d4 is not X, this field is a number that
identifies the LPU type. Numbers 0 to 9 are
assigned to different LPU types in
ascending order.

Multi-interface LPU
A multi-interface LPU provides interfaces of two or more types. For example, an
EH1D2T24XEA0 card provides 10GE BASE-XFP interfaces and 10M/100M/1000M BASE-
T interfaces. The interface type with the largest number of interfaces is the major interface
type, and the other interfaces are minor interfaces.
Figure 7-4 and Table 7-3 explain the last six characters in the name of a multi-interface LPU.

Figure 7-4 Last six characters in the name of a multi-interface LPU

6 7 8 9 10 11 12

d6
d5
d4
d3
d2
d1
Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 113
S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-3 Description of the last six characters in the name of a multi-interface LPU
ID Description

d1 Major interface type:


l T: electrical interface
l S: SFP/SFP+ optical interface
l X: XFP optical interface
l Q: QSFP+ optical interface

d2 Number of major interfaces. The value


ranges from 00 to 99.

d3 Minor interface type:


l T: electrical interface
l C: combo interface
l S: SFP/SFP+ optical interface
l X: XFP optical interface

d4 Card series:
l S: standard series. This series does not
support MPLS or extension of table
entries.
l F: common series. This series supports
MPLS but does not support extension of
table entries.
l E: enhanced series. This series supports
MPLS and extension of routing, ACL,
and MAC address entries.
l B: large buffer series. This series has a
large buffer and supports MPLS and
extension of routing, ACL, and MAC
address entries.
l X: X series. This series provides
programmability, and supports MPLS
and extension of routing, ACL, and
MAC address entries.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 114


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

ID Description

d5 When d4 is X, this field indicates the first


generation programmable card.
When d4 is not X, this field indicates the
MAC table capacity of the card:
l A: a maximum of 32K MAC address
entries and 32K FIB entries
l C: a maximum of 128K MAC address
entries and 128K FIB entries
l D: a maximum of 512K MAC address
entries and 512K FIB entries
l E: a maximum of 1M MAC address
entries and 1M FIB entries

d6 When d4 is X, this field indicates the


configuration level:
l L: lightweight configuration
l S: standard configuration
l E: enhanced configuration
l H: high-level configuration
When d4 is not X, this field is a number that
identifies the LPU type. Numbers 0 to 9 are
assigned to different LPU types in
ascending order.

Flexible service unit


Figure 7-5 and Table 7-4 explain the last six characters in a flexible service unit name.

Figure 7-5 Last six characters in a flexible service unit name

6 7 8 9 10 11 12

d4
d3
d2
d1

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 115


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-4 Description of the last six characters in a flexible service unit name
ID Description

d1 Card type. VS represents a CSS card with


SFP+ optical interfaces.

d2 Number of interfaces on the flexible service


unit. The value ranges from 00 to 99.

d3 Extended attributes. The default value is 0.

d4 A number that identifies the flexible service


unit type. The number is assigned to
different types of flexible service units in
ascending order from 00 to 99.

Value-added service card

Figure 7-6 and Table 7-5 explain the last six characters in a value-added card name.

Figure 7-6 Last six characters in a value-added card name

6 7 8 9 10 11 12

d4
d3
d2
d1
Table 7-5 Description of the last six characters in a value-added card name
ID Description

d1 Card type:
l VA: Value-added service unit
l PS: open service platform unit

d2 Reserved for function expansion. The


default value is 00.

d3 Card series. The value P represents value-


added service unit and open service
platform unit.

d4 A number that identifies the value-added


card type. The number is assigned to
different types of value-added cards in
ascending order from 00 to 99.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 116


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

CMU and clock daughter card

Figure 7-7 and Table 7-6 explain the last six characters in names of the CMU and clock
daughter card.

Figure 7-7 Last six characters in names of the CMU and clock daughter card

6 7 8 9 10 11 12

d3
d2
d1
Table 7-6 Description of the last six characters in names of the CMU and clock daughter card
ID Description

d1 Card type:
l CMU: Centralized Monitoring Unit
l CKM: clock daughter card

d2 Extended attributes. The default value is 00.

d3 A number that identifies the card type. The


number is assigned to different types of
cards in ascending order from 00 to 99.

7.2 Card Types


The following describe the different types of Line Processing Units (LPUs):
l The S series includes SA and SC interface cards, for example, 24-port 100M/1000M
BASE-X interface card (SA, SFP).
l The E series includes EA, EC, ED, and EE interface cards, for example, 48-port 100M
BASE-X interface card (EA, SFP).
l The F series includes FA and FC interface cards, for example, 48-port 1000M BASE-T
interface card (FA, RJ45).
l The B series has BC interface cards, for example, 48-port 100M/1000M BASE-X
interface card (BC, SFP).
l The X series includes X1E, X2E, X2S, X2H, X5E, X5H, and X5S interface cards, for
example, 48-port 10/100/1000BASE-T interface card (X1E, RJ45).
l The POS interface cards include a WAN interface service processing card and its
subcards P4CF, P4HF, and P1UF.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 117


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

l All the S9700 cards comply with the FCC standards except the EH1D2SRUDC00,
EH1D2X02XEA0, EH1D2X02XEC0, EH1D2X04XEA0, EH1D2X04XEC0,
EH1D2X04XED0, EH1D2X12SSA0, and EH1D2X08SED4.
l The FCC-certified cards must be used with the FCC-certified chassis.
Table 7-7 lists the cards supported by the S9700.

NOTE

The cards supported by a switch depend on the software version. For details, see Hardware Query Tool.

Table 7-7 Cards supported by the S9700


Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part
Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

Main EH1D2S S9706/ - S9703 chassis: not 132 W 3.30 03021


control RUC000 S9712 supported (inclu kg UWG
unit Main S9706 and S9712 ding (7.28
Control chassis: supported subcar lb)
Unit C in V200R003C00 ds)
(optional to V200R013C00
clock)

Main EH1D2S S9706/ - S9703 chassis: not 180 W 2.90 03030


control RUDC0 S9712 supported (inclu kg NXR
unit 0 Main S9706 and S9712 ding (6.39
Control chassis: supported subcar lb)
Unit D in V200R001C00 ds)
(optional to V200R013C00
clock)

Main EH1D2S S9706/ - S9703 chassis: not 180 W 2.90 03030


control RUDC0 S9712 supported (inclu kg PHA
unit 1 Main S9706 and S9712 ding (6.39
Control chassis: supported subcar lb)
Unit D in V200R001C00 ds)
(optional to V200R013C00
clock) -
FCC

Main EH1D2 Main - S9703 chassis: 26 W 0.92 03030


control MCUAC Control supported in (inclu kg NWA
unit 00 Unit A V200R001C00 to ding (2.03
(optional V200R013C00 subcar lb)
clock) S9706 and S9712 ds)
chassis: not
supported

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 118


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

Subcard LE0D00 Clock - Supported in 6W 0.10 03020


on the CKMA0 Pinch V200R001C00 to kg PPT
main 0 Board V200R013C00 (0.22
control lb)
unit

Subcard EH1D2 8-port - S9703 chassis: not 30 W 0.50 03021


on the VS0800 10G supported kg UWH
main 0 Cluster S9706 and S9712 (1.10
control Switchin chassis: supported lb)
unit g System in V200R003C00
Service to V200R013C00
Unit
(SFP+)

Monitori EH1D20 Centraliz - S9703 chassis: not 1W 0.22 03030


ng unit 0CMU0 ed supported kg NWB
0 Monitori S9706 and S9712 (0.48
ng Unit chassis: supported lb)
in V200R001C00
to V200R013C00

Value- LE0D0V Value- - This module is 120 W 3.10 03020


added AMPA0 added supported in kg RRN
service 0 service V200R001C00 to (6.83
card card V200R008C00 lb)
(except in
V200R007C10).

OSPU EH1D2P Open - This module is 137.5 5.50 03021


S00P00 Service supported in W kg PHK
Platform V200R002C00 to (12.13
Unit V200R013C00 lb)
(except in
V200R007C10).

100M EH1D2F 48-port EA Supported in 59 W 2.50 03030


interface 48TEA0 10/100B V200R001C00 to kg NWP
card ASE-T V200R013C00 (5.51
interface lb)
card
(EA,
RJ45)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 119


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

100M EH1D2F 48-port EC Supported in 70 W 2.62 03030


interface 48TEC0 10/100B V200R001C00 to kg NWQ
card ASE-T V200R013C00 (5.78
interface lb)
card
(EC,
RJ45)

100M EH1D2F 48-Port FA Supported only in 40 W 2.30 03030


interface 48TFA0 10/100B V200R001C00, kg NXF
card ASE-T V200R002C00, and (5.07
Interface V200R003C00 lb)
Card
(FA,
RJ45)

100M EH1D2F 48-port EA Supported in 64 W 2.54 03030


interface 48SEA0 100BAS V200R001C00 to kg NWJ
card E-X V200R013C00 (5.60
interface lb)
card
(EA,
SFP)

100M EH1D2F 48-port EC Supported in 76 W 2.66 03030


interface 48SEC0 100BAS V200R001C00 to kg NWK
card E-X V200R013C00 (5.86
interface lb)
card
(EC,
SFP)

1000M EH1D2 24-Port SA Supported only in 45 W 2.22 03030


interface G24SSA 100/100 V200R001C00, kg NWV
card 0 0BASE- V200R002C00, and (4.89
X V200R003C00 lb)
Interface
Card
(SA,
SFP)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 120


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

1000M EH1D2 24-port EC Supported in 63 W 2.66 03030


interface G24SEC 100/100 V200R001C00 to kg NWG
card 0 0BASE- V200R013C00 (5.86
X lb)
interface
card
(EC,
SFP)

1000M EH1D2 24-port ED Supported in 75 W 2.66 03030


interface G24SED 100/100 V200R001C00 to kg NWH
card 0 0BASE- V200R013C00 (5.86
X lb)
interface
card
(ED,
SFP)

1000M ET1D2G 24-Port X5E Supported only in 84 W 2.82 03032


interface 24SX5E 100/100 V200R013C00 kg YEB
card 0BASE- (6.22
X lb)
Interface
Card
(X5E,
SFP)

1000M EH1D2S 24-Port SA Supported only in 67 W 2.26 03030


interface 24CSA0 100/100 V200R001C00, kg NWW
card 0BASE- V200R002C00, and (5.86
X and 8- V200R003C00 lb)
Port
10/100/1
000BAS
E-T
Combo
Interface
Card
(SA,
SFP/
RJ45)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 121


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

1000M EH1D2S 24-port EA Supported in 70 W 2.70 03030


interface 24CEA0 100/100 V200R001C00 to kg NXD
card 0BASE- V200R013C00 (5.95
X and 8- lb)
port
10/100/1
000BAS
E-T
combo
interface
card
(EA,
SFP/
RJ45)

1000M EH1D2T 36-port EA Supported in 62 W 2.50 03030


interface 36SEA0 10/100/1 V200R001C00 to kg NXE
card 000BAS V200R013C00 (5.51
E-T and lb)
12-port
100/100
0BASE-
X
interface
card
(EA,
RJ45/
SFP)

1000M EH1D2 24-port FA Supported in 32 W 2.20 03030


interface G24TFA 10/100/1 V200R001C00 to kg NXL
card 0 000BAS V200R013C00 (4.85
E-T lb)
interface
card
(FA,
RJ45)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 122


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

1000M EH1D2 48-port EA Supported in 62 W 2.50 03030


interface G48TEA 10/100/1 V200R001C00 to kg NWL
card 0 000BAS V200R013C00 (5.51
E-T lb)
interface
card
(EA,
RJ45)

1000M EH1D2 48-port EC Supported in 68 W 2.62 03030


interface G48TEC 10/100/1 V200R001C00 to kg NWM
card 0 000BAS V200R013C00 (5.78
E-T lb)
interface
card
(EC,
RJ45)

1000M EH1D2 48-port ED Supported in 98 W 2.62 03030


interface G48TED 10/100/1 V200R001C00 to kg NWN
card 0 000BAS V200R013C00 (5.78
E-T lb)
interface
card
(ED,
RJ45)

1000M EH1D2 48-port FA Supported in 48 W 2.50 03030


interface G48TFA 10/100/1 V200R001C00 to kg NXH
card 0 000BAS V200R013C00 (5.51
E-T lb)
interface
card
(FA,
RJ45)

1000M EH1D2 48-port X1E Supported in 120 W 2.92 03030


interface G48TX1 10/100/1 V200R005C00 to kg RPK
card E 000BAS V200R013C00 (6.44
E-T lb)
interface
card
(X1E,
RJ45)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 123


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

1000M EH1D2 48-port BC Supported in 160 W 2.90 03030


interface G48TBC 10/100/1 V200R001C00 to kg NXK
card 0 000BAS V200R013C00 (6.39
E-T lb)
interface
card
(BC,
RJ45)

1000M ET1D2G 48-port X5E Supported only in 60 W 3.06 03032


interface 48TX5E 100/100 V200R013C00 kg WSL
card 0BASE- (6.75
T lb)
interface
card
(X5E,
RJ45)

1000M ET1D2G 48-port X5H Supported only in 107 W 3.3 kg 03032


interface 48TX5H 100/100 V200R013C00 (7.28 WSK
card 0BASE- lb)
T
interface
card
(X5H,
RJ45)

1000M ET1D2G 48-port X5S Supported only in 60 W 3.06 03032


interface 48TX5S 100/100 V200R013C00 kg WSG
card 0BASE- (6.75
T lb)
interface
card
(X5S,
RJ45)

1000M EH1D2 48-port EA Supported in 75 W 2.54 03030


interface G48SEA 100/100 V200R001C00 to kg NWD
card 0 0BASE- V200R013C00 (5.60
X lb)
interface
card
(EA,
SFP)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 124


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

1000M EH1D2 48-port EC Supported in 92 W 2.66 03030


interface G48SEC 100/100 V200R001C00 to kg NWE
card 0 0BASE- V200R013C00 (5.86
X lb)
interface
card
(EC,
SFP)

1000M EH1D2 48-port ED Supported in 110 W 2.66 03030


interface G48SED 100/100 V200R001C00 to kg NWF
card 0 0BASE- V200R013C00 (5.86
X lb)
interface
card
(ED,
SFP)

1000M EH1D2 48-port FA Supported in 65 W 2.60 03030


interface G48SFA 100/100 V200R001C00 to kg NXG
card 0 0BASE- V200R013C00 (5.73
X lb)
interface
card
(FA,
SFP)

1000M EH1D2 48-port BC Supported in 185 W 2.90 03030


interface G48SBC 100/100 V200R001C00 to kg NXJ
card 0 0BASE- V200R013C00 (6.39
X lb)
interface
card
(BC,
SFP)

1000M EH1D2 48-port X1E Supported in 140 W 3.04 03030


interface G48SX1 100/100 V200R005C00 to kg RPJ
card E 0BASE- V200R013C00 (6.70
X lb)
interface
card
(X1E,
SFP)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 125


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

1000M ET1D2G 48-Port EA Supported only in 62W 2.50kg 03030


interface 48TEA0 10/100/1 V200R012C00 and SGN
card 000BAS V200R013C00
E-T
Interface
Card
(EA,
RJ45)

1000M ET1D2T 36-Port EA Supported only in 62W 2.50kg 03030


interface 36SEA0 10/100/1 V200R012C00 and SGX
card 000BAS V200R013C00
E-T and
12-Port
100/100
0BASE-
X
Interface
Card
(EA,
RJ45/
SFP)

1000M ET1D2G 48-Port EA Supported only in 75W 2.54kg 03030


interface 48SEA0 100/100 V200R012C00 and SGH
card 0BASE- V200R013C00
X
Interface
Card
(EA,
SFP)

1000M ET1D2G 24-Port EC Supported only in 63W 2.66kg 03030


interface 24SEC0 100/100 V200R012C00 and SGL
card 0BASE- V200R013C00
X
Interface
Card
(EC,
SFP)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 126


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

1000M ET1D2G 48-Port EC Supported only in 68W 2.66kg 03030


interface 48TEC0 10/100/1 V200R012C00 and SGP
card 000BAS V200R013C00
E-T
Interface
Card
(EC,
RJ45)

1000M ET1D2G 48-Port EC Supported only in 92W 2.66kg 03030


interface 48SEC0 100/100 V200R012C00 and SGJ
card 0BASE- V200R013C00
X
Interface
Card
(EC,
SFP)

1000M ET1D2G 48-Port X1E Supported only in 140W 3.04kg 03030


interface 48SX1E 100/100 V200R012C00 and SGD
card 0BASE- V200R013C00
X
Interface
Card
(X1E,
SFP)

1000M ET1D2G 48-Port X1E Supported only in 120W 2.92kg 03030


interface 48TX1E 10/100/1 V200R012C00 and SGE
card 000BAS V200R013C00
E-T
Interface
Card
(X1E,
RJ45)

1000M ET1D2G 48-Port X5E Supported only in 110 W 3.1 kg 03032


interface 48SX5E 100/100 V200R013C00 (6.83 WSU
card 0BASE- lb)
X
Interface
Card
(X5E,
SFP)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 127


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

1000M ET1D2G 48-Port X5H Supported only in 162 W 3.3 kg 03032


interface 48SX5H 100/100 V200R013C00 (7.28 WSX
card 0BASE- lb)
X
Interface
Card
(X5H,
SFP)

1000M ET1D2G 48-Port X5S Supported only in 110 W 3.1 kg 03032


interface 48SX5S 100/100 V200R013C00 (6.83 WSS
card 0BASE- lb)
X
Interface
Card
(X5S,
SFP)

GE/ EH1D2T 24-port EA Supported in 53 W 2.30 03030


10GE 24XEA0 10/100/1 V200R001C00 to kg NWY
interface 000BAS V200R013C00 (5.07
card E-T and lb)
2-port
10GBAS
E-X
interface
card
(EA,
RJ45/
XFP)

GE/ EH1D2S 24-port EA Supported in 65 W 2.40 03030


10GE 24XEA0 100/100 V200R001C00 to kg NXA
interface 0BASE- V200R013C00 (5.29
card X and 2- lb)
port
10GBAS
E-X
interface
card
(EA,
SFP/
XFP)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 128


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

GE/ EH1D2S 24-port EC Supported in 81 W 2.50 03030


10GE 24XEC0 100/100 V200R001C00 to kg NXN
interface 0BASE- V200R013C00 (5.51
card X and 2- lb)
port
10GBAS
E-X
interface
card
(EC,
SFP/
XFP)

GE/ EH1D2S 4-port X1E Supported in 130 W 2.88 03030


10GE 04SX1E 10GBAS V200R005C00 to kg RPL
interface E-X and V200R013C00 (6.35
card 24-port lb)
100/100
0BASE-
X and 8-
port
10/100/1
000BAS
E-T
combo
interface
card
(X1E,
RJ45/SF
P/SFP+)

GE/ ET1D2S 4-port X5E Supported only in 124 W 3.1 kg 03032


10GE 04SX5E 10GE V200R013C00 (6.83 YEA
interface SFP+ lb)
card and 44-
port GE
SFP
interface
card
(X5E,
SFP+)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 129


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

GE/ EH1D2S 8-port X1E Supported in 130 W 2.84 03030


10GE 08SX1E 10GBAS V200R005C00 to kg RPM
interface E-X and V200R013C00 (6.26
card 8-port lb)
100/100
0BASE-
X and 8-
port
10/100/1
000BAS
E-T
combo
interface
card
(X1E,
RJ45/SF
P/SFP+)

GE/ ET1D2S 24-Port X2E Supported in 201.8 3.3 kg 03031


10GE 24SX2E 10GE V200R010C00 to W (7.28 YGJ
interface SFP+ V200R013C00 lb)
card Interface
and 8-
Port GE
SFP
Interface
Card
(X2E,
SFP+)

GE/ ET1D2S 24-Port X2S Supported in 192.3 3.2 kg 03031


10GE 24SX2S 10GE V200R010C00 to W (7.05 YGG
interface SFP+ V200R013C00 lb)
card Interface
and 8-
Port GE
SFP
Interface
Card
(X2S,
SFP+)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 130


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

GE/ ET1D2S 16-Port X2E Supported in 192.4 3.3 kg 03031


10GE 16SX2E 10GE V200R010C00 to W (7.28 YGL
interface SFP+ V200R013C00 lb)
card Interface
and 16-
Port GE
SFP
Interface
Card
(X2E,
SFP+)

GE/ ET1D2S 16-Port X2S Supported in 182.4 3.2 kg 03031


10GE 16SX2S 10GE V200R010C00 to W (7.05 YGK
interface SFP+ V200R013C00 lb)
card Interface
and 16-
Port GE
SFP
Interface
Card
(X2S,
SFP+)

GE/ ET1D2S 4-Port X1E Supported only in 130 W 2.88 03030


10GE 04SX1E 10GBAS V200R012C00 and kg SGF
interface E-X and V200R013C00
card 24-Port
100/100
0BASE-
X and 8-
Port
10/100/1
000BAS
E-T
Combo
Interface
Card
(X1E,
RJ45/SF
P/SFP+)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 131


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

GE/ ET1D2S 8-Port X1E Supported only in 130 W 2.84 03030


10GE 08SX1E 10GBAS V200R012C00 and kg SGG
interface E-X and V200R013C00
card 8-Port
100/100
0BASE-
X and 8-
Port
10/100/1
000BAS
E-T
Combo
Interface
Card
(X1E,
RJ45/SF
P/SFP+)

10GE EH1D2 2-port EA Supported in 52 W 2.14 03030


interface X02XE 10GBAS V200R001C00 to kg NWT
card A0 E-X V200R013C00 (4.72
interface lb)
card
(EA,
XFP)

10GE EH1D2 2-port EC Supported in 61 W 2.26 03030


interface X02XE 10GBAS V200R001C00 to kg NWU
card C0 E-X V200R013C00 (4.98
interface lb)
card
(EC,
XFP)

10GE EH1D2 2-port EC Supported in 61 W 2.26 03030


interface X02XE 10GBAS V200R003C00 to kg RCU
card C1 E-X V200R013C00 (4.98
interface lb)
card
(EC,
XFP),
FCC

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 132


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

10GE EH1D2 4-port EA Supported in 64 W 2.16 03030


interface X04XE 10GBAS V200R001C00 to kg NWR
card A0 E-X V200R013C00 (4.76
interface lb)
card
(EA,
XFP)

10GE EH1D2 4-port EC Supported in 75 W 2.28 03030


interface X04XE 10GBAS V200R001C00 to kg NWS
card C0 E-X V200R013C00 (5.03
interface lb)
card
(EC,
XFP)

10GE EH1D2 4-port EC Supported in 75 W 2.28 03030


interface X04XE 10GBAS V200R003C00 to kg RCW
card C1 E-X V200R013C00 (5.03
interface lb)
card
(EC,
XFP),
FCC

10GE EH1D2 4-port ED Supported in 93 W 2.30 03030


interface X04XE 10GBAS V200R001C00 to kg NXC
card D0 E-X V200R013C00 (5.07
interface lb)
card
(ED,
XFP)

10GE EH1D2 8-port ED Supported in 198.1 2.50 03021


interface X08SED 10GBAS V200R002C00 to W kg TJE
card 4 E-X V200R013C00 (5.51
interface lb)
card
(ED,
SFP+)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 133


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

10GE EH1D2 8-port ED Supported in 198.1 2.50 03021


interface X08SED 10GBAS V200R002C00 to W kg TJF
card 5 E-X V200R013C00 (5.51
interface lb)
card
(ED,
SFP+)

10GE ET1D2X 8-Port X5E Supported only in 78 W 2.7 kg 03032


interface 08SX5E 10GBAS V200R013C00 (5.95 WTF
card E-X lb)
Interface
Card
(X5E,
SFP+)

10GE ET1D2X 8-Port X5H Supported only in 130 W 2.94 03032


interface 08SX5H 10GBAS V200R013C00 kg WTH
card E-X (6.48
Interface lb)
Card
(X5H,
SFP+)

10GE EH1D2 12-port SA Supported in 85 W 2.30 03030


interface X12SSA 10GBAS V200R001C00 to kg NWX
card 0 E-X V200R013C00 (5.07
interface lb)
card
(SA,
SFP+)

10GE EH1D2 16-port FC Supported in 150 W 2.60 03030


interface X16SFC 10GBAS V200R001C00 to kg NXP
card 0 E-X V200R013C00 (5.73
interface lb)
card
(FC,
SFP+)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 134


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

10GE EH1D2 16-port SC Supported in 131 W 2.80 03031


interface X16SSC 10GBAS V200R008C00 to kg HGP
card 2 E-X V200R013C00 (6.17
interface lb)
card
(SC,
SFP+)

10GE EH1D2 32-port SC Supported in 207 W 3.02 03031


interface X32SSC 10GBAS V200R008C00 to kg FSP
card 0 E-X V200R013C00 (6.66
interface lb)
card
(SC,
SFP+)

10GE ET1D2X 32-Port X2E Supported in 213.7 3.3 kg 03031


interface 32SX2E 10GBAS V200R010C00 to W (7.28 WHS
card E-X V200R013C00 lb)
Interface
Card
(X2E,
SFP+)

10GE ET1D2X 32-Port X2S Supported in 203.3 3.2 kg 03031


interface 32SX2S 10GBAS V200R010C00 to W (7.05 YGE
card E-X V200R013C00 lb)
Interface
Card
(X2S,
SFP+)

10GE ET1D2X 32-Port X2H Supported in 214.9 3.3 kg 03032


interface 32SX2H 10GBAS V200R010C00 to W (7.28 AUQ
card E-X V200R013C00 lb)
Interface
Card
(X2H,
SFP+)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 135


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

10GE EH1D2 40-port FC Supported in 183 W 2.90 03030


interface X40SFC 10GBAS V200R001C00 to kg NXM
card 0 E-X V200R013C00 (6.39
interface lb)
card
(FC,
SFP+)

10GE EH1D2 48-port EC Supported in 300 W 3.42 03030


interface X48SEC 10GBAS V200R005C00 to kg RPH
card 0 E-X V200R013C00 (7.54
interface lb)
card
(EC,
SFP+)

10GE ET1D2X 48-Port X2S Supported in 258.1 3.4 kg 03031


interface 48SX2S 10GBAS V200R010C00 to W (7.50 WJA
card E-X V200R013C00 lb)
Interface
Card
(X2S,
SFP+)

10GE ET1D2X 12-Port SA Supported only in 85W 2.30kg 03030


interface 12SSA0 10GBAS V200R012C00 and SGY
card * E-X V200R013C00
Interface
Card
(SA,
SFP+)

10GE ET1D2X 32-Port SC Supported only in 207W 3.02kg 03031


interface 32SSC0* 10GBAS V200R012C00 and FSM
card E-X V200R013C00
Interface
Card
(SC,
SFP+)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 136


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

10GE ET1D2X 16-Port SC Supported only in 131W 2.80kg 03031


interface 16SSC2* 10GBAS V200R012C00 and HGN
card E-X V200R013C00
Interface
Card
(SC,
SFP+)

10GE ET1D2X 16-Port SC Supported only in 150W 2.60kg 03030


interface 16SSC0* 10GBAS V200R012C00 and SHB
card E-X V200R013C00
Interface
Card
(SC,
SFP+)

10GE ET1D2X 4-Port EA Supported only in 64W 2.16kg 03030


interface 04XEA0 10GBAS V200R012C00 and SGR
card * E-X V200R013C00
Interface
Card
(EA,
XFP)

10GE ET1D2X 4-Port EC Supported only in 75W 2.28kg 03030


interface 04XEC1 10GBAS V200R012C00 and SGS
card * E-X V200R013C00
Interface
Card
(EC,
XFP)

10GE ET1D2X 48-Port EC Supported only in 300W 3.42kg 03030


interface 48SEC0 10GBAS V200R012C00 and SGC
card * E-X V200R013C00
Interface
Card
(EC,
SFP+)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 137


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

40GE EH1D2L 2-port FC Supported in 88 W 2.50 03021


interface 02QFC0 40GBAS V200R002C00 to kg RNK
card E-X V200R013C00 (5.51
optical lb)
interface
card
(FC,
QSFP+)

40GE EH1D2L 8-port FC Supported in 157.2 2.80 03021


interface 08QFC0 40GBAS V200R002C00 to W kg PHM
card E-X V200R013C00 (6.17
interface lb)
card
(FC,
QSFP+)

40GE EH1D2L 8-Port X2E Supported in 178.4 3.0 kg 03031


interface 08QX2E 40GBAS V200R010C00 to W (6.61 WAS
card E-X V200R013C00 lb)
Interface
Card
(X2E,
QSFP+)

40GE ET1D2L 2-Port SC Supported only in 88W 2.50kg 03030


interface 02QSC0 40GBAS V200R012C00 and SHE
card E-X V200R013C00
Interface
Card
(SC,
QSFP+)

40GE ET1D2L 8-Port SC Supported only in 157.2 2.80kg 03030


interface 08QSC0 40GBAS V200R012C00 and W SHF
card E-X V200R013C00
Interface
Card
(SC,
QSFP+)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 138


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

40GE/ ET1D2H 2-Port X2S Supported in 143.5 3.05 03031


100GE 02QX2S 100GE V200R010C00 to W kg YGC
interface QSFP28 V200R013C00 (6.72
card Interface lb)
and 2-
Port
40GE
QSFP+
Interface
Card
(X2S,
QSFP28
)

40GE/ ET1D2H 2-Port X2E Supported in 153.1 3.15 03031


100GE 02QX2E 100GE V200R010C00 to W kg YGD
interface QSFP28 V200R013C00 (6.94
card Interface lb)
and 2-
Port
40GE
QSFP+
Interface
Card
(X2E,
QSFP28
)

100GE EH1D2 2-port EE Supported in 339 W 4.20 03030


interface C02FEE 100GBA V200R008C00 to kg RYF
card 0 SE-X V200R013C00 (9.26
interface lb)
card
(EE,
CFP)

100GE ET1D2C 4-Port X2E Supported in 164.8 3.15 03031


interface 04HX2E 100GE V200R010C00 to W kg YET
card QSFP28 V200R013C00 (6.94
Interface lb)
Card
(X2E,
QSFP28
)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 139


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

100GE ET1D2C 4-Port X2S Supported in 154.7 3.05 03031


interface 04HX2S 100GE V200R010C00 to W kg WHR
card QSFP28 V200R013C00 (6.72
Interface lb)
Card
(X2S,
QSFP28
)

100GE ET1D2C 2-Port EE Supported only in 339W 4.20kg 03030


interface 02FEE0 100GBA V200R012C00 and WVE
card SE-X V200R013C00
Interface
Card
(EE,
CFP)

POS EH1D2 WAN - Supported only in l Wi 3.80 -


interface WM000 interface V200R001C00, th kg
card 00 service V200R002C00, and tw (8.38
processi V200R003C00 o lb)
ng card P1 (with a
UF firepro
s: of
84 panel
W and
l Wi two
th P1UFs
tw )
o
P4
HF
s:
91
W
l Wi
th
tw
o
P4
CF
s:
86
W

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 140


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

POS P1UF 1-port - Supported only in 12 W 0.50 -


interface OC-48c/ V200R001C00, kg
card STM-16 V200R002C00, and (1.10
c POS- V200R003C00 lb)
SFP
flexible
card
(installe
d on a
WAN
interface
service
processi
ng card)

POS P4HF 4-port - Supported only in 15 W 0.50 -


interface OC-12c/ V200R001C00, kg
card STM-4c V200R002C00, and (1.10
POS- V200R003C00 lb)
SFP
flexible
card
(installe
d on a
WAN
interface
service
processi
ng card)

POS P4CF 4-port - Supported only in 14 W 0.50 -


interface OC-3c/ V200R001C00, kg
card STM-1c V200R002C00, and (1.10
POS- V200R003C00 lb)
SFP
flexible
card
(installe
d on a
WAN
interface
service
processi
ng card)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 141


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

ACU2 ACU2 WLAN - Supported in - - -


module NOTE ACU2 V200R005C00 to
This Access V200R013C00
module Controll
is er Unit
support
(128 AP
ed in
V200R Control
005C00 Resourc
to e
V200R Included
013C00 )
(except
in NOTE
V200R For
007C10 details,
). see
manual
s of the
ACU2
card.

Firewall ET1D2F NGFW - Supported in - - -


module W00S00 module V200R005C00 to
NOTE A, with V200R013C00
This HW
module general
is security
support
platform
ed in
V200R software
005C00 NOTE
to For
V200R details,
013C00 see
(except manual
in s of the
V200R NGFW
007C10 card.
).

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 142


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

Firewall ET1D2F NGFW - Supported in - - -


module W00S01 module V200R005C00 to
NOTE B, with V200R013C00
This HW
module general
is security
support
platform
ed in
V200R software
005C00 NOTE
to For
V200R details,
013C00 see
(except manual
in s of the
V200R NGFW
007C10 card.
).

Firewall ET1D2F NGFW - Supported in - - -


module W00S02 Module V200R005C00 to
NOTE C, with V200R013C00
This HW
module General
is Security
support
Platform
ed in
V200R Software
005C00 NOTE
to For
V200R details,
013C00 see
(except manual
in s of the
V200R NGFW
007C10 card.
).

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 143


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Card Card Car Supported Maxi Weig Part


Type Name Descrip d Version mum ht Num
tion Seri Powe ber
es r
Cons
umpt
ion

IPS ET1D2I IPS - Supported in - - -


module PS0S00 module V200R005C00 to
NOTE A, with V200R013C00
This HW
module general
is security
support
platform
ed in
V200R software
005C00 NOTE
to For
V200R details,
013C00 see
(except manual
in s of the
V200R IPS
007C10 card.
).

7.3 Card Structure and Dimensions

Card Structure
Figure 7-8 shows an example of a card.

Figure 7-8 Card


9 8 7

1 2 3 4 5 6

1. Name label 2. Ejector lever 3. Front panel plate

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 144


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

4. Port 5. Button 6. Indicator

7. Clock daughter card slot 8. Printed circuit board (PCB) 9. Positioning pin

A card consists of the following components:

l PCB
The PCB contains all the functional chips and is the core of the card. The PCB provides
indicators, buttons, and ports on the front panel. PCBs of some cards provide a clock
daughter card slot.
NOTE

Indicators, buttons, and ports on a card vary depending on the card model. Some cards support clock
daughter cards, while others do not. For details, see the description of specific cards.
l Front panel, made of the following parts:
– Captive screws: fix the card into the chassis.
– Ejector levers: allow you to insert and remove the card.
– Plate: connects the ejector levers and PCB to the panel. Some labels are attached on
the plate.

Card Dimensions
Figure 7-9 shows how the dimensions (width, depth, and height) of a card are defined.

Figure 7-9 Card dimensions

*KVZN

RUN/ALM

46 47
44 75
42 43
40 41
38 39
36 37
34 35
32 33
30 31
28 29
26 27
24 25
22 23
20 21
18 19
16 17
14 15
12 13

.KOMNZ
10 11
8 9
6 7
4 5
2 3
1

=OJZN

Table 7-8 Card dimensions


Card Type Dimensions (W x D x H)

MCU 194.5 mm x 426.8 mm x 19.9 mm (7.66 in. x 16.80 in.


x 0.78 in.)

SRU 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.54 in. x 16.80


in. x 1.38 in.)

CMU 112.9 mm x 412.7 mm x 19.8 mm (4.44 in. x 16.25 in.


x 0.78 in.)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 145


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Card Type Dimensions (W x D x H)

LPU 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.54 in. x 16.80


in. x 1.38 in.)

CKM 100.0 mm x 145.0 mm x 2.0 mm (9.94 in. x 5.71 in. x


0.08 in.)

VSU 213.0 mm x 151.8 mm x 35.1 mm (8.39 in. x 5.98 in.


x 1.38 in.)

NOTE

The card dimensions are defined as follows:


l Depth: the distance between the outer edge of an ejector lever and the end of the PCB
l Width: the longest distance between the outer edges of two ejector levers
l Height: the height of the front panel

7.4 Interface Numbering

Physical Interface Numbering Rules


Physical interfaces are numbered in the following way:
A single switch uses slot ID/subcard ID/interface ID to identify physical interfaces.
A CSS switch uses frame ID/slot ID/subcard ID/interface ID to identify physical interfaces.
l Frame ID: indicates the ID of a switch in the CSS. The value is 1 or 2.
l Slot ID: indicates the number of the slot where a card is located.
l Subcard ID: indicates the ID of a subcard.
l Interface sequence number: indicates the sequence number of an interface on the card.
Physical interface IDs on LPUs are numbered as follows:
l If there is only one row of interfaces on the panel, the interfaces are numbered from left
to right, starting with 0.

l If there are two rows of interfaces on the panel, the interfaces are numbered from top to
bottom and left to right, starting from 0.

NOTE
If an LPU has interfaces of different speeds, the interfaces of each speed are numbered separately. For
example, an EH1D2S04SX1E card has 10GE and GE interfaces. The 10GE and GE interfaces are both
numbered from left to right, starting from 0.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 146


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

If a card is inserted in slot 3 of a switch, the interface with interface ID 2 (see figures above
for interface ID numbering) is numbered 3/0/2. If the switch is in a CSS and the CSS ID is 1,
the interface is numbered 1/3/0/4.

100GE optical interfaces and some 40GE optical interfaces can be split into multiple
interfaces. The converted interfaces are numbered using the following rules:
l If the 40GE interface is numbered 40GEx/0/n, the four converted 10GE interfaces are
numbered XGEx/1/(4n + z). For example, if a 40GE interface is numbered 40GE1/0/1,
the four converted 10GE interfaces are numbered XGE1/1/4, XGE1/1/5, XGE1/1/6, and
XGE1/1/7.
If a 40GE interface is numbered 40GE x/1/n, the four converted 10GE interfaces are
numbered XGE x/2/(4n + z + 8). For example, if a 40GE interface is numbered
40GE1/1/1, the four converted 10GE interfaces are numbered XGE1/2/12, XGE1/2/13,
XGE1/2/14, and XGE1/2/15.
– x: indicates the slot number of the card.
– n: indicates the sequence number of the 40GE interface. The value starts from 0.
– z: indicates the interface location. The value ranges from 0 to 3.
l After the 100GE interfaces are split, the subcard number and interface sequence number
of converted interfaces are fixed. Table 7-9 describes the numbering rules.

Table 7-9 Numbering rule for interfaces converted from a 100GE interface
100GE Numbers of Numbers of Numbers of Numbers of
Interface Converted Ten Four Four
Number 40GE Converted Converted Converted
Interfaces 10GE 10GE 10GE
(Only Interfaces Interfaces Interfaces
Applicable (Only (Only (Only
to Applicable Applicable Applicable
EH1D2C02F to to to
EE0 Cards) EH1D2C02F ET1D2C04H ET1D2H02Q
EE0 Cards) X2E and X2E and
ET1D2C04H ET1D2H02Q
X2S Cards) X2S Cards)

100GE x/0/0 40GE x/1/0 XGE x/2/0 to XGE x/1/0 to XGE x/2/0 to
40GE x/1/1 XGE x/2/9 XGE x/1/3 XGE x/2/3

100GE x/0/1 40GE x/1/2 XGE x/2/10 to XGE x/1/4 to XGE x/2/4 to
40GE x/1/3 XGE x/2/19 XGE x/1/7 XGE x/2/7

100GE x/0/2 - - XGE x/1/8 to -


XGE x/1/11

100GE x/0/3 - - XGE x/1/12 to -


XGE x/1/15

7.5 Main Control Units and Subcards

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 147


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

NOTE

Main control units of different models cannot be used in the same chassis.

7.5.1 EH1D2SRUC000-S9706/S9712 Main Control Unit C


(Optional Clock)

Version Mapping

Table 7-10 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9703 Chassis S9706 and S9712 Chassis

EH1D2SRUC000 Not supported Supported in V200R003C00


to V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2SRUC000 integrates control and switching functions and provides the control
plane, management plane, and data plane for the system. This card provides a clock daughter
card slot.
An EH1D2SRUC000 card can be installed in:
l Slots 07 and 08 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 13 and 14 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-10 Appearance of the EH1D2SRUC000

Functions
The EH1D2SRUC000 integrates control and switching functions and provides the control
plane, management plane, and data plane, which are described as follows:
l The control plane is responsible for protocol processing, service processing, route
computing, forwarding control, service scheduling, traffic statistics collection, and
system security.
l The management plane is responsible for system status monitoring, environment
monitoring, log and alarm processing, system software loading, and system upgrades.
l The data plane provides high-speed, non-blocking data channels to implement service
switching between service modules.
The EH1D2SRUC000 consists of the following modules:

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 148


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

l Control module: provides the control and management plane for the EH1D2SRUC000
and the entire system, implementing protocol processing, route computing, forwarding
control, system management, and system security.
l Switching module: provides the data plane and high-speed service channels for service
switching.
l Local clock module: provides a working clock for chips of the control module, switching
module, and device management and monitoring module.
l Device management and monitoring module: provides a controller area network bus
(CAN Bus) module to monitor the EH1D2SRUC000 and manage the CAN Bus modules
of LPUs.
l Power supply module: provides power for the EH1D2SRUC000.

Table 7-11 Functions of the EH1D2SRUC000

Function Description

Basic functions The EH1D2SRUC000 is the system control and management unit for
the S9712 and S9706. It integrates the main control unit, clock unit,
switching unit, and system maintenance unit.

Distributed Performs concurrent data forwarding using a distributed data plane.


forwarding

Memory 2 GB

Flash 128 MB

CF card 512 MB by default


By default, the system configuration data, startup files, system software
package, and system logs are saved to the CF card.

CSS The EH1D2SRUC000 can have EH1D2VS08000 installed to provide


the CSS service.

Clock The EH1D2SRUC000 can have LE0D00CKMA00 installed to provide


stratum-3 clock, synchronous Ethernet, and IEEE 1588v2 functions.

Redundancy Supported
backup MPUs are mandatory for switches. You can configure one or two
MPUs for each switch. The MPU can be installed in either MPU slot of
a switch. An MPU consists of the control plane, management plane,
and data forwarding plane. When two MPUs are installed, the two
MPUs work in hot standby mode on the control and management
planes and work in load balancing mode on the data forwarding plane.
MPUs monitor each other. When the active MPU is faulty, the standby
MPU is automatically switched to be the active MPU to ensure service
continuity.

Hot swapping Supported


Before removing the active EH1D2SRUC000 card, perform an active/
standby switchover.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 149


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Usage Constraints

l Main control units of different models cannot be used in the same chassis.
l The two SRUs in the same chassis must be both configured with or without a subcard.
l The fans in a switch work in intelligent speed adjustment mode after a switchover between
the active and standby main control units in the switch. If the fans run at a specified speed
before a switchover, run the set fan-speed command after the switchover to set the fan
speed again.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-11 Indicators and buttons on the EH1D2SRUC000 panel


1 2 3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
CSS ID

SYNC ACT RUN/ALM

RST

CLK1 CLK2 CONSOLE ETH

4 5

Table 7-12 Indicators and buttons on the EH1D2SRUC000 panel

Number Indicator/ Color Description


Button

1 SYNC Green Steady on: The switch supports


time and clock synchronization,
and a clock daughter card is
installed on the SRU.
Off: The switch supports time and
clock synchronization, but no clock
daughter card is installed on the
SRU.

2 CSS ID Green There are eight CSS ID indicators


on the panel, but only one is on at a
time.
l CSS ID N is steady on: The
CSS ID of the local chassis is N.
l All CSS ID indicators are off:
The chassis is not running the
CSS service.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 150


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator/ Color Description


Button

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The switch has a 1600


W DC power module installed or
experiences a card failure. Manual
intervention is required.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.

4 ACT: active/ Green Steady on: The card is the active


standby status SRU.
indicator Off: The card is the standby SRU.
NOTE
When two chassis set up a CSS, the
indicator reads as follows:
Steady on: The card is the active SRU
of the CSS.
Blinking: The card is the hot standby
SRU of the CSS.
Off: The card is the cold standby SRU
of the CSS.

5 RST button - Press this button to reset the card.


NOTE
Resetting an SRU causes service
interruption. Do not press the RST
button unless necessary.

Figure 7-12 Ports on the EH1D2SRUC000 panel


1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
CSS ID

SYNC ACT RUN/ALM

RST

CLK1 CLK2 CONSOLE ETH

1 One subcard slot. EH1D2VS08000 can be installed in this slot.


2 One USB port. In V200R005C00 to V200R013C00, a USB flash drive
can be inserted into this port to load the system software to the switch
during device deployment.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 151


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

3 Two BITS ports. Ports CLK1 and CLK2 on the SRU map ports BITS0
and BITS1 on the clock daughter card. BITS devices or other products
can connect to BITS ports to synchronize the time and clock.
4 One console management port. A configuration terminal can connect to
this port to implement onsite configuration.
5 One ETH management port (10/100BASE-TX auto-sensing). A
configuration terminal or network management workstation can connect
to this port to set up a local or remote configuration environment.

ETH management port


A switch can connect to a configuration terminal or network management workstation
through the ETH management port for onsite or remote configuration. The port must use a 8.6
Ethernet Cable. Table 7-13 describes the attributes of an ETH management port.

Table 7-13 ETH management port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE802.3

Working mode 10/100 Mbit/s auto-sensing


Full-duplex

Maximum transmission distance 100 m

Console management port


A configuration terminal or network management workstation connects to the console
management port for onsite configuration. The port must use a 8.4 Console Cable. The
console management port is used when a switch is powered on for the first time. Table 7-14
describes the attributes of a console management port.

Table 7-14 Console management port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Working mode Duplex Universal Asynchronous Receiver/


Transmitter (UART)

Standards compliance RS232

Baud rate 9600 bit/s to 115200 bit/s


Default value: 9600 bit/s

BITS port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 152


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-15 BITS port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Working mode Clock synchronization mode: full-duplex


Time synchronization mode: half-duplex

Frame format l 1 pps + time of day (ToD)


l DC level shifter (DCLS)
l 2 MHz
l 2 Mbit/s: HDB3 code
l 1.544 Mbit/s: B8ZS code

Standards l 1 pps + ToD


compliance – NMEA-0183
– ToD standard of China Mobile
l DCLS: standard of DCLS signals
l 2 MHz: G.703
l 2 Mbit/s: G.703
l 1.544 Mbit/s: G.703

Cable used Time synchronization mode: straight-through Ethernet cable (RS422


signal)
Clock synchronization mode: E1/T1 cable (120-ohm balanced cable)
For details about cable parameters, see Clock Cable.

USB port
A USB flash drive can be inserted into the USB port to transfer configuration files, software
packages, or other files required for the switch during device deployment. Table 7-16 lists the
attributes of the USB port.

Table 7-16 USB port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type USB A

Standards compliance USB2.0

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 153


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-17 EH1D2SRUC000 specifications


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (5.7


specifications in. x 7.3 in. x 0.8 in.)
l Weight: 3.30 kg (7.28 lb)
l Maximum power consumption 132 W (including subcards)

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-18 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03021UWG S9706/S9712 Main Control EH1D2SRUC000


Unit C (Optional Clock)

7.5.2 EH1D2SRUDC00-S9706/S9712 Main Control Unit D


(Optional Clock)

Version Mapping

Table 7-19 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9703 Chassis S9706 and S9712 Chassis

EH1D2SRUDC00 Not supported Supported in V200R001C00


to V200R013C00

Introduction
An EH1D2SRUDC00 card can be installed in:

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 154


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

l Slots 07 and 08 in an S9706 chassis.


l Slots 13 and 14 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-13 Appearance of the EH1D2SRUDC00

Functions
The EH1D2SRUDC00 integrates control and switching functions. It provides the control
plane, management plane, and data plane, which are described as follows:
l The control plane is responsible for protocol processing, service processing, route
computing, forwarding control, service scheduling, traffic statistics collection, and
system security.
l The management plane is responsible for system status monitoring, environment
monitoring, log and alarm processing, system software loading, and system upgrades.
l The data plane provides high-speed, non-blocking data channels to implement service
switching between service modules. Two SRUs in a chassis can work in hot standby
mode.
The EH1D2SRUDC00 consists of the following function modules:
l Control module: provides the control and management plane for the EH1D2SRUDC00
and the entire system, implementing protocol processing, route computing, forwarding
control, system management, and system security.
l Switching module: provides the system data plane and provides high-speed service
channels to implement service switching.
l Local clock module: provides a working clock for chips of the control module, switching
module, and device management and monitoring module on the EH1D2SRUDC00.
l Device management and monitoring module: provides the controller area network bus
(CAN Bus) module to monitor the EH1D2SRUDC00 and manage the CAN Bus modules
of LPUs.
l Power supply module: provides power for the EH1D2SRUDC00.
l Value-added service module: provides enhanced services such as operation,
administration and maintenance (OAM) and bidirectional forwarding detection (BFD).

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 155


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-20 Functions of the EH1D2SRUDC00


Function Description

Basic function The EH1D2SRUDC00 is the system control and management unit for
the S9712 and S9706. They integrate the main control unit, clock unit,
switching unit, and system maintenance unit.

Distributed Performs concurrent data forwarding using a distributed data plane.


forwarding

OAM l 802.1ag: identifies, detects, and sends continuity check (CC)


packets.
l Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS OAM): identifies, detects,
and sends MPLS OAM packets.
l OAM UNCFG_MEP.

Memory 2 GB

Flash 128 MB

CF card 512 MB by default


By default, the system configuration data, startup files, system software
package, and system logs are saved to the CF card.

Clock The EH1D2SRUDC00 can have LE0D00CKMA00 installed to provide


stratum-3 clock, synchronous Ethernet, and IEEE 1588v2 functions.

Redundancy Supported
backup MPUs are mandatory for switches. You can configure one or two
MPUs for each switch. The MPU can be installed in either MPU slot of
a switch. An MPU consists of the control plane, management plane,
and data forwarding plane. When two MPUs are installed, the two
MPUs work in hot standby mode on the control and management
planes and work in load balancing mode on the data forwarding plane.
MPUs monitor each other. When the active MPU is faulty, the standby
MPU is automatically switched to be the active MPU to ensure service
continuity.

Hot swapping Supported


Before removing the active EH1D2SRUDC00 card, perform an active/
standby switchover.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 156


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Usage Constraints

l Main control units of different models cannot be used in the same chassis.
l The fans in a switch work in intelligent speed adjustment mode after a switchover between
the active and standby main control units in the switch. If the fans run at a specified speed
before a switchover, run the set fan-speed command after the switchover to set the fan
speed again.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-14 Indicators and buttons on the EH1D2SRUDC00 panel


1 234
CLK1 CLK2 CON ETH

SYNC
ACT RUN/ALM
RST

Table 7-21 Indicators and buttons on the EH1D2SRUDC00 panel


Number Indicator/ Color Description
Button

1 SYNC Green Steady on: The switch supports


time and clock synchronization,
and a clock daughter card is
installed on the SRU.
Off: The switch supports time and
clock synchronization but no clock
daughter card is installed on the
SRU.

2 RST button - Press this button to reset the card.


NOTE
Resetting a card causes service
interruption. Do not press the RST
button unless necessary.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 157


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator/ Color Description


Button

3 ACT: active/ Green Steady on: The card is in active


standby status state.
indicator Off: The card is in standby state.
NOTE
When two chassis set up a CSS, the
indicator reads as follows:
Steady on: The card is the active SRU
of the CSS.
Blinking: The card is the hot standby
SRU of the CSS.
Off: The card is the cold standby SRU
of the CSS.

4 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The switch has a 1600


W DC power module installed or
experiences a card failure. Manual
intervention is required.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.

Figure 7-15 Ports on the EH1D2SRUDC00 panel


1 2 3

CLK1 CLK2 CON ETH

SYNC
ACT RUN/ALM
RST

1 Two BITS ports. The CLK1 and CLK2 ports on the SRU map the BITS0
and BITS1 ports on the clock daughter card. BITS ports connect to BITS
devices or connected to the BITS ports of other products to synchronize
the time and clock.
2 One Console management port. A configuration terminal can connect to
this port to implement onsite configuration of the S9700.
3 One ETH management port (10M/100M BASE-TX auto-sensing). A
configuration terminal or network management workstation can connect
to this port to set up a local or remote configuration environment.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 158


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

ETH management port

A switch can connect to a configuration terminal or network management workstation


through the ETH management port for onsite or remote configuration. The port must use a 8.6
Ethernet Cable. Table 7-22 describes the attributes of an ETH management port.

Table 7-22 ETH management port attributes

Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE802.3

Working mode 10/100 Mbit/s auto-sensing


Full-duplex

Maximum transmission distance 100 m

Console management port

A configuration terminal or network management workstation connects to the console


management port for onsite configuration. The port must use a 8.4 Console Cable. The
console management port is used when a switch is powered on for the first time. Table 7-23
describes the attributes of a console management port.

Table 7-23 Console management port attributes

Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Working mode Duplex Universal Asynchronous Receiver/


Transmitter (UART)

Standards compliance RS232

Baud rate 9600 bit/s to 115200 bit/s


Default value: 9600 bit/s

BITS port

Table 7-24 BITS port attributes

Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Working mode Clock synchronization mode: full-duplex


Time synchronization mode: half-duplex

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 159


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Frame format l 1 pps + time of day (ToD)


l DC level shifter (DCLS)
l 2 MHz
l 2 Mbit/s: HDB3 code
l 1.544 Mbit/s: B8ZS code

Standards l 1 pps + ToD


compliance – NMEA-0183
– ToD standard of China Mobile
l DCLS: standard of DCLS signals
l 2 MHz: G.703 standard
l 2 Mbit/s: G.703 standard
l 1.544 Mbit/s: G.703 standard

Cable used Time synchronization mode: straight-through Ethernet cable (RS422


signal)
Clock synchronization mode: E1/T1 cable (120-ohm balanced cable)
For details about cable parameters, see Clock Cable.

Specifications

Table 7-25 Specifications of the EH1D2SRUDC00


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.90 kg (6.39 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 180 W (including subcards)

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 160


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-26 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NXR S9706/S9712 Main Control EH1D2SRUDC00


Unit D (Optional Clock)

7.5.3 EH1D2SRUDC01-S9706/S9712 Main Control Unit D


(Optional Clock)

Version Mapping

Table 7-27 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9703 Chassis S9706 and S9712 Chassis

EH1D2SRUDC01 Not supported Supported in V200R001C00


to V200R013C00

Introduction
An EH1D2SRUDC01 card can be installed in:

l Slots 07 and 08 in an S9706 chassis.


l Slots 13 and 14 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-16 Appearance of the EH1D2SRUDC01

Functions
The EH1D2SRUDC01 integrates control and switching functions. It provides the control
plane, management plane, and data plane, which are described as follows:

l The control plane is responsible for protocol processing, service processing, route
computing, forwarding control, service scheduling, traffic statistics collection, and
system security.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 161


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

l The management plane is responsible for system status monitoring, environment


monitoring, log and alarm processing, system software loading, and system upgrades.
l The data plane provides high-speed, non-blocking data channels to implement service
switching between service modules. Two SRUs in a chassis can work in hot standby
mode.
The EH1D2SRUDC01 consists of the following function modules:
l Control module: provides the control and management plane for the EH1D2SRUDC01
and the entire system, implementing protocol processing, route computing, forwarding
control, system management, and system security.
l Switching module: provides the system data plane and provides high-speed service
channels to implement service switching.
l Local clock module: provides a working clock for chips of the control module, switching
module, and device management and monitoring module on the EH1D2SRUDC01.
l Device management and monitoring module: provides the controller area network bus
(CAN Bus) module to monitor the EH1D2SRUDC01 and manage the CAN Bus modules
of LPUs.
l Power supply module: provides power for the EH1D2SRUDC01.
l Value-added service module: provides enhanced services such as operation,
administration and maintenance (OAM) and bidirectional forwarding detection (BFD).

Table 7-28 Functions of the EH1D2SRUDC01


Function Description

Basic function The EH1D2SRUDC01 is the system control and management unit for
the S9712 and S9706. They integrate the main control unit, clock unit,
switching unit, and system maintenance unit.

Distributed Performs concurrent data forwarding using a distributed data plane.


forwarding

OAM l 802.1ag: identifies, detects, and sends continuity check (CC)


packets.
l Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS OAM): identifies, detects,
and sends MPLS OAM packets.
l OAM UNCFG_MEP.

Memory 2 GB

Flash 128 MB

CF card 512 MB by default


By default, the system configuration data, startup files, system software
package, and system logs are saved to the CF card.

Clock The EH1D2SRUDC01 can have LE0D00CKMA00 installed to provide


stratum-3 clock, synchronous Ethernet, and IEEE 1588v2 functions.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 162


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Function Description

Redundancy Supported
backup MPUs are mandatory for switches. You can configure one or two
MPUs for each switch. The MPU can be installed in either MPU slot of
a switch. An MPU consists of the control plane, management plane,
and data forwarding plane. When two MPUs are installed, the two
MPUs work in hot standby mode on the control and management
planes and work in load balancing mode on the data forwarding plane.
MPUs monitor each other. When the active MPU is faulty, the standby
MPU is automatically switched to be the active MPU to ensure service
continuity.

Hot swapping Supported


Before removing the active EH1D2SRUDC01 card, perform an active/
standby switchover.

Usage Constraints

l Main control units of different models cannot be used in the same chassis.
l The fans in a switch work in intelligent speed adjustment mode after a switchover between
the active and standby main control units in the switch. If the fans run at a specified speed
before a switchover, run the set fan-speed command after the switchover to set the fan
speed again.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-17 Indicators and buttons on the EH1D2SRUDC01 panel


1 234
CLK1 CLK2 CON ETH

SYNC
ACT RUN/ALM
RST

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 163


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-29 Indicators and buttons on the EH1D2SRUDC01 panel


Number Indicator/ Color Description
Button

1 SYNC Green Steady on: The switch supports


time and clock synchronization,
and a clock daughter card is
installed on the SRU.
Off: The switch supports time and
clock synchronization but no clock
daughter card is installed on the
SRU.

2 RST button - Press this button to reset the card.


NOTE
Resetting a card causes service
interruption. Do not press the RST
button unless necessary.

3 ACT: active/ Green Steady on: The card is in active


standby status state.
indicator Off: The card is in standby state.
NOTE
When two chassis set up a CSS, the
indicator reads as follows:
Steady on: The card is the active SRU
of the CSS.
Blinking: The card is the hot standby
SRU of the CSS.
Off: The card is the cold standby SRU
of the CSS.

4 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The switch has a 1600


W DC power module installed or
experiences a card failure. Manual
intervention is required.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 164


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-18 Ports on the EH1D2SRUDC01 panel


1 2 3

CLK1 CLK2 CON ETH

SYNC
ACT RUN/ALM
RST

1 Two BITS ports. The CLK1 and CLK2 ports on the SRU map the BITS0
and BITS1 ports on the clock daughter card. BITS ports connect to BITS
devices or connected to the BITS ports of other products to synchronize
the time and clock.
2 One Console management port. A configuration terminal can connect to
this port to implement onsite configuration of the S9700.
3 One ETH management port (10M/100M BASE-TX auto-sensing). A
configuration terminal or network management workstation can connect
to this port to set up a local or remote configuration environment.

ETH management port


A switch can connect to a configuration terminal or network management workstation
through the ETH management port for onsite or remote configuration. The port must use a 8.6
Ethernet Cable. Table 7-30 describes the attributes of an ETH management port.

Table 7-30 ETH management port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE802.3

Working mode 10/100 Mbit/s auto-sensing


Full-duplex

Maximum transmission distance 100 m

Console management port


A configuration terminal or network management workstation connects to the console
management port for onsite configuration. The port must use a 8.4 Console Cable. The
console management port is used when a switch is powered on for the first time. Table 7-31
describes the attributes of a console management port.

Table 7-31 Console management port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 165


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Working mode Duplex Universal Asynchronous Receiver/


Transmitter (UART)

Standards compliance RS232

Baud rate 9600 bit/s to 115200 bit/s


Default value: 9600 bit/s

BITS port

Table 7-32 BITS port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Working mode Clock synchronization mode: full-duplex


Time synchronization mode: half-duplex

Frame format l 1 pps + time of day (ToD)


l DC level shifter (DCLS)
l 2 MHz
l 2 Mbit/s: HDB3 code
l 1.544 Mbit/s: B8ZS code

Standards l 1 pps + ToD


compliance – NMEA-0183
– ToD standard of China Mobile
l DCLS: standard of DCLS signals
l 2 MHz: G.703 standard
l 2 Mbit/s: G.703 standard
l 1.544 Mbit/s: G.703 standard

Cable used Time synchronization mode: straight-through Ethernet cable (RS422


signal)
Clock synchronization mode: E1/T1 cable (120-ohm balanced cable)
For details about cable parameters, see Clock Cable.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 166


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-33 Specifications of the EH1D2SRUDC01


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.90 kg (6.39 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 180 W (including subcards)

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-34 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030PHA S9706/S9712 Main Control EH1D2SRUDC01


Unit D (Optional Clock) -
FCC

7.5.4 EH1D2MCUAC00-S9703 Main Control Unit A (Optional


Clock)

Version Mapping

Table 7-35 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9703 Chassis S9706 and S9712 Chassis

EH1D2MCUAC00 Supported in V200R001C00 Not supported


to V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2MCUAC00 can be installed in slots 04 and 05 in an S9703 chassis.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 167


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-19 Appearance of the EH1D2MCUAC00

Functions
The EH1D2MCUAC00 is the main control unit of the S9703. It integrates the control unit
(Optional Clock) unit, and system maintenance unit, and provides the following functions:
l Provides channels for out-of-band communication between cards.
l Provides high-precision stratum-3 clock and synchronous Ethernet clock. These clock
features ensure clock synchronization between ports and LPUs.
l Monitors system operation. The EH1D2MCUAC00 periodically collects operation data
of different units. According to running status of the units, the EH1D2MCUAC00
generates control information to check card presence, control fabric running status,
perform port switching, reset the forwarding engine, and increase the fan speed.
l Functions as the proxy of the network management software: The EH1D2MCUAC00
manages and maintains the switch through management ports (console port and Ethernet
port).
l Stores configuration data, startup files, accounting information, upgrade software, and
system logs. The EH1D2MCUAC00 provides a CF card to store data files as a mass
storage device.

Table 7-36 Functions of the EH1D2MCUAC00


Function Description

Basic function Integrates the main control unit, clock unit, and system maintenance
unit.

Distributed Performs concurrent data forwarding using a distributed data plane.


forwarding

Memory 512 MB

Flash 64 MB

CF card 512 MB
By default, the system configuration data, startup files, system software
package, and system logs are saved to the CF card.

Clock The EH1D2MCUAC00 can have LE0D00CKMA00 installed to


provide IEEE 1588v2 functions, synchronous Ethernet, and stratum-3
clock.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 168


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Function Description

Redundancy Supported
backup Main control board is mandatory for switches. Each switch must be
configured with one or two main control boards. When one main
control board is configured for a switch, the main control board can be
installed in either main control board slot of the switch. When two main
control boards are configured, the two main control boards work in hot
standby mode to improve reliability of the switch. The active and
standby main control boards monitor the status of each other. If the
active main control board fails, the standby main control board
automatically becomes active to ensure uninterrupted services.

Hot swapping Supported


Before removing the active EH1D2MCUAC00 card, perform an active/
standby switchover.

Usage Constraints

l Main control units of different models cannot be used in the same chassis.
l The fans in a switch work in intelligent speed adjustment mode after a switchover between
the active and standby main control units in the switch. If the fans run at a specified speed
before a switchover, run the set fan-speed command after the switchover to set the fan
speed again.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-20 Indicators and buttons on the EH1D2MCUAC00 panel


1 2 34
SYNC

RST ACT RUN/ALM


CLK1 CLK2 RS485 MON CON ETH

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 169


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-37 Indicators and buttons on the EH1D2MCUAC00 panel


Number Indicator/ Color Description
Button

1 SYNC Green Steady on: The switch supports


time and clock synchronization,
and a clock daughter card is
installed on the MCU.
Off: The switch supports time and
clock synchronization, but no clock
daughter card is installed on the
MCU.

2 RST button - Press this button to reset the card.

3 ACT: active/ Green Steady on: The card is the active


standby status MCU.
indicator Off: The card is the standby MCU.

4 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The switch has a 1600


W DC power module installed or
experiences a card failure. Manual
intervention is required.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.

Figure 7-21 Ports on the EH1D2MCUAC00 panel


1 2 3 4 5
SYNC

ACT RUN/ALM
RST
CLK1 CLK2 RS485 MON CON ETH

1 Two BITS ports. The CLK1 and CLK2 ports on the MCU map the BITS0
and BITS1 ports on the clock daughter card. BITS devices or other
products can connect to BITS ports to synchronize the time and clock.
2 One RS485 port (reserved).
3 One MON port (reserved).
4 One console management port. A configuration terminal can connect to
this port to implement onsite configuration of the S9700.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 170


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

5 One ETH management port (10/100BASE-TX auto-sensing). A


configuration terminal or network management workstation can connect
to this port to set up a local or remote configuration environment.

ETH management port


A switch can connect to a configuration terminal or network management workstation
through the ETH management port for onsite or remote configuration. The port must use a 8.6
Ethernet Cable. Table 7-38 describes the attributes of an ETH management port.

Table 7-38 ETH management port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE802.3

Working mode 10/100 Mbit/s auto-sensing


Full-duplex

Maximum transmission distance 100 m

Console management port


A configuration terminal or network management workstation connects to the console
management port for onsite configuration. The port must use a 8.4 Console Cable. The
console management port is used when a switch is powered on for the first time. Table 7-39
describes the attributes of a console management port.

Table 7-39 Console management port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Working mode Duplex Universal Asynchronous Receiver/


Transmitter (UART)

Standards compliance RS232

Baud rate 9600 bit/s to 115200 bit/s


Default value: 9600 bit/s

BITS port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 171


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-40 BITS port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Working mode Clock synchronization mode: full-duplex


Time synchronization mode: half-duplex

Frame format l 1 pps + time of day (ToD)


l DC level shifter (DCLS)
l 2 MHz
l 2 Mbit/s: HDB3 code
l 1.544 Mbit/s: B8ZS code

Standards l 1 pps + ToD


compliance – NMEA-0183
– ToD standard of China Mobile
l DCLS: standard of DCLS signals
l 2 MHz: G.703 standard
l 2 Mbit/s: G.703 standard
l 1.544 Mbit/s: G.703 standard

Cable used Time synchronization mode: straight-through Ethernet cable (RS422


signal).
Clock synchronization mode: E1/T1 cable (120-ohm balanced cable)
For details about cable parameters, see Clock Cable.

Specifications

Table 7-41 Specifications of the EH1D2MCUAC00


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 194.5 mm x 426.8 mm x 19.9 mm (7.7


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 0.78 in.)
l Weight: 0.90 kg (2.0 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 26 W (including subcards)

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 172


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-42 Ordering information

Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NWA S9703 Main Control Unit A EH1D2MCUAC00


(Optional Clock)

7.5.5 LE0D00CKMA00 Clock Pinch Board,-1588

Version Mapping

Table 7-43 Switch chassis and software versions matching the CKM daughter card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

LE0D00CKMA00 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The LE0D00CKMA00 is a daughter card installed in the main control unit of the S9700 to
provide clock and time synchronization. This card has two Building Integrated Timing Supply
(BITS) ports.

The LE0D00CKMA00 can be used in the EH1D2SRUC000, EH1D2SRUDC00,


EH1D2SRUDC01 and EH1D2MCUAC00.

Figure 7-22 Appearance of the LE0D00CKMA00

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 173


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions
The LE0D00CKMA00 consists of the following functional units:

l Clock synchronization unit (synchronous Ethernet clock)


l Time synchronization unit (IEEE 1588 module)

The LE0D00CKMA00 provides the following functions:

l Provides the 19.44 MHz system clock and external clock signals. The output clock signal
complies with the ITU-T G.813 standard.
l Implements the IEEE 1588 protocol to ensure time synchronization on the network.
Time synchronization accuracy is within 0.1 us, which complies with the 1588v2
protocol.

Usage Constraints

If the switch is equipped with two MPUs, you must install clock daughter cards on both the
active and standby MPUs.

Components and Ports

Figure 7-23 Components on the LE0D00CKMA00

2 1

Table 7-44 Components on the LE0D00CKMA00


Number Component Description

1 Stud The studs fix the clock daughter card on the


MPU.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 174


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Component Description

2 Double-edge The clock daughter card uses these


connector connectors to exchange signals with the
MPU.

The LE0D00CKMA00 has two BITS ports, which are presented by CLK1 and CLK2 on the
MPU, as shown in Figure 7-24.

Figure 7-24 BITS ports of the LE0D00CKMA00 on the MPU panel


1 2

CLK1 CLK2 CON ETH

SYNC
ACT RUN/ALM
RST

Table 7-45 Ports on the LE0D00CKMA00

Number Port on the Port on the Description


MPU Panel LE0D00CKM
A00

1 CLK1 BITS0 A BITS port can be configured as


an input or output port.
2 CLK2 BITS1
l Input port: receives 2.048 MHz
clock signals, 2.048 Mbit/s clock
signals, 1.544 Mbit/s clock
signals, 1 pulse per second (pps)
clock signals, or DC level shift
(DCLS) code streams from the
upstream device and generates
19.44 MHz clock signals for the
system. The BITS port also
obtains time information and
provides time information for
LPUs.
l Output port: sends 2.048 MHz
clock signals, 2.048 Mbit/s clock
signals, 1.544 Mbit/s clock
signals, 1 pps clock signals, or
DCLS code streams to the
downstream device.

BITS port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 175


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-46 BITS port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Working mode Transmission rate


l Clock synchronization: 2 MHz, 2 Mbps,
1.544 Mbps
l Time synchronization: 9600 bit/s (full-
duplex mode supported)

Standards compliance Clock synchronization: E1 and T1


Time synchronization: DCLS and time of
day (ToD)

Specifications

Table 7-47 Specifications of the LE0D00CKMA00


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 100.0 mm x 145.0 mm x 2.0 mm (3.9 in.


specifications x 5.7 in. x 0.08 in.)
l Weight: 0.10 kg (0.2 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 6 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-48 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03020PPT Clock Pinch Board LE0D00CKMA00

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 176


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

7.5.6 EH1D2VS08000-8-Port 10G Cluster Switching System


Service Unit (SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-49 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9703 Chassis S9706 and S9712 Chassis

EH1D2VS08000 Not supported Supported in V200R003C00


to V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2VS08000 provides eight 10GE optical ports, which can only be used for cluster
connection and cannot be used for data transmission and switching.

The EH1D2VS08000 can be installed in the subcard slot of an EH1D2SRUC000.

Figure 7-25 Appearance of the EH1D2VS08000

Functions
Switches connected through optical ports on the EH1D2VS08000 cards form a cluster switch
system (CSS) and are considered as one device. You can log in to the master switch to
manage all the switches in the CSS.

Usage Constraints

To run the CSS service on a chassis, both SRUs in the chassis must have an EH1D2VS08000
card installed.
The EH1D2VS08000 is not hot swappable in the S9700.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 177


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-26 Indicators on the EH1D2VS08000 panel


3

RUN/ALM
LINK/ALM
MASTER

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

VS08

21

Table 7-50 Indicators on the EH1D2VS08000 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.

2 MASTER: Green Steady on: The SRU with the


master/slave EH1D2VS08000 card installed is
status indicator the master SRU of the CSS.
Off: The SRU with the
EH1D2VS08000 card installed is
not the master SRU of the CSS.

3 LINK/ALM Green Steady on: The link status of the


CSS port is Up.

Red Steady on: The cable is connected


incorrectly to the CSS port.

- Off: The link status of the CSS port


is Down.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 178


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-27 Ports on the EH1D2VS08000 panel


1

RUN/ALM
LINK/ALM
MASTER

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

VS08

1 Eight 10G BASE-SFP+ optical ports

10G BASE-SFP+ optical port

Table 7-51 lists the attributes of a 10G BASE-SFP+ optical port.

Table 7-51 10G BASE-SFP+ optical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attribute l When a 1 m, 3 m, 5 m, or 10 m (active)


SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed cable is
connected to the optical port, the port
attributes are determined by the SFP+ -
SFP+ high-speed cable.
l When an active optical cable is
connected to the optical port, the port
attributes are determined by the SFP+
optical cable.
l When an optical module is installed on
the optical port, the port attributes are
determined by the optical module
attributes. For details, see 9.10 10GE
SFP+ Optical Modules.

Ports on each EH1D2VS08000 card are divided into two groups: group 1 with ports 1, 2, 3,
and 4, and group 2 with ports 5, 6, 7, and 8. When chassis 1 and chassis 2 need to set up a
cluster, use either of the following methods to connect their CSS cards:

Two groups with the same group ID in different chassis must be connected by at least one
cluster cable. The ports in the two groups can be connected in any sequence. For example, any
port in group 1 in chassis 1 can be connected to any port in group 1 in chassis 2.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 179


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

l Method 1: Connect group 1 of card 1 to group 1 of card 3, group 2 of card 1 to group 2


of card 4, group 1 of card 2 to group 1 of card 4, and group 2 of card 2 to group 2 of card
3, as shown in Figure 7-28.

Figure 7-28 Cable connections on EH1D2VS08000 cards (only applicable to S9700


switches)

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
SRU SRU

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
SRU 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
SRU

Group1
Group2
Cable

NOTE

These figures use solid lines and dashed lines in different colors to help you differentiate the cable
connections clearly. This is not intended to represent specific cable types.

l Method 2: Connect group 1 of card 1 to group 1 of card 4, group 2 of card 1 to group 2


of card 3, group 1 of card 2 to group 1 of card 3, and group 2 of card 2 to group 2 of card
4, as shown in Figure 7-29.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 180


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-29 Cable connections on EH1D2VS08000 cards (only applicable to S9700


switches)

Chassis 1

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
CSS ID

Card 1
EH1D2
RUN/ALM
ACT RUN/ALM
EH1D2

08
SRUC000 LINK/ALM SYNC SRUC000
MASTER

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 RST
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

VS08 CLK1 CLK2 CONSOLE

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
CSS ID

Card 2
RUN/ALM
EH1D2

SRUC000
MASTER
LINK/ALM SYNC ACT RUN/ALM
EH1D2

SRUC000 07
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 RST
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

VS08 CLK1 CLK2 CONSOLE

RUN/ALM

EH1D2
G48TFA0
Chassis 2

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

Card 3
CSS ID
EH1D2
RUN/ALM
ACT RUN/ALM
EH1D2

LINK/ALM
SRUC000
MASTER
SYNC SRUC000
08
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 RST
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

VS08 CLK1 CLK2 CONSOLE

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
CSS ID

Card 4
RUN/ALM
07
EH1D2
ACT RUN/ALM
EH1D2

SRUC000 LINK/ALM SYNC SRUC000


MASTER

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 RST
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

VS08 CLK1 CLK2 CONSOLE

Group 1

Group 2
RUN/ALM

EH1D2
G48TFA0
Cables

Specifications

Table 7-52 EH1D2VS08000 specifications


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 213.0 mm x 151.8 mm x 35.1 mm (8.4


specifications in. x 6.0 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 0.50 kg (1.10 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 30 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 181


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-53 Ordering information

Part Number Card Description Card Model

03021UWH 8-Port 10G Cluster EH1D2VS08000


Switching System Service
Unit (SFP+)

7.6 EH1D200CMU00-Centralized Monitoring Unit

Version Mapping

Table 7-54 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9703 Chassis S9706 and S9712 Chassis

EH1D200CMU00 Not supported Supported in V200R001C00


to V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D200CMU00 can be installed in:

l Slots CMU1 and CMU2 in an S9706 chassis.


l Slots CMU1 and CMU2 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-30 Appearance of the EH1D200CMU00

Functions
The EH1D200CMU00 consists of the following modules:

l Device management module: sends interface control signals for device management.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 182


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

l Backplane interface module: provides management channels for power modules, fan
modules, and communication channels between the active and standby
EH1D200CMU00 cards.
The EH1D200CMU00 manages power modules and fan modules in a chassis. The
EH1D200CMU00 is hot swappable. Two EH1D200CMU00 cards can be installed in a chassis
to work in active/standby mode.
Fan module management
The EH1D200CMU00 provides the following fan module management functions:
l Fan module presence detection
l Fan module registration management
l Fan speed monitoring
l Fan speed control
l Management and report of fan module alarms
l Query of fan module electronic labels
The EH1D200CMU00 supports real-time fan module presence detection. Fan modules in the
chassis register with the EH1D200CMU00. After they register, the EH1D200CMU00 obtains
electronic labels of the fan modules and saves the electronic labels for users to query.
Meanwhile, the EH1D200CMU00 monitors the speed and alarms of the fan modules in real
time.
When detecting an alarm about a fan module, the EH1D200CMU00 reports the alarm to the
MPU. When the alarm is cleared, the EH1D200CMU00 reports alarm clearance to the MPU.
When the EH1D200CMU00 receives a fan speed adjustment instruction from the MPU, it
delivers the instruction to the fan modules. The fan modules then adjust their speed according
to the instruction. If a chassis has no EH1D200CMU00 installed, fans run at full speed.
Power module management
The EH1D200CMU00 provides the following power module management functions:
l Power module presence detection
l Power module shutdown
l Power module registration management
l Voltage and current monitoring
l Management and report of power module alarms
l Query of power module electronic labels
The EH1D200CMU00 supports real-time power module presence detection. Power modules
in the chassis register with the EH1D200CMU00. After they register, the EH1D200CMU00
obtains electronic labels of the power modules and saves the electronic labels for users to
query. Meanwhile, the EH1D200CMU00 queries the current and voltage of power modules in
real time.
When detecting an alarm about a power module, the EH1D200CMU00 reports the alarm to
the MPU. When the alarm is cleared, the EH1D200CMU00 reports alarm clearance to the
MPU.
When the switch is working in deep energy saving mode, the EH1D200CMU00 automatically
shuts down redundant power modules to save power. You can set the deep energy saving
mode using the set power manage mode command.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 183


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-31 Indicators on the EH1D200CMU00 panel

1
2

Table 7-55 Indicators on the EH1D200CMU00 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 RUN/ALM: Green Slow blinking: The card software is


running status running properly.
indicator Fast blinking: The card software is
unregistered.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.
Slow blinking: The switch is
reporting an alarm. For example, a
CMU, fan module, or power
module on the switch fails.
Fast blinking: The input power is
insufficient or a 1600 W DC power
module is installed.

2 ACT: active/ Green Steady on: The card is the active


standby status CMU.
indicator Off: The card is the standby CMU.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 184


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-32 Ports on the EH1D200CMU00 panel

1 One RS485 port (reserved)


2 One MON port (reserved)

Specifications

Table 7-56 Specifications of the EH1D200CMU00


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 112.9 mm x 412.7 mm x 19.8 mm (4.4


specifications in. x 16.2 in. x 0.8 in.)
l Weight: 0.22 kg (0.49 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 1 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-57 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NWB Centralized Monitoring Unit EH1D200CMU00

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 185


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

7.7 LE0D0VAMPA00-Value-Added Service Unit

Version Mapping

Table 7-58 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

LE0D0VAMPA00 This module is supported in V200R001C00


to V200R008C00 (except in
V200R007C10).

Introduction
The LE0D0VAMPA00 is a Service Process Unit (SPU) for the S9700. It provides value-added
services such as load balancing, firewall, network address translation (NAT), IP Security
(IPSec), and NetStream. Currently, the LE0D0VAMPA00 is the only SPU available.

An LE0D0VAMPA00 card can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-33 Appearance of the LE0D0VAMPA00

Functions
The LE0D0VAMPA00 provides value-added services such as load balancing, NAT, firewall,
IPSec, and NetStream. When the LE0D0VAMPA00 is installed on a switch, packets related to
a value-added service are directed to the LE0D0VAMPA00 for processing.

The LE0D0VAMPA00 is hot swappable.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 186


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-34 Indicators on the LE0D0VAMPA00 panel


1 2 3
RUN/ALM

CON ETH

Table 7-59 Indicators on the LE0D0VAMPA00 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


and receiving data.

2 LINK Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-35 Ports on the LE0D0VAMPA00 panel


1 2
RUN/ALM

CON ETH

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 187


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

1 One console management port (serial port). You can connect the serial
port on your PC to the CON port of an SPU and log in to the SPU to
configure it.
2 One ETH management port (FE electrical port). You can connect your
PC to the ETH port and log in to the SPU using Telnet to configure it.

ETH management port


A switch can connect to a configuration terminal or network management workstation
through the ETH management port for onsite or remote configuration. The port must use a 8.6
Ethernet Cable. Table 7-60 describes the attributes of an ETH management port.

Table 7-60 ETH management port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE802.3

Working mode 10/100 Mbit/s auto-sensing


Full-duplex

Maximum transmission distance 100 m

Console management port


A configuration terminal or network management workstation connects to the console
management port for onsite configuration. The port must use a 8.4 Console Cable. Table
7-61 describes the attributes of a console management port.

Table 7-61 Console management port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Working mode Duplex Universal Asynchronous Receiver/


Transmitter (UART)

Standards compliance RS232

Baud rate 9600 bit/s to 115200 bit/s


Default value: 9600 bit/s

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 188


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-62 Specifications of the LE0D0VAMPA00

Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.60 kg (5.73 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 120 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-63 Ordering information

Part Number Card Description Card Model

03020RRN Value-added service unit LE0D0VAMPA00

7.8 EH1D2PS00P00-Open Service Platform Unit

Version Mapping

Table 7-64 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2PS00P00 This module is supported in V200R002C00


to V200R013C00 (except in
V200R007C10).

Introduction
The EH1D2PS00P00 can be installed in:

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 189


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-36 Appearance of the EH1D2PS00P00

Functions
In addition to processing and forwarding service data, the EH1D2PS00P00 can also provide
certain functions using specific operating system and application software.

The EH1D2PS00P00 supports intrusion prevention system (IPS) software.

The IPS software provides the following security functions:

l Detects attacks based on a signature database. The IPS software can identify attacks that
target vulnerabilities of commonly used applications (such as Adobe PDF Reader and
Microsoft Office) and operating systems (such as Microsoft Windows), and
abnormalities of these applications and operating systems.
l Identifies behaviors that violate RFC standards through application identification,
protocol decoding, and state detection, and prevents applications that may use
vulnerabilities of protocols to initiate attacks from running.
l Detects attacks to HTTPS traffic and takes measures to protect the traffic.
l Automatically updates and upgrades the signature database to defend against
vulnerabilities of applications and operating systems in advance.
l Supports periodic and emergent updating of the signature database and allows users to
add customized signatures.
l Implements highly precise intrusion prevention using the default security policy and
provides the bypass function.

The IPS software also provides comprehensive management functions:

l Fine-grained rights management: The IPS manages user rights based on different user
levels, including monitoring level, configuration level, and management level.
l System management based on the web system, command line interface (CLI), and
simple network management protocol (SNMP).
l Reports on logs and alarms: The IPS uses log analysis software to collect and analyze
logs and alarms accurately, and provides various reports on the logs and alarms. Users
can customize reports.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 190


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-65 Functions of the EH1D2PS00P00 running application software


Function Description

Operating system VMware

Application software IPS and other application software

CPU Intel Core processor, 2.1 GHz, 4 cores, 6


MB cache

Memory l DDR3-1066/1333 MT/s


l Standard configuration: two 2 GB
memory cards (total capacity of 4 GB)
l Maximum configuration: two 8 GB
memory cards (total capacity of 16 GB)

Built-in flash memory 8 GB

Hard disk l Provides two 2.5-inch 500 GB enterprise


Serial Advanced Technology Attachment
(SATA) hard disks.
l Supports RAID 0 and RAID 1.
l Supports hot swapping.
NOTICE
Huawei-certified hard disks are required.
Reliability of non-Huawei-certified hard disks
cannot be ensured. Huawei is not responsible for
any problems caused by non-Huawei-certified
hard disks and will not fix such problems.
Hard disks provided by Huawei are certified.

Service port Two 10GE ports


NOTE
l The two ports are not on the card panel.
l You can run the interface interface-type
interface-number command to enter the view
of the two service ports. The interface-type
indicates the interface type and the interface-
number indicates the interface number that is
0 or 1.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 191


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Function Description

Management port l One VGA port supports:


– Hot swapping
– Standard DB15 socket
l Two USB ports support:
– Hot swapping
– USB 2.0 High-Speed
– USB Specification Rev.2.0
l One serial port: UART port
l One GE port: 10M/100M/1000M auto-
sensing, RJ45 connector. The port enters
sleeping state when no link is
established.

Energy-saving l Dynamic voltage and frequency scaling


for CPU
l Sleeping of idle ports
l Card power detection

Table 7-66 Functions of the EH1D2PS00P00 for service data processing and forwarding
Function Description

Basic function Service data processing and forwarding

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2PS00P00 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-37 Indicators and buttons on the EH1D2PS00P00 panel


1 2 4 5 7
RUN/ALM

0
PWR RST sub card HDD0

STAT 1 HDD1
CONSOLE ETH VGA HDD0 HDD1

3 6

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 192


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-67 Indicators and buttons on the EH1D2PS00P00 panel


Number Indicator/ Color Description
Button

1 PWR button - Press for 0.5s to power the card on


or off.
Hold down the button for more
than 4s to forcibly power off the
card. This operation is performed
when the card stops responding.

2 RST button - Press this button to reset the


operating system and application
software on the card.
NOTICE
Pressing the RST button causes loss of
some service packets. Do not press this
button unless necessary.

3 STAT - Off: The card is powered off or is


resetting.

Yellow Steady on: The BIOS is running.

Green Steady on: The operating system


(OS) is running normally.

Red Steady on: A major alarm occurred


and requires manual intervention.
For example, hardware self-check
fails or no OS is available.

4 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of ETH port and receiving data.

5 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of ETH port established on the port.

6 HDD0 and Green Blinking: The hard disk is being


HDD1 hard accessed.
disk indicators

7 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 193


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator/ Color Description


Button

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-38 Ports on the EH1D2PS00P00 panel


1 2
RUN/ALM

0
PWR RST sub card HDD0

STAT 1 HDD1
CONSOLE ETH VGA HDD0 HDD1

3 4 5

1 One console management port. A configuration terminal can connect to


this port to implement onsite configuration.
2 One ETH management port (10M/100M/1000M BASE-T auto-sensing).
A configuration terminal or network management workstation can
connect to this port to set up a local or remote configuration environment.
3 Two USB ports. Peripherals such as a USB mouse or keyboard can
connect to USB ports.
4 One VGA port. A monitor can connect to this port.
5 Two hard disk slots.

ETH management port


A switch can connect to a configuration terminal or network management workstation
through the ETH management port for onsite or remote configuration. The port must use a 8.6
Ethernet Cable. Table 7-68 describes the attributes of an ETH management port.

Table 7-68 ETH management port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE802.3

Working mode 10/100/1000 Mbit/s auto-sensing


Full-duplex

Maximum transmission distance 100 m

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 194


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Console management port


A configuration terminal or network management workstation connects to the console
management port for onsite configuration. The port must use a 8.4 Console Cable. Table
7-69 describes the attributes of a console management port.

Table 7-69 Console management port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Working mode Duplex Universal Asynchronous Receiver/


Transmitter (UART)

Standards compliance RS232

Baud rate 9600 bit/s to 115200 bit/s


Default value: 9600 bit/s

Specifications

Table 7-70 Specifications of the EH1D2PS00P00


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 5.50 kg (12.13 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 137.5 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-71 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03021PHK Open Service Platform EH1D2PS00P00


(OSP) unit

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 195


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

7.9 100M Interface Cards

7.9.1 EH1D2F48TEA0-48-Port 10/100BASE-T Interface Card (EA,


RJ45)

Version Mapping

Table 7-72 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2F48TEA0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2F48TEA0 can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-39 Appearance of the EH1D2F48TEA0

Functions

Table 7-73 Functions of the EH1D2F48TEA0

Function Description

Basic function Provides forty-eight FE electrical ports for data transmission and line-
rate switching.

Distributed Performs concurrent data forwarding using a distributed data plane.


forwarding

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 196


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Function Description

Hot swapping The EH1D2F48TEA0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-40 Indicators on the EH1D2F48TEA0 panel


12 3
RUN/ALM

Table 7-74 Indicators on the EH1D2F48TEA0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.
2 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-41 Ports on the EH1D2F48TEA0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 197


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

1 Forty-eight 10M/100M BASE-T electrical ports

10M/100M BASE-T electrical ports


Table 7-75 lists the attributes of a 10M/100M BASE-T electrical port.

Table 7-75 10M/100M BASE-T electrical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-76 Specifications of the EH1D2F48TEA0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.50 kg (5.73 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 59 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-77 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NWP 48-port 10/100BASE-T EH1D2F48TEA0


interface card (EA, RJ45)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 198


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

7.9.2 EH1D2F48TEC0-48-Port 10/100BASE-T Interface Card (EC,


RJ45)

Version Mapping

Table 7-78 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2F48TEC0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2F48TEC0 can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-42 Appearance of the EH1D2F48TEC0

Functions

Table 7-79 Functions of the EH1D2F48TEC0

Function Description

Basic function Provides forty-eight FE electrical ports for data transmission and line-
rate switching.

Distributed Performs concurrent data forwarding using a distributed data plane.


forwarding

Hot swapping The EH1D2F48TEC0 is hot swappable.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 199


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-43 Indicators on the EH1D2F48TEC0 panel


12 3
RUN/ALM

Table 7-80 Indicators on the EH1D2F48TEC0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.
2 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-44 Ports on the EH1D2F48TEC0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 200


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

1 Forty-eight 10M/100M BASE-T electrical ports

10M/100M BASE-T electrical ports

Table 7-81 lists the attributes of a 10M/100M BASE-T electrical port.

Table 7-81 10M/100M BASE-T electrical port attributes

Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-82 Specifications of the EH1D2F48TEC0

Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.66 kg (5.86 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 70 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-83 Ordering information

Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NWQ 48-port 10/100BASE-T EH1D2F48TEC0


interface card (EC, RJ45)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 201


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

7.9.3 EH1D2F48TFA0-48-Port 10/100BASE-T Interface Card (FA,


RJ45)

Version Mapping

Table 7-84 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2F48TFA0 Supported only in V200R001C00,


V200R002C00, and V200R003C00

Introduction
The EH1D2F48TFA0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-45 Appearance of the EH1D2F48TFA0

Functions

Table 7-85 Functions of the EH1D2F48TFA0


Function Description

Basic function Provides forty-eight FE electrical ports for data transmission and line-
rate switching.

Distributed Performs concurrent data forwarding using a distributed data plane.


forwarding

Hot swapping The EH1D2F48TFA0 is hot swappable.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 202


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-46 Indicators on the EH1D2F48TFA0 panel


12 3
RUN/ALM

Table 7-86 Indicators on the EH1D2F48TFA0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.
2 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-47 Ports on the EH1D2F48TFA0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 203


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

1 Forty-eight 10M/100M BASE-T electrical ports

10M/100M BASE-T electrical ports

Table 7-87 lists the attributes of a 10M/100M BASE-T electrical port.

Table 7-87 10M/100M BASE-T electrical port attributes

Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-88 Specifications of the EH1D2F48TFA0

Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.30 kg (5.07 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 40 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-89 Ordering information

Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NXF 48-port 10/100BASE-T EH1D2F48TFA0


interface card (FA, RJ45)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 204


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

7.9.4 EH1D2F48SEA0-48-Port 100BASE-X Interface Card (EA, SFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-90 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2F48SEA0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2F48SEA0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-48 Appearance of the EH1D2F48SEA0

Functions

Table 7-91 Functions of the EH1D2F48SEA0


Function Description

Basic function Provides forty-eight FE optical ports for


data transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2F48SEA0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-49 Indicators on the EH1D2F48SEA0 panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 205


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-92 Indicators on the EH1D2F48SEA0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-50 Ports on the EH1D2F48SEA0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 100M BASE-X optical ports

100M BASE-X optical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 206


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-93 lists the attributes of a 100M BASE-X optical port.

Table 7-93 100M BASE-X optical port attributes

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details on the optical modules supported
by the EH1D2F48SEA0 and their attributes,
see 9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3u

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-94 Specifications of the EH1D2F48SEA0

Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.54 kg (5.60 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 64 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-95 Ordering information

Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NWJ 48-port 100BASE-X EH1D2F48SEA0


interface card (EA, SFP)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 207


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

7.9.5 EH1D2F48SEC0-48-Port 100BASE-X Interface Card (EC, SFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-96 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2F48SEC0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2F48SEC0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-51 Appearance of the EH1D2F48SEC0

Functions

Table 7-97 Functions of the EH1D2F48SEC0


Function Description

Basic function Provides forty-eight FE optical ports for


data transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2F48SEC0 is hot swappable.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 208


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-52 Indicators on the EH1D2F48SEC0 panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Table 7-98 Indicators on the EH1D2F48SEC0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 209


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-53 Ports on the EH1D2F48SEC0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 100M BASE-X optical ports

100M BASE-X optical port

Table 7-99 lists the attributes of a 100M BASE-X optical port.

Table 7-99 100M BASE-X optical port attributes

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details on the optical modules supported
by the EH1D2F48SEC0 and their attributes,
see 9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3u

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-100 Specifications of the EH1D2F48SEC0

Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.66 kg (5.86 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 76 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 210


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-101 Ordering information

Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NWK 48-port 100BASE-X EH1D2F48SEC0


interface card (EC, SFP)

7.10 1000M Interface Cards

7.10.1 EH1D2G24SSA0-24-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card


(SA, SFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-102 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2G24SSA0 Supported only in V200R001C00,


V200R002C00, and V200R003C00

Introduction
The EH1D2G24SSA0 can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-54 Appearance of the EH1D2G24SSA0

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 211


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-103 Functions of the EH1D2G24SSA0


Function Description

Basic function Provides twenty-four GE optical ports for


data transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2G24SSA0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-55 Indicators on the EH1D2G24SSA0 panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Table 7-104 Indicators on the EH1D2G24SSA0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 212


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-56 Ports on the EH1D2G24SSA0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Twenty-four 100/1000BASE-X optical ports

100/1000BASE-X optical ports


Table 7-105 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with an optical module
installed.

Table 7-105 100/1000BASE-X optical port attributes (GE optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details about optical modules supported
by the EH1D2G24SSA0 and their attributes,
see 9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules,
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 213


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-106 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with a copper module
installed.

Table 7-106 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-107 Specifications of the EH1D2G24SSA0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.22 kg (4.89 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 45 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 214


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-108 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NWV 24-port 100/1000BASE-X EH1D2G24SSA0


interface card (SA, SFP)

7.10.2 ET1D2G24SEC0-24-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card


(EC, SFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-109 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2G24SEC0 Supported only in V200R012C00 and


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2G24SEC0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-57 Appearance of the ET1D2G24SEC0

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 215


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-110 Functions of the ET1D2G24SEC0


Function Description

Basic function Provides twenty-four GE optical ports for


data transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2G24SEC0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-58 Indicators on the ET1D2G24SEC0 panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Table 7-111 Indicators on the ET1D2G24SEC0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 216


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-59 Ports on the ET1D2G24SEC0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Twenty-four 100/1000BASE-X optical ports

100/1000BASE-X optical ports


Table 7-112 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with an optical module
installed.

Table 7-112 100/1000BASE-X optical port attributes (GE optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details about optical modules supported
by the ET1D2G24SEC0 and their attributes,
see 9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules,
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 217


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-113 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with a copper module
installed.

Table 7-113 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-114 Specifications of the ET1D2G24SEC0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 i. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.66 kg (5.86 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 63 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 218


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-115 Ordering information

Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030SGL 24-port 100/1000BASE-X ET1D2G24SEC0


interface card (EC, SFP)

7.10.3 EH1D2G24SEC0-24-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card


(EC, SFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-116 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2G24SEC0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2G24SEC0 can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-60 Appearance of the EH1D2G24SEC0

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 219


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-117 Functions of the EH1D2G24SEC0


Function Description

Basic function Provides twenty-four GE optical ports for


data transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2G24SEC0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-61 Indicators on the EH1D2G24SEC0 panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Table 7-118 Indicators on the EH1D2G24SEC0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 220


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-62 Ports on the EH1D2G24SEC0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Twenty-four 100/1000BASE-X optical ports

100/1000BASE-X optical ports


Table 7-119 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with an optical module
installed.

Table 7-119 100/1000BASE-X optical port attributes (GE optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details about optical modules supported
by the EH1D2G24SEC0 and their attributes,
see 9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules,
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 221


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-120 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with a copper module
installed.

Table 7-120 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-121 Specifications of the EH1D2G24SEC0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 i. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.66 kg (5.86 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 63 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 222


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-122 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NWG 24-port 100/1000BASE-X EH1D2G24SEC0


interface card (EC, SFP)

7.10.4 EH1D2G24SED0-24-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card


(ED, SFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-123 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2G24SED0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2G24SED0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-63 Appearance of the EH1D2G24SED0

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 223


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-124 Functions of the EH1D2G24SED0


Function Description

Basic function Provides twenty-four GE optical ports for


data transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2G24SED0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-64 Indicators on the EH1D2G24SED0 panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Table 7-125 Indicators on the EH1D2G24SED0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 224


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-65 Ports on the EH1D2G24SED0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Twenty-four 100/1000BASE-X optical ports

100/1000BASE-X optical ports

Table 7-126 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with an optical module
installed.

Table 7-126 100/1000BASE-X optical port attributes (GE optical module)

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details about optical modules supported
by the EH1D2G24SED0 and their
attributes, see 9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical
Modules, 9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules,
9.7 GE-CWDM eSFP Optical Modules,
and 9.8 GE-DWDM eSFP Optical
Modules.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 225


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-127 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with a copper module
installed.

Table 7-127 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-128 Specifications of the EH1D2G24SED0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.66 kg (5.86 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 75 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 226


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-129 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NWH 24-port 100/1000BASE-X EH1D2G24SED0


interface card (ED, SFP)

7.10.5 EH1D2S24CSA0-24-Port 100/1000BASE-X and 8-Port


10/100/1000BASE-T Combo Interface Card (SA, SFP/RJ45)

Version Mapping

Table 7-130 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2S24CSA0 Supported only in V200R001C00,


V200R002C00, and V200R003C00

Introduction
The EH1D2S24CSA0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-66 Appearance of the EH1D2S24CSA0

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 227


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-131 Functions of the EH1D2S24CSA0

Function Description

Basic function Provides line-rate switching on sixteen GE


optical ports and eight combo ports. The
combo ports can be configured as either
optical ports or electrical ports.
NOTE
A maximum of twenty-four ports, that is, sixteen
GE optical ports and eight combo ports, can
work at the same time on the EH1D2S24CSA0.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2S24CSA0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-67 Indicators on the EH1D2S24CSA0 panel


1 2 46 7
RUN/ALM

COMBO
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23

35

Table 7-132 Indicators on the EH1D2S24CSA0 panel

Number Indicator Color Description

1 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.
2 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

3 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 228


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

4 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

6 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

7 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-68 Ports on the EH1D2S24CSA0 panel


1 2
RUN/ALM

COMBO
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23

1 Eight combo ports. Each combo port consists of a 10/100/1000BASE-T


port and a 100/1000BASE-X port.
2 Sixteen 100/1000BASE-X optical ports

Combo

A combo port is a dual-purpose port consisting of an Ethernet optical port and an Ethernet
electrical port. The electrical and optical ports of a combo port are multiplexed, and only one
of them can work at a time.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 229


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

NOTE

A combo port can work in any of the following modes: auto (selects working mode automatically), fiber
(optical port), and copper (electrical port). You can run the combo-port command to configure the
working mode of a combo port. By default, a combo port works in auto mode. In this mode, a combo
port determines the working port in the following way:
l If the combo port only has an Ethernet cable connected, the electrical port of the combo port is the
working port after the combo port goes Up.
l If the combo port has an optical module installed, the optical port of the combo port is the working
port after the combo port goes Up, regardless of whether an Ethernet cable is connected to combo
port.

Table 7-133 lists the attributes of a 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port.

Table 7-133 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port attributes

Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-134 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port.

Table 7-134 100/1000BASE-X optical port attributes

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details about optical modules supported
by the EH1D2S24CSA0 and their attributes,
see 9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules,
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

100/1000BASE-X optical ports

Table 7-135 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with an optical module
installed.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 230


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-135 Optical port attributes (optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details about optical modules supported
by the EH1D2S24CSA0 and their attributes,
see 9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules,
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-136 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with a copper module
installed.

Table 7-136 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 231


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-137 Specifications of the EH1D2S24CSA0

Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.26 kg (5.86 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 67 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-138 Ordering information

Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NWW 24-port 100/1000BASE-X EH1D2S24CSA0


and 8-port
10/100/1000BASE-T combo
interface card (SA, SFP/
RJ45)

7.10.6 EH1D2S24CEA0-24-Port 100/1000BASE-X and 8-Port


10/100/1000BASE-T Combo Interface Card(EA, SFP/RJ45, 1588)

Version Mapping

Table 7-139 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2S24CEA0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 232


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Introduction
The EH1D2S24CEA0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-69 Appearance of the EH1D2S24CEA0

Functions

Table 7-140 Functions of the EH1D2S24CEA0


Function Description

Basic function The EH1D2S24CEA0 provides line-rate


switching on sixteen GE optical ports and
eight GE combo ports. The combo ports can
be configured as either optical ports or
electrical ports.
NOTE
A maximum of twenty-four ports, that is, sixteen
GE optical ports and eight combo ports, can
work at the same time on the EH1D2S24CEA0.

Synchronous Ethernet The 100 Mbit/s optical/electrical ports and


GE optical ports of the EH1D2S24CEA0
support the synchronous Ethernet function.
When a combo port works as a GE
electrical port, it does not support the
synchronous Ethernet function.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot Swap The EH1D2S24CEA0 is hot swappable.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 233


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Usage Constraints

To use the synchronous Ethernet function on the EH1D2S24CEA0, make sure a clock
daughter card is running on the device.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-70 Indicators on the EH1D2S24CEA0 panel


1 2 46 7
RUN/ALM

COMBO
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23

35

Table 7-141 Indicators on the EH1D2S24CEA0 panel

Number Indicator Color Description

1 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.
2 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

3 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

4 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

6 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 234


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

7 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-71 Ports on the EH1D2S24CEA0 panel


1 2
RUN/ALM

COMBO
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23

1 Eight combo ports. Each combo port consists of a 10/100/1000BASE-T


port and a 100/1000BASE-X port.
2 Sixteen 100/1000BASE-X optical ports

Combo ports
A combo port is a dual-purpose port consisting of an Ethernet optical port and an Ethernet
electrical port. The electrical and optical ports of a combo port are multiplexed, and only one
of them can work at a time.
NOTE

A combo port can work in any of the following modes: auto (selects working mode automatically), fiber
(optical port), and copper (electrical port). You can run the combo-port command to configure the
working mode of a combo port. By default, a combo port works in auto mode. In this mode, a combo
port determines the working port in the following way:
l If the combo port only has an Ethernet cable connected, the electrical port of the combo port is the
working port after the combo port goes Up.
l If the combo port has an optical module installed, the optical port of the combo port is the working
port after the combo port goes Up, regardless of whether an Ethernet cable is connected to combo
port.

Table 7-142 lists the attributes of a 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 235


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-142 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port attributes

Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-143 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port.

Table 7-143 100/1000BASE-X optical port attributes

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details about optical modules supported
by the EH1D2S24CEA0 and their attributes,
see 9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules,
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

100/1000BASE-X optical ports

Table 7-144 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with an optical module
installed.

Table 7-144 Optical port attributes (optical module)

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details about optical modules supported
by the EH1D2S24CEA0 and their attributes,
see 9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules,
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 236


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-145 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with a copper module
installed.

Table 7-145 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-146 Specifications of the EH1D2S24CEA0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 i. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.70 kg (5.95 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 75 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 237


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-147 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NXD 24-port 100/1000BASE-X EH1D2S24CEA0


and 8-port
10/100/1000BASE-T combo
interface card (EA, SFP/
RJ45, 1588)

7.10.7 ET1D2G24SX5E-24-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card


(X5E, SFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-148 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2G24SX5E Supported only in V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2G24SX5E can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-72 Appearance of the ET1D2G24SX5E

Functions
The ET1D2G24SX5E provides the following functions:

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 238


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

l Communicates with the MPU and works under the control of the MPU.
l Searches for routes and destination addresses of data packets for forwarding.
l Forwards data packets.

Table 7-149 Functions of the ET1D2G24SX5E

Function Description

Basic functions Provides twenty-four GE optical ports for


data access and line-rate switching.

Forwarding speed 24 Gbit/s

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2G24SX5E is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-73 Indicators on the ET1D2G24SX5E panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Table 7-150 Indicators on the ET1D2G24SX5E panel

Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 239


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-74 Ports on the ET1D2G24SX5E panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Twenty-four 100/1000BASE-X ports

100/1000BASE-X port
Table 7-151 describes the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X port with an optical module
installed.

Table 7-151 Optical port attributes (optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For optical modules supported by the
ET1D2G24SX5E and their attributes, see
9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules, 9.5
GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 240


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-152 describes the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X port with a copper module
installed.

Table 7-152 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-153 Specifications of the ET1D2G24SX5E


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.82 kg (6.22 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 84 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 241


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-154 Ordering information


Part Number Card Name Card Model

03032YEB 24-port 100/1000BASE-X ET1D2G24SX5E


interface card (X5E, SFP)

7.10.8 ET1D2T36SEA0-36-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T and 12-Port


100/1000BASE-X Interface Card (EA, RJ45/SFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-155 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2T36SEA0 Supported only in V200R012C00 and


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2T36SEA0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-75 Appearance of the ET1D2T36SEA0

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 242


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-156 Functions of the ET1D2T36SEA0


Function Description

Basic function Provides thirty-six 10M/100M/1000M


Ethernet electrical ports and twelve 100M/
1000M Ethernet optical ports for data
transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot Swap The ET1D2T36SEA0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-76 Indicators on the ET1D2T36SEA0 panel


24 5 6 7
RUN/ALM

13

Table 7-157 Indicators on the ET1D2T36SEA0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical
port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 243


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

6 LINK/ACT Blinking: The port is transmitting


indicator of a and receiving data.
lower electrical
port

7 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-77 Ports on the ET1D2T36SEA0 panel


1 2

RUN/ALM

1 Twelve 100/1000BASE-X optical ports


2 Thirty-six 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical ports

100/1000BASE-X optical ports


Table 7-158 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with an optical module
installed.

Table 7-158 Optical port attributes (optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 244


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details about optical modules supported
by the ET1D2T36SEA0 and their attributes,
see 9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules,
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-159 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with a copper module
installed.

Table 7-159 Optical port attributes (copper module)

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

10/100/1000BASE-T electrical ports

Table 7-160 lists the attributes of a 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port.

Table 7-160 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port attributes

Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 245


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-161 Specifications of the ET1D2T36SEA0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.50 kg (5.51 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 62 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-162 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030SGX 36-port 10/100/1000BASE- ET1D2T36SEA0


T and 12-port
100/1000BASE-X interface
card (EA, RJ45/SFP)

7.10.9 EH1D2T36SEA0-36-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T and 12-Port


100/1000BASE-X Interface Card (EA, RJ45/SFP)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 246


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Version Mapping

Table 7-163 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2T36SEA0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2T36SEA0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-78 Appearance of the EH1D2T36SEA0

Functions

Table 7-164 Functions of the EH1D2T36SEA0


Function Description

Basic function Provides thirty-six 10M/100M/1000M


Ethernet electrical ports and twelve 100M/
1000M Ethernet optical ports for data
transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot Swap The EH1D2T36SEA0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-79 Indicators on the EH1D2T36SEA0 panel


24 5 6 7
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47

13

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 247


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-165 Indicators on the EH1D2T36SEA0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.
6 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

7 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 248


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-80 Ports on the EH1D2T36SEA0 panel


1 2
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47

1 Twelve 100/1000BASE-X optical ports


2 Thirty-six 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical ports

100/1000BASE-X optical ports


Table 7-166 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with an optical module
installed.

Table 7-166 Optical port attributes (optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details about optical modules supported
by the EH1D2T36SEA0 and their attributes,
see 9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules,
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-167 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with a copper module
installed.

Table 7-167 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 249


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

10/100/1000BASE-T electrical ports


Table 7-168 lists the attributes of a 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port.

Table 7-168 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-169 Specifications of the EH1D2T36SEA0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.50 kg (5.51 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 62 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 250


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-170 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NXE 36-port 10/100/1000BASE- EH1D2T36SEA0


T and 12-port
100/1000BASE-X interface
card (EA, RJ45/SFP)

7.10.10 ET1D2G48TEA0-48-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Interface Card


(EA, RJ45)

Version Mapping

Table 7-171 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2G48TEA0 Supported only in V200R012C00 and


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2G48TEA0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-81 Appearance of the ET1D2G48TEA0

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 251


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-172 Functions of the ET1D2G48TEA0

Function Description

Basic function Provides forty-eight GE electrical ports for


data transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2G48TEA0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-82 Indicators on the ET1D2G48TEA0 panel


12 3
RUN/ALM

Table 7-173 Indicators on the ET1D2G48TEA0 panel

Number Indicator Color Description

1 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.
2 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 252


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-83 Ports on the ET1D2G48TEA0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical ports

10/100/1000BASE-T electrical ports


Table 7-174 lists the attributes of a 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port.

Table 7-174 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 253


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-175 Specifications of the ET1D2G48TEA0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.50 kg (5.51 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 62 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-176 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030SGN 48-port 10/100/1000BASE- ET1D2G48TEA0


T interface card (EA, RJ45)

7.10.11 EH1D2G24TFA0-24-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Interface


Card (FA, RJ45)

Version Mapping

Table 7-177 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2G24TFA0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2G24TFA0 can be installed in:

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 254


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-84 Appearance of the EH1D2G24TFA0

Functions

Table 7-178 Functions of the EH1D2G24TFA0


Function Description

Basic function Provides twenty-four 10M/100M/1000M


Ethernet electrical ports for data
transmission and line-rate switching.

Energy Efficient Ethernet (EEE) The EEE mode can dynamically adjust
power consumption based on network
traffic volume.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2G24TFA0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-85 Indicators on the EH1D2G24TFA0 panel


1 2 3
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 255


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-179 Indicators on the EH1D2G24TFA0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.
2 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-86 Ports on the EH1D2G24TFA0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23

1 Twenty-four 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical ports

10/100/1000BASE-T electrical ports


Table 7-180 lists the attributes of a 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 256


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-180 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE802.3ab and IEEE802.3az

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-181 Specifications of the EH1D2G24TFA0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.20 kg (4.85 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 32 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-182 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NXL 24-port 10/100/1000BASE- EH1D2G24TFA0


T interface card (FA, RJ45)

7.10.12 EH1D2G48TEA0-48-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Interface


Card (EA, RJ45)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 257


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Version Mapping

Table 7-183 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2G48TEA0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2G48TEA0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-87 Appearance of the EH1D2G48TEA0

Functions

Table 7-184 Functions of the EH1D2G48TEA0


Function Description

Basic function Provides forty-eight GE electrical ports for


data transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2G48TEA0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-88 Indicators on the EH1D2G48TEA0 panel


12 3
RUN/ALM

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 258


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-185 Indicators on the EH1D2G48TEA0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.
2 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-89 Ports on the EH1D2G48TEA0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical ports

10/100/1000BASE-T electrical ports


Table 7-186 lists the attributes of a 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 259


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-186 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-187 Specifications of the EH1D2G48TEA0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.50 kg (5.51 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 62 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-188 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NWL 48-port 10/100/1000BASE- EH1D2G48TEA0


T interface card (EA, RJ45)

7.10.13 ET1D2G48TEC0-48-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Interface Card


(EC, RJ45)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 260


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Version Mapping

Table 7-189 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2G48TEC0 Supported only in V200R012C00 and


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2G48TEC0 can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-90 Appearance of the ET1D2G48TEC0

Functions

Table 7-190 Functions f the ET1D2G48TEC0


Function Description

Basic function Provides forty-eight GE electrical ports for


data transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2G48TEC0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-91 Indicators on the ET1D2G48TEC0 panel


12 3
RUN/ALM

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 261


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-191 Indicators on the ET1D2G48TEC0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.
2 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-92 Ports on the ET1D2G48TEC0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical ports

10/100/1000BASE-T electrical ports


Table 7-192 lists the attributes of a 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 262


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-192 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-193 Specifications of the ET1D2G48TEC0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.66 kg (5.86 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 68 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-194 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030SGP 48-port 10/100/1000BASE- ET1D2G48TEC0


T interface card (EC, RJ45)

7.10.14 EH1D2G48TEC0-48-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Interface


Card (EC, RJ45)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 263


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Version Mapping

Table 7-195 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2G48TEC0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2G48TEC0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-93 Appearance of the EH1D2G48TEC0

Functions

Table 7-196 Functions of the EH1D2G48TEC0


Function Description

Basic function Provides forty-eight GE electrical ports for


data transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2G48TEC0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-94 Indicators on the EH1D2G48TEC0 panel


12 3
RUN/ALM

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 264


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-197 Indicators on the EH1D2G48TEC0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.
2 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-95 Ports on the EH1D2G48TEC0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical ports

10/100/1000BASE-T electrical ports


Table 7-198 lists the attributes of a 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 265


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-198 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-199 Specifications of the EH1D2G48TEC0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.66 kg (5.86 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 68 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-200 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NWM 48-port 10/100/1000BASE- EH1D2G48TEC0


T interface card (EC, RJ45)

7.10.15 EH1D2G48TED0-48-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Interface


Card (ED, RJ45)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 266


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Version Mapping

Table 7-201 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2G48TED0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2G48TED0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-96 Appearance of the EH1D2G48TED0

Functions

Table 7-202 Functions of the EH1D2G48TED0


Function Description

Basic function Provides forty-eight GE electrical ports for


data transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2G48TED0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-97 Indicators on the EH1D2G48TED0 panel


12 3
RUN/ALM

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 267


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-203 Indicators on the EH1D2G48TED0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.
2 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-98 Ports on the EH1D2G48TED0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical ports

10/100/1000BASE-T electrical ports


Table 7-204 lists the attributes of a 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 268


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-204 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-205 Specifications of the EH1D2G48TED0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.66 kg (5.86 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 98 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-206 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NWN 48-port 10/100/1000BASE- EH1D2G48TED0


T interface card (ED, RJ45)

7.10.16 EH1D2G48TFA0-48-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Interface


Card (FA, RJ45)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 269


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Version Mapping

Table 7-207 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2G48TFA0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2G48TFA0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-99 Appearance of the EH1D2G48TFA0

Functions

Table 7-208 Functions of the EH1D2G48TFA0


Function Description

Basic function Provides forty-eight GE electrical ports for


data transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2G48TFA0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-100 Indicators on the EH1D2G48TFA0 panel


12 3
RUN/ALM

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 270


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-209 Indicators on the EH1D2G48TFA0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.
2 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-101 Ports on the EH1D2G48TFA0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical ports

10/100/1000BASE-T electrical ports


Table 7-210 lists the attributes of a 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 271


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-210 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-211 Specifications of the EH1D2G48TFA0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.50 kg (5.51 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 48 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-212 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NXH 48-port 10/100/1000BASE- EH1D2G48TFA0


T interface card (FA, RJ45)

7.10.17 ET1D2G48TX1E-48-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Interface Card


(X1E, RJ45)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 272


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Version Mapping

Table 7-213 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2G48TX1E Supported only in V200R012C00 and


V200R013C00

Introduction
The provides high performance, large entry sizes, and a large buffer for data switching. This
card is highly integrated and has a large port density.
The can be installed in:
The ET1D2G48TX1E can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-102 Appearance of the ET1D2G48TX1E

Functions
The ET1D2G48TX1E provides the following functions:
l Communicates with the MPU and works under the control of the MPU.
l Searches for routes and destination addresses of data packets for forwarding.
l Forwards data packets.

Table 7-214 Functions of the ET1D2G48TX1E


Function Description

Basic functions Provides forty-eight GE electrical ports for


data access and line-rate switching.

Forwarding speed 48 Gbit/s

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2G48TX1E is hot swappable.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 273


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-103 Indicators on the ET1D2G48TX1E panel


12 3
RUN/ALM

Table 7-215 Indicators on the ET1D2G48TX1E panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.
2 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-104 Ports on the ET1D2G48TX1E panel


1
RUN/ALM

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 274


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

1 Forty-eight 10/100/1000BASE-T ports

10/100/1000BASE-T port
Table 7-216 describes the attributes of a 10/100/1000BASE-T port.

Table 7-216 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-217 Specifications of the ET1D2G48TX1E


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.92 kg (6.44 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 120 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 275


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-218 Ordering information


Part Number Card Name Card Model

03030SGE 48-port 10/100/1000BASE- ET1D2G48TX1E


T interface card (X1E,
RJ45)

7.10.18 EH1D2G48TX1E-48-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Interface


Card (X1E, RJ45)

Version Mapping

Table 7-219 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2G48TX1E Supported in V200R005C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2G48TX1E provides high performance, large entry sizes, and a large buffer for
data switching. This card is highly integrated and has a large port density.

The EH1D2G48TX1E can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-105 Appearance of the EH1D2G48TX1E

Functions
The EH1D2G48TX1E provides the following functions:
l Communicates with the MPU and works under the control of the MPU.
l Searches for routes and destination addresses of data packets for forwarding.
l Forwards data packets.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 276


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-220 Functions of the EH1D2G48TX1E


Function Description

Basic functions Provides forty-eight GE electrical ports for


data access and line-rate switching.

Forwarding speed 48 Gbit/s

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2G48TX1E is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-106 Indicators on the EH1D2G48TX1E panel


12 3
RUN/ALM

Table 7-221 Indicators on the EH1D2G48TX1E panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.
2 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 277


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-107 Ports on the EH1D2G48TX1E panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 10/100/1000BASE-T ports

10/100/1000BASE-T port
Table 7-222 describes the attributes of a 10/100/1000BASE-T port.

Table 7-222 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-223 Specifications of the EH1D2G48TX1E


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.92 kg (6.44 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 120 W

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 278


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Item Description

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-224 Ordering information


Part Number Card Name Card Model

03030RPK 48-port 10/100/1000BASE- EH1D2G48TX1E


T interface card (X1E,
RJ45)

7.10.19 EH1D2G48TBC0-48-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Interface


Card (BC, RJ45)

Version Mapping

Table 7-225 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2G48TBC0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2G48TBC0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-108 Appearance of the EH1D2G48TBC0

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 279


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-226 Functions of the EH1D2G48TBC0


Function Description

Basic function Provides forty-eight 10M/100M/1000M


Ethernet electrical ports for data
transmission and line-rate switching.
Capable of handling 50 Gbit/s traffic.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2G48TBC0 is hot swappable.

Application
The EH1D2G48TBC0 and EH1D2G48SBC0 of the S9700 have a large buffer capacity. The
1.25 GB buffer capacity on each port achieves 200 ms buffering, which prevents packet loss
caused by traffic bursts on a network. When the network is congested and traffic bursts occur,
the large-buffer cards can effectively buffer traffic on ports. The large buffer capacity,
combined with QoS traffic shaping, ensures even, stable traffic transmission on a congested,
unstable network. These cards prevent packet loss while reducing congestion and traffic
bursts on upstream devices.
The large-buffer cards apply to data center networks and video networks:
l When used on a data center network, these cards ensure fast, stable, and low-latency data
forwarding.
l When used on a video network, these cards can prevent voice/image distortion, delay,
and asynchronous image and voice presence caused by packet loss and transmission
latency, guaranteeing high-quality video conferences.
The following uses a collaborative computing scenario as an example to describe application
of these cards in a data center.
Complicated computing tasks, such as search engine computing, oil exploration computing,
and meteorological computing, must be carried out by multiple servers simultaneously. In this
situation, the servers perform collaborative computing, which results in fast transmission of
data flows on a network and traffic bursts when multiple servers send computing data to one
server at the same time. Traffic bursts cause congestion on network nodes, as shown in Figure
7-109. Packets are dropped on congested network nodes.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 280


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-109 Traffic bursts caused by collaborative computing in EoR deployment

Router Congestion point

Data flow
Core switch
CSS

Aggregation
switch

Server

As shown in Figure 7-110, all switches from the end of row (EoR) switches to core switches
in a data center are equipped with large-buffer cards. These large-buffer cards prevent packet
loss caused by traffic bursts in the data center.

Figure 7-110 Large-buffer cards deployed in a data center

Router
Large-buffer
Core switch card deployed

CSS

Aggregation
switch

Server

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-111 Indicators on the EH1D2G48TBC0 panel


12 3
RUN/ALM

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 281


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-227 Indicators on the EH1D2G48TBC0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.
2 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-112 Ports on the EH1D2G48TBC0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical ports

10/100/1000BASE-T electrical ports


Table 7-228 lists the attributes of a 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 282


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-228 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-229 Specifications of the EH1D2G48TBC0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.90 kg (6.39 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 160 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-230 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NXK 48-port 10/100/1000BASE- EH1D2G48TBC0


T interface card (BC, RJ45)

7.10.20 ET1D2G48TX5E-48-port 100/1000BASE-T interface card


(X5E, RJ45)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 283


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Version Mapping

Table 7-231 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2G48TX5E Supported only in V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2G48TX5E provides high performance, large entry sizes, and a large buffer for data
switching. This card is highly integrated and has a large port density.

The ET1D2G48TX5E can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-113 Appearance of the ET1D2G48TX5E

Functions
The ET1D2G48TX5E provides the following functions:
l Communicates with the MPU and works under the control of the MPU.
l Searches for routes and destination addresses of data packets for forwarding.
l Forwards data packets.

Table 7-232 Functions of the ET1D2G48TX5E

Function Description

Basic functions Provides forty-eight GE electrical ports for


data access and line-rate switching.

Forwarding speed 48 Gbit/s

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2G48TX5E is hot swappable.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 284


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-114 Indicators on the ET1D2G48TX5E panel


12 3
RUN/ALM

Table 7-233 Indicators on the ET1D2G48TX5E panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.
2 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-115 Ports on the ET1D2G48TX5E panel


1
RUN/ALM

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 285


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

1 Forty-eight 100/1000BASE-T ports

100/1000BASE-T port

Table 7-234 describes the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-T port.

Table 7-234 100/1000BASE-T electrical port attributes

Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-235 Specifications of the ET1D2G48TX5E

Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.06 kg (6.75 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 60 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-236 Ordering information

Part Number Card Name Card Model

03032WSL 48-port 100/1000BASE-T ET1D2G48TX5E


interface card (X5E, RJ45)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 286


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

7.10.21 ET1D2G48TX5H-48-port 100/1000BASE-T interface card


(X5H, RJ45)

Version Mapping

Table 7-237 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2G48TX5H Supported only in V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2G48TX5H provides high performance, large entry sizes, and a large buffer for
data switching. This card is highly integrated and has a large port density.

The ET1D2G48TX5H can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-116 Appearance of the ET1D2G48TX5H

Functions
The ET1D2G48TX5H provides the following functions:
l Communicates with the MPU and works under the control of the MPU.
l Searches for routes and destination addresses of data packets for forwarding.
l Forwards data packets.

Table 7-238 Functions of the ET1D2G48TX5H

Function Description

Basic functions Provides forty-eight GE electrical ports for


data access and line-rate switching.

Forwarding speed 48 Gbit/s

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 287


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Function Description

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2G48TX5H is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-117 Indicators on the ET1D2G48TX5H panel


12 3
RUN/ALM

Table 7-239 Indicators on the ET1D2G48TX5H panel

Number Indicator Color Description

1 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.
2 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 288


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-118 Ports on the ET1D2G48TX5H panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 100/1000BASE-T ports

100/1000BASE-T port

Table 7-240 describes the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-T port.

Table 7-240 100/1000BASE-T electrical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-241 Specifications of the ET1D2G48TX5H


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.3 kg (7.28 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 107 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 289


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-242 Ordering information

Part Number Card Name Card Model

03032WSK 48-port 100/1000BASE-T ET1D2G48TX5H


interface card (X5H, RJ45)

7.10.22 ET1D2G48TX5S-48-port 100/1000BASE-T interface card


(X5S, RJ45)

Version Mapping

Table 7-243 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2G48TX5S Supported only in V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2G48TX5S provides high performance, large entry sizes, and a large buffer for data
switching. This card is highly integrated and has a large port density.

The ET1D2G48TX5S can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-119 Appearance of the ET1D2G48TX5S

Functions
The ET1D2G48TX5S provides the following functions:
l Communicates with the MPU and works under the control of the MPU.
l Searches for routes and destination addresses of data packets for forwarding.
l Forwards data packets.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 290


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-244 Functions of the ET1D2G48TX5S


Function Description

Basic functions Provides forty-eight GE electrical ports for


data access and line-rate switching.

Forwarding speed 48 Gbit/s

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2G48TX5S is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-120 Indicators on the ET1D2G48TX5S panel


12 3
RUN/ALM

Table 7-245 Indicators on the ET1D2G48TX5S panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.
2 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 291


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-121 Ports on the ET1D2G48TX5S panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 100/1000BASE-T ports

100/1000BASE-T port
Table 7-246 describes the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-T port.

Table 7-246 100/1000BASE-T electrical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-247 Specifications of the ET1D2G48TX5S


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.06 kg (6.75 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 60 W

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 292


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Item Description

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-248 Ordering information


Part Number Card Name Card Model

03032WSG 48-port 100/1000BASE-T ET1D2G48TX5S


interface card (X5S, RJ45)

7.10.23 ET1D2G48SEA0-48-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card


(EA, SFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-249 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2G48SEA0 Supported only in V200R012C00 and


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2G48SEA0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-122 Appearance of the ET1D2G48SEA0

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 293


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-250 Functions of the ET1D2G48SEA0


Function Description

Basic function Provides forty-eight GE optical ports for


data transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2G48SEA0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-123 Indicators on the ET1D2G48SEA0 panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Table 7-251 Indicators on the ET1D2G48SEA0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 294


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-124 Ports on the ET1D2G48SEA0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 100/1000BASE-X optical ports

100/1000BASE-X optical ports


Table 7-252 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with an optical module
installed.

Table 7-252 Optical port attributes (optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details about optical modules supported
by the ET1D2G48SEA0 and its attributes,
see 9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules,
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 295


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-253 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with a copper module
installed.

Table 7-253 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-254 Specifications of the ET1D2G48SEA0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.54 kg (5.60 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 75 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 296


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-255 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030SGH 48-port 100/1000BASE-X ET1D2G48SEA0


interface card (EA, SFP)

7.10.24 EH1D2G48SEA0-48-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card


(EA, SFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-256 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2G48SEA0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2G48SEA0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-125 Appearance of the EH1D2G48SEA0

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 297


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-257 Functions of the EH1D2G48SEA0


Function Description

Basic function Provides forty-eight GE optical ports for


data transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2G48SEA0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-126 Indicators on the EH1D2G48SEA0 panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Table 7-258 Indicators on the EH1D2G48SEA0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 298


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-127 Ports on the EH1D2G48SEA0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 100/1000BASE-X optical ports

100/1000BASE-X optical ports

Table 7-259 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with an optical module
installed.

Table 7-259 Optical port attributes (optical module)

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details about optical modules supported
by the EH1D2G48SEA0 and its attributes,
see 9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules,
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 299


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-260 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with a copper module
installed.

Table 7-260 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-261 Specifications of the EH1D2G48SEA0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.54 kg (5.60 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 75 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 300


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-262 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NWD 48-port 100/1000BASE-X EH1D2G48SEA0


interface card (EA, SFP)

7.10.25 ET1D2G48SEC0-48-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card


(EC, SFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-263 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2G48SEC0 Supported only in V200R012C00 and


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2G48SEC0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-128 ET1D2G48SEC0

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 301


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-264 Functions of the ET1D2G48SEC0


Function Description

Basic function Provides forty-eight GE optical ports for


data transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2G48SEC0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-129 Indicators on the ET1D2G48SEC0 panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Table 7-265 Indicators on the ET1D2G48SEC0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 302


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-130 Ports on the ET1D2G48SEC0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 100/1000BASE-X optical ports

100/1000BASE-X optical ports


Table 7-266 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with an optical module
installed.

Table 7-266 Optical port attributes (optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details about optical modules supported
by the ET1D2G48SEC0 and its attributes,
see 9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules,
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 303


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-267 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with a copper module
installed.

Table 7-267 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-268 Specifications of the ET1D2G48SEC0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.66 kg (5.86 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 92 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 304


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-269 Ordering information

Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030SGJ 48-port 100/1000BASE-X ET1D2G48SEC0


interface card (EC, SFP)

7.10.26 EH1D2G48SED0-48-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card


(ED, SFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-270 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2G48SED0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2G48SED0 can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-131 Appearance of the EH1D2G48SED0

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 305


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-271 Functions of the EH1D2G48SED0


Function Description

Basic function Provides forty-eight GE optical ports for


data transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2G48SED0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-132 Indicators on the EH1D2G48SED0 panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Table 7-272 Indicators on the EH1D2G48SED0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 306


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-133 Ports on the EH1D2G48SED0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 100/1000BASE-X optical ports

100/1000BASE-X optical ports

Table 7-273 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with an optical module
installed.

Table 7-273 Optical port attributes (optical module)

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details about optical modules supported
by the EH1D2G48SED0 and its attributes,
see 9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules,
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 307


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-274 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with a copper module
installed.

Table 7-274 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-275 Specifications of the EH1D2G48SED0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.66 kg (5.86 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 110 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 308


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-276 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NWF 48-port 100/1000BASE-X EH1D2G48SED0


interface card (ED, SFP)

7.10.27 EH1D2G48SFA0-48-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card


(FA, SFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-277 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2G48SFA0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2G48SFA0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-134 Appearance of the EH1D2G48SFA0

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 309


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-278 Functions of the EH1D2G48SFA0


Function Description

Basic function Provides forty-eight GE optical ports for


data transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2G48SFA0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-135 Indicators on the EH1D2G48SFA0 panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Table 7-279 Indicators on the EH1D2G48SFA0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 310


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-136 Ports on the EH1D2G48SFA0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 100/1000BASE-X optical ports

100/1000BASE-X optical ports

Table 7-280 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with an optical module
installed.

Table 7-280 Optical port attributes (optical module)

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details about optical modules supported
by the EH1D2G48SFA0 and its attributes,
see 9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules,
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 311


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-281 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with a copper module
installed.

Table 7-281 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-282 Specifications of the EH1D2G48SFA0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.60 kg (5.73 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 65 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 312


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-283 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NXG 48-port 100/1000BASE-X EH1D2G48SFA0


interface card (FA, SFP)

7.10.28 EH1D2G48SBC0-48-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card


(BC, SFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-284 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2G48SBC0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2G48SBC0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-137 Appearance of the EH1D2G48SBC0

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 313


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-285 Functions of the EH1D2G48SBC0


Function Description

Basic function Provides forty-eight 100M/1000M optical


ports for data transmission and line-rate
switching.
Capable of handling 50 Gbit/s traffic.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2G48SBC0 is hot swappable.

Application
The EH1D2G48TBC0 and EH1D2G48SBC0 of the S9700 have a large buffer capacity. The
1.25 GB buffer capacity on each port achieves 200 ms buffering, which prevents packet loss
caused by traffic bursts on a network. When the network is congested and traffic bursts occur,
the large-buffer cards can effectively buffer traffic on ports. The large buffer capacity,
combined with QoS traffic shaping, ensures even, stable traffic transmission on a congested,
unstable network. These cards prevent packet loss while reducing congestion and traffic
bursts on upstream devices.
The large-buffer cards apply to data center networks and video networks:
l When used on a data center network, these cards ensure fast, stable, and low-latency data
forwarding.
l When used on a video network, these cards can prevent voice/image distortion, delay,
and asynchronous image and voice presence caused by packet loss and transmission
latency, guaranteeing high-quality video conferences.
The following uses a collaborative computing scenario as an example to describe application
of these cards in a data center.
Complicated computing tasks, such as search engine computing, oil exploration computing,
and meteorological computing, must be carried out by multiple servers simultaneously. In this
situation, the servers perform collaborative computing, which results in fast transmission of
data flows on a network and traffic bursts when multiple servers send computing data to one
server at the same time. Traffic bursts cause congestion on network nodes, as shown in Figure
7-138. Packets are dropped on congested network nodes.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 314


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-138 Traffic bursts caused by collaborative computing in EoR deployment

Router Congestion point

Data flow
Core switch
CSS

Aggregation
switch

Server

As shown in Figure 7-139, all switches from the end of row (EoR) switches to core switches
in a data center are equipped with large-buffer cards. These large-buffer cards prevent packet
loss caused by traffic bursts in the data center.

Figure 7-139 Large-buffer cards deployed in a data center

Router
Large-buffer
Core switch card deployed

CSS

Aggregation
switch

Server

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-140 Indicators on the EH1D2G48SBC0 panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 315


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-286 Indicators on the EH1D2G48SBC0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-141 Ports on the EH1D2G48SBC0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 100/1000BASE-X optical ports

100/1000BASE-X optical ports

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 316


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-287 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with an optical module
installed.

Table 7-287 Optical port attributes (optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details about optical modules supported
by the EH1D2G48SBC0 and their
attributes, see 9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical
Modules, 9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules,
9.7 GE-CWDM eSFP Optical Modules,
and 9.8 GE-DWDM eSFP Optical
Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-288 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with a copper module
installed.

Table 7-288 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 317


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-289 Specifications of the EH1D2G48SBC0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.90 kg (6.39 lb) (excluding the optical module)
l Maximum power consumption: 185 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-290 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NXJ 48-port 100/1000BASE-X EH1D2G48SBC0


interface card (BC, SFP)

7.10.29 ET1D2G48SX1E-48-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card


(X1E, SFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-291 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2G48SX1E Supported only in V200R012C00 and


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2G48SX1E provides high performance, large entry sizes, and a large buffer for data
switching. This card is highly integrated and has a large port density.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 318


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

The ET1D2G48SX1E can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-142 Appearance of the ET1D2G48SX1E

Functions
The ET1D2G48SX1E provides the following functions:
l Communicates with the MPU and works under the control of the MPU.
l Searches for routes and destination addresses of data packets for forwarding.
l Forwards data packets.

Table 7-292 Functions of the ET1D2G48SX1E

Function Description

Basic functions Provides forty-eight GE optical ports for


data access and line-rate switching.

Forwarding speed 48 Gbit/s

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2G48SX1E is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-143 Indicators on the ET1D2G48SX1E panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 319


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-293 Indicators on the ET1D2G48SX1E panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-144 Ports on the ET1D2G48SX1E panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 100/1000BASE-X ports

100/1000BASE-X port
Table 7-294 describes the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X port with an optical module
installed.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 320


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-294 Optical port attributes (optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For optical modules supported by the
ET1D2G48SX1E and their attributes, see
9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules, 9.5
GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-295 describes the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X port with a copper module
installed.

Table 7-295 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 321


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-296 Specifications of the ET1D2G48SX1E


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.04 kg (6.70 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 140 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-297 Ordering information


Part Number Card Name Card Model

03030SGD 48-port 100/1000BASE-X ET1D2G48SX1E


interface card (X1E, SFP)

7.10.30 EH1D2G48SX1E-48-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card


(X1E, SFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-298 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2G48SX1E Supported in V200R005C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2G48SX1E provides high performance, large entry sizes, and a large buffer for
data switching. This card is highly integrated and has a large port density.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 322


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

The EH1D2G48SX1E can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-145 Appearance of the EH1D2G48SX1E

Functions
The EH1D2G48SX1E provides the following functions:
l Communicates with the MPU and works under the control of the MPU.
l Searches for routes and destination addresses of data packets for forwarding.
l Forwards data packets.

Table 7-299 Functions of the EH1D2G48SX1E

Function Description

Basic functions Provides forty-eight GE optical ports for


data access and line-rate switching.

Forwarding speed 48 Gbit/s

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2G48SX1E is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-146 Indicators on the EH1D2G48SX1E panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 323


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-300 Indicators on the EH1D2G48SX1E panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-147 Ports on the EH1D2G48SX1E panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 100/1000BASE-X ports

100/1000BASE-X port
Table 7-301 describes the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X port with an optical module
installed.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 324


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-301 Optical port attributes (optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For optical modules supported by the
EH1D2G48SX1E and their attributes, see
9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules, 9.5
GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-302 describes the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X port with a copper module
installed.

Table 7-302 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 325


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-303 Specifications of the EH1D2G48SX1E


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.04 kg (6.70 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 140 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-304 Ordering information


Part Number Card Name Card Model

03030RPJ 48-port 100/1000BASE-X EH1D2G48SX1E


interface card (X1E, SFP)

7.10.31 ET1D2G48SX5E-48-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card


(X5E, SFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-305 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2G48SX5E Supported only in V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2G48SX5E provides high performance, large entry sizes, and a large buffer for data
switching. This card is highly integrated and has a large port density.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 326


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

The ET1D2G48SX5E can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-148 Appearance of the ET1D2G48SX5E

Functions
The ET1D2G48SX5E provides the following functions:
l Communicates with the MPU and works under the control of the MPU.
l Searches for routes and destination addresses of data packets for forwarding.
l Forwards data packets.

Table 7-306 Functions of the ET1D2G48SX5E

Function Description

Basic functions Provides forty-eight GE optical ports for


data access and line-rate switching.

Forwarding speed 48 Gbit/s

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2G48SX5E is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-149 Indicators on the ET1D2G48SX5E panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 327


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-307 Indicators on the ET1D2G48SX5E panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-150 Ports on the ET1D2G48SX5E panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 100/1000BASE-X ports

100/1000BASE-X port
Table 7-308 describes the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X port with an optical module
installed.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 328


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-308 Optical port attributes (optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For optical modules supported by the
ET1D2G48SX5E and their attributes, see
9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules, 9.5
GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-309 describes the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X port with a copper module
installed.

Table 7-309 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 329


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-310 Specifications of the ET1D2G48SX5E


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.1 kg (6.83 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 110 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-311 Ordering information


Part Number Card Name Card Model

03032WSU 48-Port 100/1000BASE-X ET1D2G48SX5E


Interface Card (X5E, SFP)

7.10.32 ET1D2G48SX5H-48-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card


(X5H, SFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-312 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2G48SX5H Supported only in V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2G48SX5H provides high performance, large entry sizes, and a large buffer for
data switching. This card is highly integrated and has a large port density.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 330


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

The ET1D2G48SX5H can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-151 Appearance of the ET1D2G48SX5H

Functions
The ET1D2G48SX5H provides the following functions:
l Communicates with the MPU and works under the control of the MPU.
l Searches for routes and destination addresses of data packets for forwarding.
l Forwards data packets.

Table 7-313 Functions of the ET1D2G48SX5H

Function Description

Basic functions Provides forty-eight GE optical ports for


data access and line-rate switching.

Forwarding speed 48 Gbit/s

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2G48SX5H is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-152 Indicators on the ET1D2G48SX5H panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 331


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-314 Indicators on the ET1D2G48SX5H panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-153 Ports on the ET1D2G48SX5H panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 100/1000BASE-X ports

100/1000BASE-X port
Table 7-315 describes the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X port with an optical module
installed.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 332


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-315 Optical port attributes (optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For optical modules supported by the
ET1D2G48SX5H and their attributes, see
9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules, 9.5
GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-316 describes the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X port with a copper module
installed.

Table 7-316 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 333


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-317 Specifications of the ET1D2G48SX5H


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.3 kg (7.28 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 162 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-318 Ordering information


Part Number Card Name Card Model

03032WSX 48-Port 100/1000BASE-X ET1D2G48SX5H


Interface Card (X5H, SFP)

7.10.33 ET1D2G48SX5S-48-Port 100/1000BASE-X Interface Card


(X5S, SFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-319 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2G48SX5S Supported only in V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2G48SX5S provides high performance, large entry sizes, and a large buffer for data
switching. This card is highly integrated and has a large port density.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 334


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

The ET1D2G48SX5S can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-154 Appearance of the ET1D2G48SX5S

Functions
The ET1D2G48SX5S provides the following functions:
l Communicates with the MPU and works under the control of the MPU.
l Searches for routes and destination addresses of data packets for forwarding.
l Forwards data packets.

Table 7-320 Functions of the ET1D2G48SX5S

Function Description

Basic functions Provides forty-eight GE optical ports for


data access and line-rate switching.

Forwarding speed 48 Gbit/s

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2G48SX5S is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-155 Indicators on the ET1D2G48SX5S panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 335


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-321 Indicators on the ET1D2G48SX5S panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-156 Ports on the ET1D2G48SX5S panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 100/1000BASE-X ports

100/1000BASE-X port
Table 7-322 describes the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X port with an optical module
installed.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 336


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-322 Optical port attributes (optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For optical modules supported by the
ET1D2G48SX5S and their attributes, see
9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules, 9.5
GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-323 describes the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X port with a copper module
installed.

Table 7-323 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 337


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-324 Specifications of the ET1D2G48SX5S

Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.1 kg (6.83 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 110 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-325 Ordering information

Part Number Card Name Card Model

03032WSS 48-Port 100/1000BASE-X ET1D2G48SX5S


Interface Card (X5S, SFP)

7.11 GE/10GE Interface Cards

7.11.1 EH1D2T24XEA0-24-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T and 2-Port


10GBASE-X Interface Card (EA, RJ45/XFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-326 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2T24XEA0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 338


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Introduction
The EH1D2T24XEA0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-157 Appearance of the EH1D2T24XEA0

Functions

Table 7-327 Functions of the EH1D2T24XEA0


Function Description

Basic function Provides twenty-four GE electrical ports


and two 10GE optical ports for data
transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Software feature LAN/WAN switching

Hot swapping The EH1D2T24XEA0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-158 Indicators on the EH1D2T24XEA0 panel


1 2 3 4 5
RUN/ALM

0 1
LINK LINK
ACT ACT

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 339


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-328 Indicators on the EH1D2T24XEA0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


and receiving data.

2 LINK Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.

3 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.
4 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-159 Ports on the EH1D2T24XEA0 panel


1 2
RUN/ALM

0 1
LINK LINK
ACT ACT

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23

1 Two 10GBASE XFP optical ports


2 Twenty-four 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical ports

10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 340


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-329 lists the attributes of a 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port.

Table 7-329 10/100/1000BASE-T electrical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

10GBASE XFP optical port


Table 7-330 lists the attributes of a 10GBASE XFP optical port.

Table 7-330 10GBASE XFP optical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type XFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the XFP optical module used.


For details about the optical modules
supported by the EH1D2T24XEA0 and
their attributes, see 9.13 10GE XFP
Optical Modules, 9.14 10GE-CWDM
XFP Optical Modules, and 9.15 10GE-
DWDM XFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-331 Specifications of the EH1D2T24XEA0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.30 kg (5.07 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 53 W

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 341


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Item Description

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-332 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NWY 24-port 10/100/1000BASE- EH1D2T24XEA0


T and 2-port 10GBASE-X
interface card (EA, RJ45/
XFP)

7.11.2 EH1D2S24XEA0-24-Port 100/1000BASE-X and 2-Port


10GBASE-X Interface Card (EA, SFP/XFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-333 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2S24XEA0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2S24XEA0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-160 Appearance of the EH1D2S24XEA0

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 342


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-334 Functions of the EH1D2S24XEA0

Function Description

Basic function Provides twenty-four GE optical ports and


two 10GE optical ports for data
transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Software feature LAN/WAN interface switching

Hot swapping The EH1D2S24XEA0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-161 Indicators on the EH1D2S24XEA0 panel


1 2 46 7
RUN/ALM

0 1
LINK LINK
ACT ACT

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23

35

Table 7-335 Indicators on the EH1D2S24XEA0 panel

Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


and receiving data.

2 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.

3 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

4 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 343


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

6 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

7 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-162 Ports on the EH1D2S24XEA0 panel


1 2
RUN/ALM

0 1
LINK LINK
ACT ACT

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23

1 Two 10GBASE XFP optical ports


2 Twenty-four 100/1000BASE-X optical ports

100/1000BASE-X optical port


Table 7-336 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with an optical module
installed.

Table 7-336 100/1000BASE-X optical port attributes (GE optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 344


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details about the optical modules
supported by the EH1D2S24XEA0 and their
attributes, see 9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical
Modules, 9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules,
9.7 GE-CWDM eSFP Optical Modules,
and 9.8 GE-DWDM eSFP Optical
Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-337 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with a copper module
installed.

Table 7-337 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

10GBASE XFP optical port


Table 7-338 lists the attributes of a 10GBASE XFP optical port.

Table 7-338 10GBASE XFP optical port attributes


Attribute XFP Description

Connector type XFP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 345


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute XFP Description

Optical port attributes Depend on the XFP optical module used.


For details about the optical modules
supported by the EH1D2S24XEA0 and their
attributes, see 9.13 10GE XFP Optical
Modules, 9.14 10GE-CWDM XFP
Optical Modules, and 9.15 10GE-DWDM
XFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-339 Specifications of the EH1D2S24XEA0

Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.40 kg (5.29 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 65 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-340 Ordering information

Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NXA 24-port 100/1000BASE-X EH1D2S24XEA0


and 2-port 10GBASE-X
interface card (EA, SFP/
XFP)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 346


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

7.11.3 EH1D2S24XEC0-24-Port 100/1000BASE-X and 2-Port


10GBASE-X Interface Card (EC, SFP/XFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-341 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2S24XEC0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2S24XEC0 can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-163 Appearance of the EH1D2S24XEC0

Functions

Table 7-342 Functions of the EH1D2S24XEC0

Function Description

Basic function Provides twenty-four GE optical ports and


two 10GE optical ports for data
transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Software feature LAN/WAN interface switching

Hot swapping The EH1D2S24XEC0 is hot swappable.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 347


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-164 Indicators on the EH1D2S24XEC0 panel


1 2 46 7
RUN/ALM

0 1
LINK LINK
ACT ACT

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23

35

Table 7-343 Indicators on the EH1D2S24XEC0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


and receiving data.

2 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.

3 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

4 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

6 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

7 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 348


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-165 Ports on the EH1D2S24XEC0 panel


1 2
RUN/ALM

0 1
LINK LINK
ACT ACT

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23

1 Two 10GBASE XFP optical ports


2 Twenty-four 100/1000BASE-X optical ports

100/1000BASE-X optical port

Table 7-344 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with an optical module
installed.

Table 7-344 100/1000BASE-X optical port attributes (GE optical module)

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details about the optical modules
supported by the EH1D2S24XEC0 and their
attributes, see 9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical
Modules, 9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules,
9.7 GE-CWDM eSFP Optical Modules,
and 9.8 GE-DWDM eSFP Optical
Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-345 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with a copper module
installed.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 349


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-345 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

10GBASE XFP optical port


Table 7-346 lists the attributes of a 10GBASE XFP optical port.

Table 7-346 10GBASE XFP optical port attributes


Attribute XFP Description

Connector type XFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the XFP optical module used.


For details about the optical modules
supported by the EH1D2S24XEC0 and their
attributes, see 9.13 10GE XFP Optical
Modules, 9.14 10GE-CWDM XFP
Optical Modules, and 9.15 10GE-DWDM
XFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 350


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-347 Specifications of the EH1D2S24XEC0

Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.50 kg (5.51 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 81 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-348 Ordering information

Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NXN 24-port 100/1000BASE-X EH1D2S24XEC0


and 2-port 10GBASE-X
interface card (EC, SFP/
XFP)

7.11.4 ET1D2S04SX1E-4-Port 10GBASE-X and 24-Port


100/1000BASE-X and 8-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Combo Interface
Card (X1E, RJ45/SFP/SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-349 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2S04SX1E Supported only in V200R012C00 and


V200R013C00

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 351


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Introduction
The ET1D2S04SX1E can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-166 Appearance of the ET1D2S04SX1E

Functions
The ET1D2S04SX1E provides the following functions:
l Communicates with the MPU and works under the control of the MPU.
l Searches for routes and destination addresses of data packets for forwarding.
l Forwards data packets.

Table 7-350 Functions of the


Function Description

Basic functions Provides four 10G Ethernet optical ports,


sixteen 100/1000M Ethernet optical ports,
and eight 10/100/1000M combo ports for
data access and line-rate switching.

Forwarding speed 64 Gbit/s

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Software feature LAN/WAN switchover

Hot swapping The ET1D2S04SX1E is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-167 Indicators on the ET1D2S04SX1E panel


12 46 7 8 9
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3
ACT ACT ACT ACT
LINK LINK LINK LINK

35

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 352


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-351 Indicators on the ET1D2S04SX1E panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a 10GE and receiving data.
optical port

2 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a 10GE established on the port.
optical port

3 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower GE and receiving data.
optical port

4 ACT indicator
of an upper GE
optical port

5 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower GE established on the port.
optical port

6 LINK indicator
of an upper GE
optical port

7 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.
8 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

9 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 353


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-168 Ports on the ET1D2S04SX1E panel


1 2

RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3
ACT ACT ACT ACT
LINK LINK LINK LINK

1 Four 10GBASE SFP+ ports


2 Sixteen 100/1000BASE-X ports
3 Eight combo ports. Each combo port consists of a 10/100/1000BASE-T
port and a 100/1000BASE-X port.

10GBASE SFP+ port

Table 7-352 describes the attributes of a 10GBASE SFP+ port.

Table 7-352 Attributes of a 10GBASE SFP+ port

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2S04SX1E and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules, 9.11
10GE-CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules,
and 9.12 10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical
Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 354


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Network protocol IP

100/1000BASE-X port
Table 7-353 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with an optical module
installed.

Table 7-353 Optical port attributes (optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For optical modules supported by the
ET1D2S04SX1E and their attributes, see
9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules, 9.5
GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-354 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with a copper module
installed.

Table 7-354 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Combo Port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 355


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

A combo port is a dual-purpose port consisting of an Ethernet optical port and an Ethernet
electrical port. The electrical and optical ports of a combo port are multiplexed, and only one
of them can work at a time.
NOTE

A combo port can work in any of the following modes: auto (selects working mode automatically), fiber
(optical port), and copper (electrical port). You can run the combo-port command to configure the
working mode of a combo port. By default, a combo port works in auto mode. In this mode, a combo
port determines the working port in the following way:
l If the combo port only has an Ethernet cable connected, the electrical port of the combo port is the
working port after the combo port goes Up.
l If the combo port has an optical module installed, the optical port of the combo port is the working
port after the combo port goes Up, regardless of whether an Ethernet cable is connected to combo
port.

Table 7-355 describes the attributes of a 10/100/1000BASE-T port.

Table 7-355 Attributes of a 10/100/1000BASE-T port


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-356 describes the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X port.

Table 7-356 Attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X port


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For optical modules supported by the
ET1D2S04SX1E and their attributes, see
9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules, 9.5
GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 356


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-357 Specifications of the ET1D2S04SX1E


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.88 kg (6.35 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 130 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-358 Ordering information


Part Number Card Name Card Model

03030SGF 4-port 10GBASE-X and 24- ET1D2S04SX1E


port 100/1000BASE-X and
8-port 10/100/1000BASE-T
combo interface card (X1E,
RJ45/SFP/SFP+)

7.11.5 EH1D2S04SX1E-4-Port 10GBASE-X and 24-Port


100/1000BASE-X and 8-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Combo Interface
Card (X1E, RJ45/SFP/SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-359 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2S04SX1E Supported in V200R005C00 to


V200R013C00

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 357


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Introduction
The EH1D2S04SX1E can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-169 Appearance of the EH1D2S04SX1E

Functions
The EH1D2S04SX1E provides the following functions:
l Communicates with the MPU and works under the control of the MPU.
l Searches for routes and destination addresses of data packets for forwarding.
l Forwards data packets.

Table 7-360 Functions of the EH1D2S04SX1E


Function Description

Basic functions Provides four 10G Ethernet optical ports,


sixteen 100/1000M Ethernet optical ports,
and eight 10/100/1000M combo ports for
data access and line-rate switching.

Forwarding speed 64 Gbit/s

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Software feature LAN/WAN switchover

Hot swapping The EH1D2S04SX1E is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-170 Indicators on the EH1D2S04SX1E panel


12 46 7 8 9
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3
ACT ACT ACT ACT
LINK LINK LINK LINK

35

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 358


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-361 Indicators on the EH1D2S04SX1E panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a 10GE and receiving data.
optical port

2 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a 10GE established on the port.
optical port

3 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower GE and receiving data.
optical port

4 ACT indicator
of an upper GE
optical port

5 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower GE established on the port.
optical port

6 LINK indicator
of an upper GE
optical port

7 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.
8 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

9 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 359


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-171 Ports on the EH1D2S04SX1E panel


1 2

RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3
ACT ACT ACT ACT
LINK LINK LINK LINK

1 Four 10GBASE SFP+ ports


2 Sixteen 100/1000BASE-X ports
3 Eight combo ports. Each combo port consists of a 10/100/1000BASE-T
port and a 100/1000BASE-X port.

10GBASE SFP+ port

Table 7-362 describes the attributes of a 10GBASE SFP+ port.

Table 7-362 Attributes of a 10GBASE SFP+ port

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
EH1D2S04SX1E and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules, 9.11
10GE-CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules
and9.12 10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical
Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 360


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Network protocol IP

100/1000BASE-X port
Table 7-363 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with an optical module
installed.

Table 7-363 Optical port attributes (optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For optical modules supported by the
EH1D2S04SX1E and their attributes, see
9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules, 9.5
GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-364 lists the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X optical port with a copper module
installed.

Table 7-364 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s
rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Combo Port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 361


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

A combo port is a dual-purpose port consisting of an Ethernet optical port and an Ethernet
electrical port. The electrical and optical ports of a combo port are multiplexed, and only one
of them can work at a time.
NOTE

A combo port can work in any of the following modes: auto (selects working mode automatically), fiber
(optical port), and copper (electrical port). You can run the combo-port command to configure the
working mode of a combo port. By default, a combo port works in auto mode. In this mode, a combo
port determines the working port in the following way:
l If the combo port only has an Ethernet cable connected, the electrical port of the combo port is the
working port after the combo port goes Up.
l If the combo port has an optical module installed, the optical port of the combo port is the working
port after the combo port goes Up, regardless of whether an Ethernet cable is connected to combo
port.

Table 7-365 describes the attributes of a 10/100/1000BASE-T port.

Table 7-365 Attributes of a 10/100/1000BASE-T port


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-366 describes the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X port.

Table 7-366 Attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X port


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For optical modules supported by the
EH1D2S04SX1E and their attributes, see
9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules, 9.5
GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 362


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-367 Specifications of the EH1D2S04SX1E

Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.88 kg (6.35 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 130 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-368 Ordering information

Part Number Card Name Card Model

03030RPL 4-port 10GBASE-X and 24- EH1D2S04SX1E


port 100/1000BASE-X and
8-port 10/100/1000BASE-T
combo interface card (X1E,
RJ45/SFP/SFP+)

7.11.6 ET1D2S04SX5E-4-port 10GE SFP+ and 44-port GE SFP


interface card (X5E, SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-369 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2S04SX5E Supported only in V200R013C00

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 363


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Introduction
The ET1D2S04SX5E can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-172 Appearance of the ET1D2S04SX5E

Functions
The ET1D2S04SX5E provides the following functions:
l Communicates with the MPU and works under the control of the MPU.
l Searches for routes and destination addresses of data packets for forwarding.
l Forwards data packets.

Table 7-370 Functions of the ET1D2S04SX5E

Function Description

Basic functions Provides four 10GE optical ports and forty-


four GE optical ports for data transmission
and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2S04SX5E is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-173 Indicators on the ET1D2S04SX5E panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

10G 1G

13

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 364


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-371 Indicators on the ET1D2S04SX5E panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-174 Ports on the ET1D2S04SX5E panel


1 2
RUN/ALM

10G 1G

1 Four 10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports


2 Forty-four 1000BASE-X ports

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 365


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports support 10GE and GE auto sensing. Table 7-372
describes the attributes of a port working in 1000M mode, and Table 7-373 describes the
attributes of a port working in 10G mode. Table 7-374 describes the attributes of a 10GBASE
SFP+/1000BASE-X port using a copper module.

Table 7-372 Optical port attributes (GE optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2S04SX5E and their attributes, see
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-373 Optical port attributes (10GE optical module, high-speed cable or SFP+ optical
cable)
Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2S04SX5E and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules
(OSXD22N00 not supported), 9.11 10GE-
CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules, and 9.12
10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 366


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-374 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

1000BASE-X ports
Table 7-375 lists the attributes of a 1000BASE-X port with an optical module installed.

Table 7-375 Optical port attributes (optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details about optical modules supported
by the ET1D2S04SX5E and its attributes,
see 9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7
GE-CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and
9.8 GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-376 lists the attributes of a 1000BASE-X port with a copper module installed.

Table 7-376 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 367


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-377 Specifications of the ET1D2S04SX5E


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.1 kg (6.83 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 124 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-378 Ordering information


Part Number Card Name Card Model

03032YEA 4-port 10GE SFP+ and 44- ET1D2S04SX5E


port GE SFP interface card
(X5E, SFP+)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 368


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

7.11.7 ET1D2S08SX1E-8-Port 10GBASE-X and 8-Port


100/1000BASE-X and 8-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Combo Interface
Card (X1E, RJ45/SFP/SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-379 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2S08SX1E Supported only in V200R012C00 and


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2S08SX1E can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-175 Appearance of the ET1D2S08SX1E

Functions
The ET1D2S08SX1E provides the following functions:
l Communicates with the MPU and works under the control of the MPU.
l Searches for routes and destination addresses of data packets for forwarding.
l Forwards data packets.

Table 7-380 Functions of the ET1D2S08SX1E

Function Description

Basic functions Provides eight 10GBASE-X ports and eight


10/100/1000M combo ports for data access
and line-rate switching.

Forwarding speed 88 Gbit/s

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 369


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Function Description

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2S08SX1E is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-176 Indicators on the ET1D2S08SX1E panel


12 46 7 8 9
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT
LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK

35

Table 7-381 Indicators on the ET1D2S08SX1E panel

Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a 10GE and receiving data.
optical port

2 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a 10GE established on the port.
optical port

3 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower GE and receiving data.
optical port

4 ACT indicator
of an upper GE
optical port

5 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower GE established on the port.
optical port

6 LINK indicator
of an upper GE
optical port

7 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 370


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

8 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

9 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-177 Ports on the ET1D2S08SX1E panel


1 2
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT
LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK

1 Eight 10GE BASE-SFP+ ports


2 Eight combo ports. Each combo port consists of a 10/100/1000BASE-T
port and a 100/1000BASE-X port.

10GBASE SFP+ port


Table 7-382 describes the attributes of a 10GBASE SFP+ port.

Table 7-382 Attributes of a 10GBASE SFP+ port


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 371


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2S08SX1E and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules, 9.11
10GE-CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules and
9.12 10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical
Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Combo port

A combo port is a dual-purpose port consisting of an Ethernet optical port and an Ethernet
electrical port. The electrical and optical ports of a combo port are multiplexed, and only one
of them can work at a time.
NOTE

A combo port can work in any of the following modes: auto (selects working mode automatically), fiber
(optical port), and copper (electrical port). You can run the combo-port command to configure the
working mode of a combo port. By default, a combo port works in auto mode. In this mode, a combo
port determines the working port in the following way:
l If the combo port only has an Ethernet cable connected, the electrical port of the combo port is the
working port after the combo port goes Up.
l If the combo port has an optical module installed, the optical port of the combo port is the working
port after the combo port goes Up, regardless of whether an Ethernet cable is connected to combo
port.

Table 7-383 describes the attributes of a 10/100/1000BASE-T port.

Table 7-383 Attributes of a 10/100/1000BASE-T port


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-384 describes the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X port.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 372


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-384 Attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X port


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For optical modules supported by the
ET1D2S08SX1E and their attributes, see
9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules, 9.5
GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-385 Specifications of the ET1D2S08SX1E


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.84 kg (6.26 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 130 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 373


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-386 Ordering information


Part Number Card Name Card Model

03030SGG 8-port 10GBASE-X and 8- ET1D2S08SX1E


port 100/1000BASE-X and
8-port 10/100/1000BASE-T
combo interface card (X1E,
RJ45/SFP/SFP+)

7.11.8 EH1D2S08SX1E-8-Port 10GBASE-X and 8-Port


100/1000BASE-X and 8-Port 10/100/1000BASE-T Combo Interface
Card (X1E, RJ45/SFP/SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-387 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2S08SX1E Supported in V200R005C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2S08SX1E can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-178 Appearance of the EH1D2S08SX1E

Functions
The EH1D2S08SX1E provides the following functions:
l Communicates with the MPU and works under the control of the MPU.
l Searches for routes and destination addresses of data packets for forwarding.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 374


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

l Forwards data packets.

Table 7-388 Functions of the EH1D2S08SX1E


Function Description

Basic functions Provides eight 10GBASE-X ports and eight


10/100/1000M combo ports for data access
and line-rate switching.

Forwarding speed 88 Gbit/s

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2S08SX1E is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-179 Indicators on the EH1D2S08SX1E panel


12 46 7 8 9
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT
LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK

35

Table 7-389 Indicators on the EH1D2S08SX1E panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a 10GE and receiving data.
optical port

2 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a 10GE established on the port.
optical port

3 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower GE and receiving data.
optical port

4 ACT indicator
of an upper GE
optical port

5 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower GE established on the port.
optical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 375


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

6 LINK indicator
of an upper GE
optical port

7 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


indicator of an established on the port.
upper electrical Blinking: The port is transmitting
port and receiving data.
8 LINK/ACT
indicator of a
lower electrical
port

9 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-180 Ports on the EH1D2S08SX1E panel


1 2

RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT
LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK

1 Eight 10GE BASE-SFP+ ports


2 Eight combo ports. Each combo port consists of a 10/100/1000BASE-T
port and a 100/1000BASE-X port.

10GBASE SFP+ port

Table 7-390 describes the attributes of a 10GBASE SFP+ port.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 376


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-390 Attributes of a 10GBASE SFP+ port


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
EH1D2S08SX1E and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules, 9.11
10GE-CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules and
9.12 10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical
Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Combo port
A combo port is a dual-purpose port consisting of an Ethernet optical port and an Ethernet
electrical port. The electrical and optical ports of a combo port are multiplexed, and only one
of them can work at a time.
NOTE

A combo port can work in any of the following modes: auto (selects working mode automatically), fiber
(optical port), and copper (electrical port). You can run the combo-port command to configure the
working mode of a combo port. By default, a combo port works in auto mode. In this mode, a combo
port determines the working port in the following way:
l If the combo port only has an Ethernet cable connected, the electrical port of the combo port is the
working port after the combo port goes Up.
l If the combo port has an optical module installed, the optical port of the combo port is the working
port after the combo port goes Up, regardless of whether an Ethernet cable is connected to combo
port.

Table 7-391 describes the attributes of a 10/100/1000BASE-T port.

Table 7-391 Attributes of a 10/100/1000BASE-T port


Attribute Description

Connector type RJ45

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 377


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-392 describes the attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X port.

Table 7-392 Attributes of a 100/1000BASE-X port


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For optical modules supported by the
EH1D2S08SX1E and their attributes, see
9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules, 9.5
GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-393 Specifications of the EH1D2S08SX1E


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.84 kg (6.26 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 130 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 378


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-394 Ordering information


Part Number Card Name Card Model

03030RPM 8-port 10GBASE-X and 8- EH1D2S08SX1E


port 100/1000BASE-X and
8-port 10/100/1000BASE-T
combo interface card (X1E,
RJ45/SFP/SFP+)

7.11.9 ET1D2S24SX2E-24-Port 10GE SFP+ Interface and 8-Port GE


SFP Interface Card (X2E, SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-395 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2S24SX2E Supported in V200R010C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2S24SX2E can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-181 Appearance of the ET1D2S24SX2E

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 379


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-396 Functions of the ET1D2S24SX2E


Function Description

Basic functions Provides twenty-four 10GE optical ports


and eight GE optical ports for data
transmission and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2S24SX2E is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-182 Indicators on the ET1D2S24SX2E panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

13

Table 7-397 Indicators on the ET1D2S24SX2E panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 380


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-183 Ports on the ET1D2S24SX2E panel


1 2
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

1 Twenty-four 10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports


2 Eight 1000BASE-X ports

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X port


10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports support 10GE and GE auto sensing. Table 7-398
describes the attributes of a port working in 1000M mode, and Table 7-399 describes the
attributes of a port working in 10G mode. Table 7-400 describes the attributes of a 10GBASE
SFP+/1000BASE-X port using a copper module.

Table 7-398 Optical port attributes (GE optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 381


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2S24SX2E and their attributes, see
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-399 Optical port attributes (10GE optical module, high-speed cable or SFP+ optical
cable)
Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2S24SX2E and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules
(OSXD22N00 not supported), 9.11 10GE-
CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules and 9.12
10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-400 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s rates).

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 382


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

1000BASE-X ports

Table 7-401 lists the attributes of a 1000BASE-X port with an optical module installed.

Table 7-401 Optical port attributes (optical module)

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details about optical modules supported
by the ET1D2S24SX2E and its attributes,
see 9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7
GE-CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and
9.8 GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-402 lists the attributes of a 1000BASE-X port with a copper module installed.

Table 7-402 Optical port attributes (copper module)

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 383


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-403 Specifications of the ET1D2S24SX2E


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.3 kg (7.28 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 201.8 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-404 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03031YGJ 24-Port 10GE SFP+ ET1D2S24SX2E


Interface and 8-Port GE SFP
Interface Card (X2E, SFP+)

7.11.10 ET1D2S24SX2S-24-Port 10GE SFP+ Interface and 8-Port


GE SFP Interface Card (X2S, SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-405 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2S24SX2S Supported in V200R010C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2S24SX2S can be installed in:

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 384


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-184 Appearance of the ET1D2S24SX2S

Functions

Table 7-406 Functions of the ET1D2S24SX2S

Function Description

Basic functions Provides twenty-four 10GE optical ports


and eight GE optical ports for data
transmission and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2S24SX2S is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-185 Indicators on the ET1D2S24SX2S panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

13

Table 7-407 Indicators on the ET1D2S24SX2S panel

Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 385


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-186 Ports on the ET1D2S24SX2S panel


1 2
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

1 Twenty-four 10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports


2 Eight 1000BASE-X ports

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X port

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports support 10GE and GE auto sensing. Table 7-408
describes the attributes of a port working in 1000M mode, and Table 7-409 describes the
attributes of a port working in 10G mode. Table 7-410 describes the attributes of a 10GBASE
SFP+/1000BASE-X port using a copper module.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 386


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-408 Optical port attributes (GE optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2S24SX2S and their attributes, see 9.5
GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-409 Optical port attributes (10GE optical module, high-speed cable or SFP+ optical
cable)
Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2S24SX2S and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules
(OSXD22N00 not supported), 9.11 10GE-
CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules and 9.12
10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-410 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 387


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

1000BASE-X ports

Table 7-411 lists the attributes of a 1000BASE-X port with an optical module installed.

Table 7-411 Optical port attributes (optical module)

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details about optical modules supported
by the ET1D2S24SX2S and its attributes,
see 9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7
GE-CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and
9.8 GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-412 lists the attributes of a 1000BASE-X port with a copper module installed.

Table 7-412 Optical port attributes (copper module)

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s rates).

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 388


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-413 Specifications of the ET1D2S24SX2S


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.2 kg (7.05 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 192.3 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-414 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03031YGG 24-Port 10GE SFP+ ET1D2S24SX2S


Interface and 8-Port GE SFP
Interface Card (X2S, SFP+)

7.11.11 ET1D2S16SX2E-16-Port 10GE SFP+ Interface and 16-Port


GE SFP Interface Card (X2E, SFP+)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 389


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Version Mapping

Table 7-415 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2S16SX2E Supported in V200R010C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2S16SX2E can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-187 Appearance of the ET1D2S16SX2E

Functions

Table 7-416 Functions of the ET1D2S16SX2E


Function Description

Basic functions Provides sixteen 10GE optical ports and


sixteen GE optical ports for data
transmission and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2S16SX2E is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-188 Indicators on the ET1D2S16SX2E panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15

13

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 390


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-417 Indicators on the ET1D2S16SX2E panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-189 Ports on the ET1D2S16SX2E panel


1 2
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15

1 Sixteen 10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports


2 Sixteen 1000BASE-X ports

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 391


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports support 10GE and GE auto sensing. Table 7-418
describes the attributes of a port working in 1000M mode, and Table 7-419 describes the
attributes of a port working in 10G mode. Table 7-420 describes the attributes of a 10GBASE
SFP+/1000BASE-X port using a copper module.

Table 7-418 Optical port attributes (GE optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2S16SX2E and their attributes, see
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-419 Optical port attributes (10GE optical module, high-speed cable or SFP+ optical
cable)
Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2S16SX2E and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules
(OSXD22N00 not supported), 9.11 10GE-
CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules and 9.12
10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 392


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-420 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

1000BASE-X ports
Table 7-421 lists the attributes of a 1000BASE-X port with an optical module installed.

Table 7-421 Optical port attributes (optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details about optical modules supported
by the ET1D2S16SX2E and its attributes,
see 9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7
GE-CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and
9.8 GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-422 lists the attributes of a 1000BASE-X port with a copper module installed.

Table 7-422 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 393


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-423 Specifications of the ET1D2S16SX2E


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.3 kg (7.28 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 192.4 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-424 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03031YGL 16-Port 10GE SFP+ ET1D2S16SX2E


Interface and 16-Port GE
SFP Interface Card (X2E,
SFP+)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 394


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

7.11.12 ET1D2S16SX2S-16-Port 10GE SFP+ Interface and 16-Port


GE SFP Interface Card (X2S, SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-425 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2S16SX2S Supported in V200R010C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2S16SX2S can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-190 Appearance of the ET1D2S16SX2S

Functions

Table 7-426 Functions of the ET1D2S16SX2S


Function Description

Basic functions Provides sixteen 10GE optical ports and


sixteen GE optical ports for data
transmission and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2S16SX2S is hot swappable.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 395


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-191 Indicators on the ET1D2S16SX2S panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15

13

Table 7-427 Indicators on the ET1D2S16SX2S panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 396


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-192 Ports on the ET1D2S16SX2S panel


1 2
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15

1 Sixteen 10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports


2 Sixteen 1000BASE-X ports

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X port


10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports support 10GE and GE auto sensing. Table 7-428
describes the attributes of a port working in 1000M mode, and Table 7-429 describes the
attributes of a port working in 10G mode. Table 7-430 describes the attributes of a 10GBASE
SFP+/1000BASE-X port using a copper module.

Table 7-428 Optical port attributes (GE optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2S16SX2S and their attributes, see 9.5
GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-429 Optical port attributes (10GE optical module, high-speed cable or SFP+ optical
cable)
Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 397


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2S16SX2S and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules
(OSXD22N00 not supported), 9.11 10GE-
CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules and 9.12
10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-430 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

1000BASE-X ports
Table 7-431 lists the attributes of a 1000BASE-X port with an optical module installed.

Table 7-431 Optical port attributes (optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 398


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details about optical modules supported
by the ET1D2S16SX2S and its attributes,
see 9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7
GE-CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and
9.8 GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-432 lists the attributes of a 1000BASE-X port with a copper module installed.

Table 7-432 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-433 Specifications of the ET1D2S16SX2S


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.2 kg (7.05 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 182.4 W

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 399


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Item Description

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-434 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03031YGK 16-Port 10GE SFP+ ET1D2S16SX2S


Interface and 16-Port GE
SFP Interface Card (X2S,
SFP+)

7.12 10GE Interface Cards

7.12.1 EH1D2X02XEA0-2-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (EA,


XFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-435 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2X02XEA0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2X02XEA0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 400


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-193 Appearance of the EH1D2X02XEA0

Functions

Table 7-436 Functions of the EH1D2X02XEA0


Function Description

Basic function Provides two 10GE optical ports for data


transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2X02XEA0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-194 Indicators on the EH1D2X02XEA0 panel


1 2 3
RUN/ALM

0 1
LINK LINK
ACT ACT

Table 7-437 Indicators on the EH1D2X02XEA0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


and receiving data.

2 LINK Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 401


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-195 Ports on the EH1D2X02XEA0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 1
LINK LINK
ACT ACT

1 Two 10GBASE XFP optical ports

10GBASE XFP optical port

Table 7-438 lists the attributes of a 10GBASE XFP optical port.

Table 7-438 10GBASE XFP optical port attributes

Attribute Description

Connector type XFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the XFP optical module used.


For details about the optical modules
supported by the EH1D2X02XEA0 and
their attributes, see 9.13 10GE XFP
Optical Modules, 9.14 10GE-CWDM
XFP Optical Modules, and 9.15 10GE-
DWDM XFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 402


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-439 Specifications of the EH1D2X02XEA0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.14 kg (4.71 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 52 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-440 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NWT 2-port 10GBASE-X EH1D2X02XEA0


interface card (EA, XFP)

7.12.2 EH1D2X02XEC0-2-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (EC,


XFP)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 403


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Version Mapping

Table 7-441 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2X02XEC0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2X02XEC0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-196 Appearance of the EH1D2X02XEC0

Functions

Table 7-442 Functions of the EH1D2X02XEC0


Function Description

Basic function Provides two 10GE optical ports for data


transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2X02XEC0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-197 Indicators on the EH1D2X02XEC0 panel


1 2 3
RUN/ALM

0 1
LINK LINK
ACT ACT

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 404


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-443 Indicators on the EH1D2X02XEC0 panel

Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


and receiving data.

2 LINK Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-198 Ports on the EH1D2X02XEC0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 1
LINK LINK
ACT ACT

1 Two 10GBASE XFP optical ports

10GBASE XFP optical port

Table 7-444 lists the attributes of a 10GBASE XFP optical port.

Table 7-444 10GBASE XFP optical port attributes

Attribute Description

Connector type XFP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 405


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Optical port attributes Depend on the XFP optical module used.


For details about the optical modules
supported by the EH1D2X02XEC0 and
their attributes, see 9.13 10GE XFP
Optical Modules, 9.14 10GE-CWDM
XFP Optical Modules, and 9.15 10GE-
DWDM XFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-445 Specifications of the EH1D2X02XEC0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.26 kg (4.98 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 61 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-446 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NWU 2-port 10GBASE-X EH1D2X02XEC0


interface card (EC, XFP)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 406


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

7.12.3 EH1D2X02XEC1-2-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (EC,


XFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-447 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2X02XEC1 Supported in V200R003C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2X02XEC1 can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-199 Appearance of the EH1D2X02XEC1

Functions

Table 7-448 Functions of the EH1D2X02XEC1

Function Description

Basic function Provides two 10GE optical ports for data


transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2X02XEC1 is hot swappable.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 407


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-200 Indicators on the EH1D2X02XEC1 panel


1 2 3
RUN/ALM

0 1
LINK LINK
ACT ACT

Table 7-449 Indicators on the EH1D2X02XEC1 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


and receiving data.

2 LINK Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-201 Ports on the EH1D2X02XEC1 panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 1
LINK LINK
ACT ACT

1 Two 10GBASE XFP optical ports

10GBASE XFP optical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 408


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-450 lists the attributes of a 10GBASE XFP optical port.

Table 7-450 10GBASE XFP optical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type XFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the XFP optical module used.


For details about the optical modules
supported by the EH1D2X02XEC1 and
their attributes, see 9.13 10GE XFP
Optical Modules, 9.14 10GE-CWDM
XFP Optical Modules, and 9.15 10GE-
DWDM XFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-451 Specifications of the EH1D2X02XEC1


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.26 kg (4.98 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 61 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 409


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-452 Ordering information

Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030RCU 2-port 10GBASE-X EH1D2X02XEC1


interface card (EC, XFP),
FCC

7.12.4 ET1D2X04XEA0-4-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (EA,


XFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-453 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2X04XEA0 Supported only in V200R012C00 and


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2X04XEA0 can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-202 Appearance of the ET1D2X04XEA0

Functions

Table 7-454 Functions of the ET1D2X04XEA0

Function Description

Basic function Provides four 10GE optical ports for data


transmission and line-rate switching.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 410


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Function Description

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2X04XEA0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-203 Indicators on the ET1D2X04XEA0 panel


12 3
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3
LINK LINK LINK LINK
ACT ACT ACT ACT

Table 7-455 Indicators on the ET1D2X04XEA0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


and receiving data.

2 LINK Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-204 Ports on the ET1D2X04XEA0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3
LINK LINK LINK LINK
ACT ACT ACT ACT

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 411


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

1 Four 10GBASE XFP optical ports

10GBASE XFP optical port


Table 7-456 lists the attributes of a 10GBASE XFP optical port.

Table 7-456 10GBASE XFP optical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type XFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the XFP optical module used.


For details about the optical modules
supported by the ET1D2X04XEA0 and
their attributes, see 9.13 10GE XFP
Optical Modules, 9.14 10GE-CWDM
XFP Optical Modules, and 9.15 10GE-
DWDM XFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-457 Specifications of the ET1D2X04XEA0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.16 kg (4.76 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 64 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 412


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-458 Order information

Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030SGR 4-port 10GBASE-X ET1D2X04XEA0


interface card (EA, XFP)

7.12.5 EH1D2X04XEA0-4-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (EA,


XFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-459 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2X04XEA0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2X04XEA0 can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-205 Appearance of the EH1D2X04XEA0

Functions

Table 7-460 Functions of the EH1D2X04XEA0

Function Description

Basic function Provides four 10GE optical ports for data


transmission and line-rate switching.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 413


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Function Description

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2X04XEA0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-206 Indicators on the EH1D2X04XEA0 panel


1 2 3
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3
LINK LINK LINK LINK
ACT ACT ACT ACT

Table 7-461 Indicators on the EH1D2X04XEA0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


and receiving data.

2 LINK Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-207 Ports on the EH1D2X04XEA0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3
LINK LINK LINK LINK
ACT ACT ACT ACT

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 414


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

1 Four 10GBASE XFP optical ports

10GBASE XFP optical port


Table 7-462 lists the attributes of a 10GBASE XFP optical port.

Table 7-462 10GBASE XFP optical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type XFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the XFP optical module used.


For details about the optical modules
supported by the EH1D2X04XEA0 and
their attributes, see 9.13 10GE XFP
Optical Modules, 9.14 10GE-CWDM
XFP Optical Modules, and 9.15 10GE-
DWDM XFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-463 Specifications of the EH1D2X04XEA0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.16 kg (4.76 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 64 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 415


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-464 Order information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NWR 4-port 10GBASE-X EH1D2X04XEA0


interface card (EA, XFP)

7.12.6 ET1D2X04XEC1-4-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (EC,


XFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-465 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2X04XEC1 Supported only in V200R012C00 and


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2X04XEC1 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-208 Appearance of the ET1D2X04XEC1

Functions

Table 7-466 Functions of the ET1D2X04XEC1


Function Description

Basic function Provides four 10GE optical ports for data


transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 416


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Function Description

Hot swapping The ET1D2X04XEC1 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-209 Indicators on the ET1D2X04XEC1 panel


12 3
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3
LINK LINK LINK LINK
ACT ACT ACT ACT

Table 7-467 Indicators on the ET1D2X04XEC1 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


and receiving data.

2 LINK Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-210 Ports on the ET1D2X04XEC1 panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3
LINK LINK LINK LINK
ACT ACT ACT ACT

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 417


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

1 Four 10GBASE XFP optical ports

10GBASE XFP optical port


Table 7-468 lists the attributes of a 10GBASE XFP optical port.

Table 7-468 10GBASE XFP optical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type XFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the XFP optical module used.


For details about the optical modules
supported by the ET1D2X04XEC1 and their
attributes, see 9.13 10GE XFP Optical
Modules, 9.14 10GE-CWDM XFP
Optical Modules, and 9.15 10GE-DWDM
XFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-469 Specifications of the ET1D2X04XEC1


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.28 kg (5.03 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 75 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 418


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-470 Order information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030SGS 4-port 10GBASE-X ET1D2X04XEC1


interface card (EC, XFP)

7.12.7 EH1D2X04XEC0-4-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (EC,


XFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-471 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2X04XEC0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2X04XEC0 can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-211 Appearance of the EH1D2X04XEC0

Functions

Table 7-472 Functions of the EH1D2X04XEC0


Function Description

Basic function Provides four 10GE optical ports for data


transmission and line-rate switching.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 419


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Function Description

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2X04XEC0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-212 Indicators on the EH1D2X04XEC0 panel


1 2 3
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3
LINK LINK LINK LINK
ACT ACT ACT ACT

Table 7-473 Indicators on the EH1D2X04XEC0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


and receiving data.

2 LINK Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-213 Ports on the EH1D2X04XEC0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3
LINK LINK LINK LINK
ACT ACT ACT ACT

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 420


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

1 Four 10GBASE XFP optical ports

10GBASE XFP optical port


Table 7-474 lists the attributes of a 10GBASE XFP optical port.

Table 7-474 10GBASE XFP optical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type XFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the XFP optical module used.


For details about the optical modules
supported by the EH1D2X04XEC0 and
their attributes, see 9.13 10GE XFP
Optical Modules, 9.14 10GE-CWDM
XFP Optical Modules, and 9.15 10GE-
DWDM XFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-475 Specifications of the EH1D2X04XEC0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.28 kg (5.03 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 75 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 421


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-476 Order information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NWS 4-port 10GBASE-X EH1D2X04XEC0


interface card (EC, XFP)

7.12.8 ET1D2X08SX5E-8-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (X5E,


SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-477 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2X08SX5E Supported only in V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2X08SX5E can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-214 Appearance of the ET1D2X08SX5E

Functions
The ET1D2X08SX5E provides the following functions:
l Communicates with the MPU and works under the control of the MPU.
l Searches for routes and destination addresses of data packets for forwarding.
l Forwards data packets.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 422


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-478 Functions of the ET1D2X08SX5E


Function Description

Basic functions Provides eight 1000M/10G BASE-X ports


for data access and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2X08SX5E is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-215 Indicators on the ET1D2X08SX5E panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Table 7-479 Indicators on the ET1D2X08SX5E panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 423


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-216 Ports on the ET1D2X08SX5E panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Eight 10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X port


10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports support 10GE and GE auto sensing.

Table 7-480 Optical port attributes (GE optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For the SFP optical modules supported by
the ET1D2X08SX5E and their attributes,
see 9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7
GE-CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and
9.8 GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 424


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-481 Optical port attributes (10GE optical module, high-speed cable or SFP+ optical
cable)
Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2X08SX5E and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules
(OSXD22N00 not supported), 9.11 10GE-
CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules and 9.12
10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-482 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 425


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-483 Specifications of the ET1D2X08SX5E

Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.7 kg (5.95 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 78 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-484 Ordering information

Part Number Card Name Card Model

03032WTF 8-Port 10GBASE-X ET1D2X08SX5E


Interface Card (X5E, SFP+)

7.12.9 ET1D2X08SX5H-8-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (X5H,


SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-485 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2X08SX5H Supported only in V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2X08SX5H can be installed in:

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 426


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-217 Appearance of the ET1D2X08SX5H

Functions
The ET1D2X08SX5H provides the following functions:
l Communicates with the MPU and works under the control of the MPU.
l Searches for routes and destination addresses of data packets for forwarding.
l Forwards data packets.

Table 7-486 Functions of the ET1D2X08SX5H


Function Description

Basic functions Provides eight 1000M/10G BASE-X ports


for data access and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2X08SX5H is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-218 Indicators on the ET1D2X08SX5H panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 427


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-487 Indicators on the ET1D2X08SX5H panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-219 Ports on the ET1D2X08SX5H panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Eight 10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X port

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports support 10GE and GE auto sensing.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 428


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-488 Optical port attributes (GE optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For the SFP optical modules supported by
the ET1D2X08SX5H and their attributes,
see 9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7
GE-CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and
9.8 GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-489 Optical port attributes (10GE optical module, high-speed cable or SFP+ optical
cable)
Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2X08SX5H and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules
(OSXD22N00 not supported), 9.11 10GE-
CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules and 9.12
10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-490 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 429


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-491 Specifications of the ET1D2X08SX5H


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.94 kg (6.48 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 130 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-492 Ordering information


Part Number Card Name Card Model

03032WTH 8-Port 10GBASE-X ET1D2X08SX5H


Interface Card (X5H, SFP+)

7.12.10 EH1D2X04XEC1-4-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (EC,


XFP)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 430


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Version Mapping

Table 7-493 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2X04XEC1 Supported in V200R003C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2X04XEC1 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-220 Appearance of the EH1D2X04XEC1

Functions

Table 7-494 Functions of the EH1D2X04XEC1


Function Description

Basic function Provides four 10GE optical ports for data


transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2X04XEC1 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-221 Indicators on the EH1D2X04XEC1 panel


1 2 3
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3
LINK LINK LINK LINK
ACT ACT ACT ACT

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 431


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-495 Indicators on the EH1D2X04XEC1 panel

Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


and receiving data.

2 LINK Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-222 Ports on the EH1D2X04XEC1 panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3
LINK LINK LINK LINK
ACT ACT ACT ACT

1 Four 10GBASE XFP optical ports

10GBASE XFP optical port

Table 7-496 lists the attributes of a 10GBASE XFP optical port.

Table 7-496 10GBASE XFP optical port attributes

Attribute Description

Connector type XFP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 432


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Optical port attributes Depend on the XFP optical module used.


For details about the optical modules
supported by the EH1D2X04XEC1 and
their attributes, see 9.13 10GE XFP
Optical Modules, 9.14 10GE-CWDM
XFP Optical Modules, and 9.15 10GE-
DWDM XFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-497 Specifications of the EH1D2X04XEC1


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.28 kg (5.03 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 75 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-498 Order information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030RCW 4-port 10GBASE-X EH1D2X04XEC1


interface card (EC, XFP),
FCC

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 433


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

7.12.11 EH1D2X04XED0-4-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (ED,


XFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-499 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2X04XED0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2X04XED0 can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-223 Appearance of the EH1D2X04XED0

Functions

Table 7-500 Functions of the EH1D2X04XED0

Function Description

Basic function Provides four 10GE optical ports for data


transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2X04XED0 is hot swappable.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 434


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-224 Indicators on the EH1D2X04XED0 panel


1 2 3
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3
LINK LINK LINK LINK
ACT ACT ACT ACT

Table 7-501 Indicators on the EH1D2X04XED0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


and receiving data.

2 LINK Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-225 Ports on the EH1D2X04XED0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3
LINK LINK LINK LINK
ACT ACT ACT ACT

1 Four 10GBASE XFP optical ports

10GBASE XFP optical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 435


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-502 lists the attributes of a 10GBASE XFP optical port.

Table 7-502 10GBASE XFP optical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type XFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the XFP optical module used.


For details about the optical modules
supported by the EH1D2X04XED0 and
their attributes, see 9.13 10GE XFP
Optical Modules, 9.14 10GE-CWDM
XFP Optical Modules, and 9.15 10GE-
DWDM XFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-503 Specifications of the EH1D2X04XED0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.30 kg (5.07 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 93 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 436


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-504 Order information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NXC 4-port 10GBASE-X EH1D2X04XED0


interface card (ED, XFP)

7.12.12 EH1D2X08SED4-8-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (ED,


SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-505 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2X08SED4 Supported in V200R002C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2X08SED4 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-226 Appearance of the EH1D2X08SED4

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 437


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-506 Functions of the EH1D2X08SED4

Function Description

Basic function Provides eight 10GE BASE-X optical ports


for data transmission and line-rate
switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Software feature Service port clustering

Hot swapping The EH1D2X08SED4 is hot swappable.

Usage Constraints

When service ports on an EH1D2X08SED4 card need to be used to set up a CSS, the card can
only be installed in the S9712 or S9706 chassis and must use 10G optical modules or 10G
cables.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-227 Indicators on the EH1D2X08SED4 panel


1 2 3
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT


LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK

Table 7-507 Indicators on the EH1D2X08SED4 panel

Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of an optical and receiving data.
port

2 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of an optical established on the port.
port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 438


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-228 Ports on the EH1D2X08SED4 panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT


LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK

1 Eight 10GBASE SFP+ optical ports

10GBASE SFP+ optical port


Table 7-508 lists the attributes of a 10GE BASE-SFP+ optical port.

Table 7-508 Optical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 439


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
EH1D2X08SED4, see 9.10 10GE SFP+
Optical Modules, 9.11 10GE-CWDM SFP
+ Optical Modules and 9.12 10GE-
DWDM SFP+ Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-509 Specifications of the EH1D2X08SED4


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.50 kg (5.51 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 198.1 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-510 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03021TJE 8-port 10GBASE-X EH1D2X08SED4


interface card (ED, SFP+)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 440


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

7.12.13 EH1D2X08SED5-8-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (ED,


SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-511 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2X08SED5 Supported in V200R002C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2X08SED5 can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-229 Appearance of the EH1D2X08SED5

Functions

Table 7-512 Functions of the EH1D2X08SED5

Function Description

Basic function Provides eight 10GE BASE-X optical ports


for data transmission and line-rate
switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Software feature Service port clustering

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 441


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Function Description

Hot swapping The EH1D2X08SED5 is hot swappable.

Usage Constraints

When service ports on an EH1D2X08SED5 card need to be used to set up a CSS, the card can
only be installed in the S9712 or S9706 chassis and must use 10G optical modules or 10G
cables.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-230 Indicators on the EH1D2X08SED5 panel


1 2 3
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT


LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK

Table 7-513 Indicators on the EH1D2X08SED5 panel

Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of an optical and receiving data.
port

2 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of an optical established on the port.
port

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 442


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-231 Ports on the EH1D2X08SED5 panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT


LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK

1 Eight 10GBASE SFP+ optical ports

10GBASE SFP+ optical port


Table 7-514 lists the attributes of a 10GE BASE-SFP+ optical port.

Table 7-514 Optical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
EH1D2X08SED5, see 9.10 10GE SFP+
Optical Modules, 9.11 10GE-CWDM SFP
+ Optical Modules and 9.12 10GE-
DWDM SFP+ Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 443


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-515 Specifications of the EH1D2X08SED5


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.50 kg (5.51 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 198.1 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-516 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03021TJF 8-port 10GBASE-X EH1D2X08SED5


interface card (ED, SFP+)

7.12.14 ET1D2X12SSA0-12-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (SA,


SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-517 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2X12SSA0 Supported only in V200R012C00 and


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2X12SSA0 can be installed in:

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 444


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-232 Appearance of the ET1D2X12SSA0

Functions

Table 7-518 Functions of the ET1D2X12SSA0

Function Description

Basic function Provides twelve 10GE optical ports for data


transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Software feature LAN/WAN switchover

Hot swapping The ET1D2X12SSA0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-233 Indicators on the ET1D2X12SSA0 panel


12 3
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11

LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK
ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT

Table 7-519 Indicators on the ET1D2X12SSA0 panel

Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of an optical and receiving data.
port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 445


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

2 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of an optical established on the port.
port

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-234 Ports on the ET1D2X12SSA0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11

LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK
ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT

1 Twelve 10GBASE SFP+ optical ports

10GBASE SFP+ optical port


Table 7-520 lists the attributes of a 10GBASE SFP+ optical port.

Table 7-520 10GBASE SFP+ optical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 446


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m or 10 m), SFP+ optical module,
or SFP+ optical cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2X12SSA0 and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules
(OSXD22N00 not supported), 9.11 10GE-
CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules and 9.12
10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-521 Specifications of the ET1D2X12SSA0

Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.30 kg (5.07 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 85 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-522 Ordering information

Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030SGY 12-port 10GBASE-X ET1D2X12SSA0


interface card (SA, SFP+)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 447


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

7.12.15 EH1D2X12SSA0-12-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (SA,


SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-523 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2X12SSA0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2X12SSA0 can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-235 Appearance of the EH1D2X12SSA0

Functions

Table 7-524 Functions of the EH1D2X12SSA0


Function Description

Basic function Provides twelve 10GE optical ports for data


transmission and line-rate switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Software feature Service port clustering and LAN/WAN


switchover

Hot swapping The EH1D2X12SSA0 is hot swappable.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 448


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Usage Constraints

When service ports on an EH1D2X12SSA0 card need to be used to set up a CSS, the card can
only be installed in the S9712 or S9706 chassis.
An EH1D2X12SSA0 card supports line-rate forwarding in any of the following conditions:
l The card is installed in any LPU slot of an S9703. Whether this card can support line-
rate forwarding in this condition also depends on the model of LPUs installed in other
slots.
l The card is installed in any LPU slot of an S9706 switch configured with two main
control units (SRUD).
l The card is installed in slot 6 or 7 of an S9712 switch configured with two main control
units (SRUD), and the fabric mode of this slot is set to the extended mode.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-236 Indicators on the EH1D2X12SSA0 panel


1 2 3
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11

LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK
ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT

Table 7-525 Indicators on the EH1D2X12SSA0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of an optical and receiving data.
port

2 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of an optical established on the port.
port

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 449


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-237 Ports on the EH1D2X12SSA0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11

LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK LINK
ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT ACT

1 Twelve 10GBASE SFP+ optical ports

10GBASE SFP+ optical port


Table 7-526 lists the attributes of a 10GBASE SFP+ optical port.

Table 7-526 10GBASE SFP+ optical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m or 10 m), SFP+ optical module,
or SFP+ optical cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
EH1D2X12SSA0 and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules
(OSXD22N00 not supported), 9.11 10GE-
CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules and 9.12
10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 450


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-527 Specifications of the EH1D2X12SSA0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.30 kg (5.07 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 85 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-528 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NWX 12-port 10GBASE-X EH1D2X12SSA0


interface card (SA, SFP+)

7.12.16 ET1D2X16SSC0-16-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (SC,


SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-529 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2X16SSC0 Supported only in V200R012C00 and


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2X16SSC0 can be installed in:

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 451


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-238 Appearance of the ET1D2X16SSC0

Functions

Table 7-530 Functions of the ET1D2X16SSC0

Function Description

Basic function Provides sixteen 10GE BASE-X optical


ports for data transmission and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2X16SSC0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-239 Indicators on the ET1D2X16SSC0 panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Table 7-531 Indicators on the ET1D2X16SSC0 panel

Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 452


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-240 Ports on the ET1D2X16SSC0 panel


1

RUN/ALM

1 Sixteen 10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X optical ports

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X optical port


10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X optical ports support 10GE and GE auto sensing.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 453


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-532 Optical port attributes (GE optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2X16SSC0 and their attributes, see
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-533 Optical port attributes (10GE optical module, high-speed cable or SFP+ optical
cable)
Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2X16SSC0 and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules, 9.11
10GE-CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules and
9.12 10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical
Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-534 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 454


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(1000 Mbit/s rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-535 Specifications of the ET1D2X16SSC0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.60 kg (5.73 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 150 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-536 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030SHB 16-port 10GBASE-X ET1D2X16SSC0


interface card (SC, SFP+)

7.12.17 EH1D2X16SFC0-16-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (FC,


SFP+)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 455


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Version Mapping

Table 7-537 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2X16SFC0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2X16SFC0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-241 Appearance of the EH1D2X16SFC0

Functions

Table 7-538 Functions of the EH1D2X16SFC0


Function Description

Basic function Provides sixteen 10GE BASE-X optical


ports for data transmission and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Software feature Service port clustering

Hot swapping The EH1D2X16SFC0 is hot swappable.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 456


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Usage Constraints

When service ports on an EH1D2X16SFC0 card need to be used to set up a CSS, the card can
only be installed in the S9712 or S9706 chassis and must use 10G optical modules or 10G
cables.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-242 Indicators on the EH1D2X16SFC0 panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Table 7-539 Indicators on the EH1D2X16SFC0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 457


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-243 Ports on the EH1D2X16SFC0 panel


1

RUN/ALM

1 Sixteen 10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X optical ports

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X optical port


10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X optical ports support 10GE and GE auto sensing.

Table 7-540 Optical port attributes (GE optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For the optical modules supported by the
EH1D2X16SFC0 and their attributes, see
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 458


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-541 Optical port attributes (10GE optical module, high-speed cable or SFP+ optical
cable)
Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
EH1D2X16SFC0 and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules, 9.11
10GE-CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules and
9.12 10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical
Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-542 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(1000 Mbit/s rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 459


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-543 Specifications of the EH1D2X16SFC0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.60 kg (5.73 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 150 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-544 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NXP 16-port 10GBASE-X EH1D2X16SFC0


interface card (FC, SFP+)

7.12.18 ET1D2X16SSC2-16-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (SC,


SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-545 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2X16SSC2 Supported only in V200R012C00 and


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2X16SSC2 can be installed in:

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 460


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-244 Appearance of the ET1D2X16SSC2

Functions

Table 7-546 Functions of the ET1D2X16SSC2

Function Description

Basic function Provides sixteen 10GE optical ports for data


transmission and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2X16SSC2 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-245 Indicators on the ET1D2X16SSC2 panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15

13

Table 7-547 Indicators on the ET1D2X16SSC2 panel

Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 461


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-246 Ports on the ET1D2X16SSC2 panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15

1 Sixteen 10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X port


10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports support 10GE and GE auto sensing. Table 7-548
describes the attributes of a port working in 1000M mode, and Table 7-549 describes the
attributes of a port working in 10G mode. Table 7-550 describes the attributes of a 10GBASE
SFP+/1000BASE-X port using a copper module.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 462


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-548 Optical port attributes (GE optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2X16SSC2 and their attributes, see
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-549 Optical port attributes (10GE optical module, high-speed cable or SFP+ optical
cable)
Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2X16SSC2 and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules, 9.11
10GE-CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules and
9.12 10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical
Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-550 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 463


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(1000 Mbit/s rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-551 Specifications of the ET1D2X16SSC2


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.80 kg (6.17 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 131 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-552 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03031HGN 16-port 10GBASE-X ET1D2X16SSC2


interface card (SC, SFP+)

7.12.19 EH1D2X16SSC2-16-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (SC,


SFP+)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 464


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Version Mapping

Table 7-553 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2X16SSC2 Supported in V200R008C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2X16SSC2 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-247 Appearance of the EH1D2X16SSC2

Functions

Table 7-554 Functions of the EH1D2X16SSC2


Function Description

Basic function Provides sixteen 10GE optical ports for data


transmission and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Software feature Service port clustering

Hot swapping The EH1D2X16SSC2 is hot swappable.

Usage Constraints

If service ports on the EH1D2X16SSC2 need to be used to set up a CSS, the card can only be
installed in the S9712 or S9706 chassis and must use 10G optical modules and 10G cables.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 465


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-248 Indicators on the EH1D2X16SSC2 panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15

13

Table 7-555 Indicators on the EH1D2X16SSC2 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 466


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-249 Ports on the EH1D2X16SSC2 panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15

1 Sixteen 10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X port


10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports support 10GE and GE auto sensing. Table 7-556
describes the attributes of a port working in 1000M mode, and Table 7-557 describes the
attributes of a port working in 10G mode. Table 7-558 describes the attributes of a 10GBASE
SFP+/1000BASE-X port using a copper module.

Table 7-556 Optical port attributes (GE optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For the optical modules supported by the
EH1D2X16SSC2 and their attributes, see
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-557 Optical port attributes (10GE optical module, high-speed cable or SFP+ optical
cable)
Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 467


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
EH1D2X16SSC2 and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules, 9.11
10GE-CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules and
9.12 10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical
Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-558 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(1000 Mbit/s rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-559 Specifications of the EH1D2X16SSC2


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.80 kg (6.17 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 131 W

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 468


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Item Description

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-560 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03031HGP 16-port 10GBASE-X EH1D2X16SSC2


interface card (SC, SFP+)

7.12.20 ET1D2X32SSC0-32-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (SC,


SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-561 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2X32SSC0 Supported only in V200R012C00 and


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2X32SSC0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-250 Appearance of the ET1D2X32SSC0

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 469


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-562 Functions of the ET1D2X32SSC0


Function Description

Basic functions Provides thirty-two 10GE optical ports for


data transmission and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping Supported

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-251 Indicators on the ET1D2X32SSC0 panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31

13

Table 7-563 Indicators on the ET1D2X32SSC0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 470


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-252 Ports on the ET1D2X32SSC0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31

1 Thirty-two 10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X port

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports support 10GE and GE auto sensing. Table 7-564
describes the attributes of a port working in 1000M mode, and Table 7-565 describes the
attributes of a port working in 10G mode. Table 7-566 describes the attributes of a 10GBASE
SFP+/1000BASE-X port using a copper module.

Table 7-564 Optical port attributes (GE optical module)

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2X32SSC0 and their attributes, see
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 471


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Standards compliance IEEE802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-565 Optical port attributes (10GE optical module, high-speed cable or SFP+ optical
cable)
Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2X32SSC0 and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules, 9.11
10GE-CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules and
9.12 10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical
Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-566 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(1000 Mbit/s rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 472


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-567 Specifications of the ET1D2X32SSC0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.02 kg (6.66 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 207 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-568 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03031FSM 32-port 10GBASE-X ET1D2X32SSC0


interface card (SC, SFP+)

7.12.21 EH1D2X32SSC0-32-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (SC,


SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-569 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2X32SSC0 Supported in V200R008C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2X32SSC0 can be installed in:

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 473


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-253 Appearance of the EH1D2X32SSC0

Functions

Table 7-570 Functions of the EH1D2X32SSC0


Function Description

Basic functions Provides thirty-two 10GE optical ports for


data transmission and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Software feature Service port clustering

Hot swapping Supported

Usage Constraints

If service ports on the EH1D2X32SSC0 need to be used to set up a CSS, the card can only be
installed in the S9712 or S9706 chassis and must use 10G optical modules and 10G cables.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-254 Indicators on the EH1D2X32SSC0 panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31

13

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 474


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-571 Indicators on the EH1D2X32SSC0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-255 Ports on the EH1D2X32SSC0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31

1 Thirty-two 10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X port


10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports support 10GE and GE auto sensing. Table 7-572
describes the attributes of a port working in 1000M mode, and Table 7-573 describes the

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 475


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

attributes of a port working in 10G mode. Table 7-574 describes the attributes of a 10GBASE
SFP+/1000BASE-X port using a copper module.

Table 7-572 Optical port attributes (GE optical module)

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For the optical modules supported by the
EH1D2X32SSC0 and their attributes, see
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-573 Optical port attributes (10GE optical module, high-speed cable or SFP+ optical
cable)

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
EH1D2X32SSC0 and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules, 9.11
10GE-CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules and
9.12 10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical
Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-574 Optical port attributes (copper module)

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 476


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(1000 Mbit/s rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-575 Specifications of the EH1D2X32SSC0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.02 kg (6.66 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 207 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-576 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03031FSP 32-port 10GBASE-X EH1D2X32SSC0


interface card (SC, SFP+)

7.12.22 ET1D2X32SX2E-32-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (X2E,


SFP+)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 477


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Version Mapping

Table 7-577 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2X32SX2E Supported in V200R010C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2X32SX2E can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-256 Appearance of the ET1D2X32SX2E

Functions

Table 7-578 Functions of the ET1D2X32SX2E


Function Description

Basic functions Provides thirty-two 10GE optical ports for


data transmission and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping Supported

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-257 Indicators on the ET1D2X32SX2E panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31

13

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 478


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-579 Indicators on the ET1D2X32SX2E panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-258 Ports on the ET1D2X32SX2E panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31

1 Thirty-two 10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 479


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports support 10GE and GE auto sensing. Table 7-580
describes the attributes of a port working in 1000M mode, and Table 7-581 describes the
attributes of a port working in 10G mode. Table 7-582 describes the attributes of a 10GBASE
SFP+/1000BASE-X port using a copper module.

Table 7-580 Optical port attributes (GE optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2X32SX2E and their attributes, see
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-581 Optical port attributes (10GE optical module, high-speed cable or SFP+ optical
cable)
Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2X32SX2E and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules
(OSXD22N00 not supported), 9.11 10GE-
CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules and 9.12
10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 480


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-582 Optical port attributes (copper module)

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-583 Specifications of the ET1D2X32SX2E

Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.3 kg (7.28 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 213.7 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-584 Ordering information

Part Number Card Description Card Model

03031WHS 32-port 10GBASE-X ET1D2X32SX2E


interface card (X2E, SFP+)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 481


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

7.12.23 ET1D2X32SX2S-32-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (X2S,


SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-585 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2X32SX2S Supported in V200R010C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2X32SX2S can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-259 Appearance of the ET1D2X32SX2S

Functions

Table 7-586 Functions of the ET1D2X32SX2S


Function Description

Basic functions Provides thirty-two 10GE optical ports for


data transmission and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping Supported

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-260 Indicators on the ET1D2X32SX2S panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31

13

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 482


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-587 Indicators on the ET1D2X32SX2S panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-261 Ports on the ET1D2X32SX2S panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31

1 Thirty-two 10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 483


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports support 10GE and GE auto sensing. Table 7-588
describes the attributes of a port working in 1000M mode, and Table 7-589 describes the
attributes of a port working in 10G mode. Table 7-590 describes the attributes of a 10GBASE
SFP+/1000BASE-X port using a copper module.

Table 7-588 Optical port attributes (GE optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2X32SX2S and their attributes, see
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-589 Optical port attributes (10GE optical module, high-speed cable or SFP+ optical
cable)
Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2X32SX2S and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules
(OSXD22N00 not supported), 9.11 10GE-
CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules and 9.12
10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 484


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-590 Optical port attributes (copper module)

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-591 Specifications of the ET1D2X32SX2S

Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.2 kg (7.05 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 203.3 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-592 Ordering information

Part Number Card Description Card Model

03031YGE 32-port 10GBASE-X ET1D2X32SX2S


interface card (X2S, SFP+)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 485


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

7.12.24 ET1D2X32SX2H-32-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (X2H,


SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-593 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2X32SX2H Supported in V200R010C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2X32SX2H can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-262 Appearance of the ET1D2X32SX2H

Functions

Table 7-594 Functions of the ET1D2X32SX2H


Function Description

Basic functions Provides thirty-two 10GE optical ports for


data transmission and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping Supported

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-263 Indicators on the ET1D2X32SX2H panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31

13

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 486


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-595 Indicators on the ET1D2X32SX2H panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-264 Ports on the ET1D2X32SX2H panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31

1 Thirty-two 10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 487


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports support 10GE and GE auto sensing. Table 7-596
describes the attributes of a port working in 1000M mode, and Table 7-597 describes the
attributes of a port working in 10G mode. Table 7-598 describes the attributes of a 10GBASE
SFP+/1000BASE-X port using a copper module.

Table 7-596 Optical port attributes (GE optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2X32SX2H and their attributes, see
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-597 Optical port attributes (10GE optical module, high-speed cable or SFP+ optical
cable)
Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2X32SX2H and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules
(OSXD22N00 not supported), 9.11 10GE-
CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules and 9.12
10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 488


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-598 Optical port attributes (copper module)

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-599 Specifications of the ET1D2X32SX2H

Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.3 kg (7.28 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 214.9 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-600 Ordering information

Part Number Card Description Card Model

03032AUQ 32-port 10GBASE-X ET1D2X32SX2H


interface card (X2H, SFP+)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 489


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

7.12.25 EH1D2X40SFC0-40-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (FC,


SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-601 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2X40SFC0 Supported in V200R001C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
This EH1D2X40SFC0 can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-265 Appearance of the EH1D2X40SFC0

Functions

Table 7-602 Functions of the EH1D2X40SFC0


Function Description

Basic function Provides forty 1000M/10GE BASE-X


optical ports for data transmission and
switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Software feature Service port clustering

Hot swapping The EH1D2X40SFC0 is hot swappable.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 490


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Usage Constraints

When service ports on an EH1D2X40SFC0 card need to be used to set up a CSS, the card can
only be installed in the S9712 or S9706 chassis and must use 10G optical modules or 10G
cables.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-266 Indicators on the EH1D2X40SFC0 panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Table 7-603 Indicators on the EH1D2X40SFC0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 491


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-267 Ports on the EH1D2X40SFC0 panel


1

RUN/ALM

1 Forty 10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X optical ports

NOTE

l When a lot of cables are connected to a card, the cable management frame for this slot may not have
sufficient space. In this case, deploy cables in three layers that do not cross over each other, and then
put the three layers through the cable management frame. See Figure 7-268.
l It is not recommended to connect copper cables and optical fibers to the same card because copper
cables may block the routes of optical fibers. If copper cables and optical fibers are used on the same
card, connect the optical fibers to ports near the left side of the card and the copper cables to ports
near the right side, as shown in Figure 7-269.

Figure 7-268 Three layers of cables in a cable management frame

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 492


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-269 Arrangement of optical fibers and SFP+ cables

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X optical port


10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X optical ports support 10GE and GE auto sensing. Table 7-604
lists the attributes of a 1000M BASE-X optical port, and Table 7-605 lists the attributes of a
10GE BASE-SFP+ optical port. Table 7-606 lists the attributes of a 10GBASE SFP+/
1000BASE-X optical port with a copper module installed.

Table 7-604 Optical port attributes (GE optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For the optical modules supported by the
EH1D2X40SFC0 and their attributes, see
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7 GE-
CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and 9.8
GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-605 Optical port attributes (10GE optical module, high-speed cable or SFP+ optical
cable)
Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 493


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
EH1D2X40SFC0 and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules, 9.11
10GE-CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules and
9.12 10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical
Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-606 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(1000 Mbit/s rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-607 Specifications of the EH1D2X40SFC0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.90 kg (6.39 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 183 W

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 494


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Item Description

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-608 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030NXM 40-port 10GBASE-X EH1D2X40SFC0


interface card (FC, SFP+)

7.12.26 ET1D2X48SEC0-48-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (EC,


SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-609 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2X48SEC0 Supported only in V200R012C00 and


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2X48SEC0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-270 Appearance of the ET1D2X48SEC0

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 495


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions
The ET1D2X48SEC0 provides the following functions:
l Communicates with the MPU and works under the control of the MPU.
l Searches for routes and destination addresses of data packets for forwarding.
l Forwards data packets.

Table 7-610 Functions of the ET1D2X48SEC0


Function Description

Basic functions Provides forty-eight 1000M/10G BASE-X


ports for data access and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2X48SEC0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-271 Indicators on the ET1D2X48SEC0 panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Table 7-611 Indicators on the ET1D2X48SEC0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 496


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-272 Ports on the ET1D2X48SEC0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports

NOTE

l When a lot of cables are connected to a card, the cable management frame for this slot may not have
sufficient space. In this case, deploy cables in three layers that do not cross over each other, and then
put the three layers through the cable management frame. See Figure 7-273.
l It is not recommended to connect copper cables and optical fibers to the same card because copper
cables may block the routes of optical fibers. If copper cables and optical fibers are used on the same
card, connect the optical fibers to ports near the left side of the card and the copper cables to ports
near the right side, as shown in Figure 7-274.

Figure 7-273 Three layers of cables in a cable management frame

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 497


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-274 Optical fibers and SFP+ cables on the same card

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X port


10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports support 10GE and GE auto sensing.

Table 7-612 Optical port attributes (GE optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For the SFP optical modules supported by
the ET1D2X48SEC0 and their attributes,
see 9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7
GE-CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and
9.8 GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-613 Optical port attributes (10GE optical module, high-speed cable or SFP+ optical
cable)
Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2X48SEC0 and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules, 9.11
10GE-CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules and
9.12 10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical
Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 498


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-614 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(1000 Mbit/s rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-615 Specifications of the ET1D2X48SEC0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.42 kg (7.54 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 300 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 499


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-616 Ordering information

Part Number Card Name Card Model

03030SGC 48-port 10GBASE-X ET1D2X48SEC0


interface card (EC, SFP+)

7.12.27 EH1D2X48SEC0-48-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (EC,


SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-617 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2X48SEC0 Supported in V200R005C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2X48SEC0 can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-275 Appearance of the EH1D2X48SEC0

Functions
The EH1D2X48SEC0 provides the following functions:
l Communicates with the MPU and works under the control of the MPU.
l Searches for routes and destination addresses of data packets for forwarding.
l Forwards data packets.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 500


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-618 Functions of the EH1D2X48SEC0


Function Description

Basic functions Provides forty-eight 1000M/10G BASE-X


ports for data access and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The EH1D2X48SEC0 is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-276 Indicators on the EH1D2X48SEC0 panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Table 7-619 Indicators on the EH1D2X48SEC0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 501


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-277 Ports on the EH1D2X48SEC0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports

NOTE

l When a lot of cables are connected to a card, the cable management frame for this slot may not have
sufficient space. In this case, deploy cables in three layers that do not cross over each other, and then
put the three layers through the cable management frame. See Figure 7-278.
l It is not recommended to connect copper cables and optical fibers to the same card because copper
cables may block the routes of optical fibers. If copper cables and optical fibers are used on the same
card, connect the optical fibers to ports near the left side of the card and the copper cables to ports
near the right side, as shown in Figure 7-279.

Figure 7-278 Three layers of cables in a cable management frame

Figure 7-279 Optical fibers and SFP+ cables on the same card

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 502


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X port


10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports support 10GE and GE auto sensing.

Table 7-620 Optical port attributes (GE optical module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For the SFP optical modules supported by
the EH1D2X48SEC0 and their attributes,
see 9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7
GE-CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and
9.8 GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-621 Optical port attributes (10GE optical module, high-speed cable or SFP+ optical
cable)
Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
EH1D2X48SEC0 and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules, 9.11
10GE-CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules and
9.12 10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical
Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 503


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-622 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(1000 Mbit/s rates).

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-623 Specifications of the EH1D2X48SEC0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.42 kg (7.54 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 300 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-624 Ordering information


Part Number Card Name Card Model

03030RPH 48-port 10GBASE-X EH1D2X48SEC0


interface card (EC, SFP+)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 504


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

7.12.28 ET1D2X48SX2S-48-Port 10GBASE-X Interface Card (X2S,


SFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-625 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2X48SX2S Supported in V200R010C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2X48SX2S can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-280 Appearance of the ET1D2X48SX2S

Functions
The ET1D2X48SX2S provides the following functions:
l Communicates with the MPU and works under the control of the MPU.
l Searches for routes and destination addresses of data packets for forwarding.
l Forwards data packets.

Table 7-626 Functions of the ET1D2X48SX2S


Function Description

Basic functions Provides forty-eight 1000M/10G BASE-X


ports for data access and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2X48SX2S is hot swappable.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 505


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-281 Indicators on the ET1D2X48SX2S panel


24 5
RUN/ALM

13

Table 7-627 Indicators on the ET1D2X48SX2S panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT indicator Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


of a lower and receiving data.
optical port

2 ACT indicator
of an upper
optical port

3 LINK indicator Green Steady on: A link has been


of a lower established on the port.
optical port

4 LINK indicator
of an upper
optical port

5 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 506


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-282 Ports on the ET1D2X48SX2S panel


1
RUN/ALM

1 Forty-eight 10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports

NOTE

l When a lot of cables are connected to a card, the cable management frame for this slot may not have
sufficient space. In this case, deploy cables in three layers that do not cross over each other, and then
put the three layers through the cable management frame. See Figure 7-283.
l It is not recommended to connect copper cables and optical fibers to the same card because copper
cables may block the routes of optical fibers. If copper cables and optical fibers are used on the same
card, connect the optical fibers to ports near the left side of the card and the copper cables to ports
near the right side, as shown in Figure 7-284.

Figure 7-283 Three layers of cables in a cable management frame

Figure 7-284 Optical fibers and SFP+ cables on the same card

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X port

10GBASE SFP+/1000BASE-X ports support 10GE and GE auto sensing.

Table 7-628 Optical port attributes (GE optical module)

Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 507


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For the SFP optical modules supported by
the ET1D2X48SX2S and their attributes,
see 9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules, 9.7
GE-CWDM eSFP Optical Modules, and
9.8 GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3z

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-629 Optical port attributes (10GE optical module, high-speed cable or SFP+ optical
cable)
Attribute Description

Connector type SFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed


cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m, 10 m), QSFP+ -
4*SFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
SFP+ optical module, or SFP+ optical
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
ET1D2X48SX2S and their attributes, see
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules
(OSXD22N00 not supported), 9.11 10GE-
CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules and 9.12
10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ae

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Table 7-630 Optical port attributes (copper module)


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP copper module used.


For details on the copper modules supported
by the cards and attributes of the copper
modules, see 9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
(100 Mbit/s and 1000 Mbit/s rates).

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 508


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Standards compliance IEEE 802.3ab

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-631 Specifications of the ET1D2X48SX2S

Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.4 kg (7.50 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 258.1 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-632 Ordering information

Part Number Card Name Card Model

03031WJA 48-port 10GBASE-X ET1D2X48SX2S


interface card (X2S, SFP+)

7.13 40GE Interface Cards

7.13.1 ET1D2L02QSC0-2-Port 40GBASE-X Interface Card (SC,


QSFP+)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 509


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Version Mapping

Table 7-633 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2L02QSC0 Supported only in V200R012C00 and


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2L02QSC0 can be installed in:

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-285 Appearance of the ET1D2L02QSC0

Functions

Table 7-634 Functions of the ET1D2L02QSC0

Function Description

Basic function l Provides two 40GE optical ports for data


transmission and line-rate switching.
l Allows a 40GE port to split into four
10GE ports.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2L02QSC0 is hot swappable.

Application
A 40GE network can be established by installing 40GE cards on aggregation switches and
core switches, as shown in Figure 7-286.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 510


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-286 40GE cards deployed on a campus network

Branch

Visitor Branch

Eth-trunk
Router
CSS

40GE line
Firewall

Data center

Core switch

DMZ
Aggregation
switch

AP
Access switch

A 40GE network with 40GE cards deployed has the following advantages:
l Provides higher bandwidth.
l Is compatible with 10GE networks because a 40GE interface can be split into four 10GE
interfaces. This feature enables customers to seamlessly upgrade their 10GE networks to
40GE networks.
l Has a higher efficiency and lower packet loss ratio than a 40GE network established by
bundling four 10GE lines for load balancing.
The 40GE cards are used on networks that need to provide high bandwidth, for example,
video surveillance bearer networks and high-definition (HD) video conference bearer
networks. The following uses an HD video conference bearer network as an example to
describe application of 40GE cards.
Transmission of HD video and voice flows consumes high bandwidth on a network,
especially on the aggregation layer and core layer. The bandwidth of aggregation and core
devices usually becomes a bottleneck on an HD video conference bearer network. As shown
in Figure 7-286, 40GE cards are deployed on the aggregation layer and core layer to transmit
HD video and voice flows faster, more efficiently, with fewer packets lost. This deployment
ensures sufficient bandwidth for the HD video conference bearer network and delivers high
quality HD images and voice.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 511


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-287 Indicators on the ET1D2L02QSC0 panel


1 3
RUN/ALM

TX 0 RX TX 1 RX
0 1
ACT ACT

LINK LINK

Table 7-635 Indicators on the ET1D2L02QSC0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


and receiving data.

2 LINK Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-288 Ports on the ET1D2L02QSC0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

TX 0 RX TX 1 RX
0 1
ACT ACT

LINK LINK

1 Two 40GE BASE-X optical ports

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 512


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

40GE BASE-X optical port


Table 7-636 lists the attributes of a 40GE BASE-X optical port.

Table 7-636 40GE BASE-X optical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type QSFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the QSFP+ optical module,


QSFP+ - QSFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3
m, 5 m), QSFP+ - 4*SFP+ high-speed
cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m) or QSFP+ AOC
cable used.
For details on optical modules supported by
the ET1D2L02QSC0 and their attributes,
see 9.16 40GE QSFP+ Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3ba

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-637 Specifications of the ET1D2L02QSC0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.50 kg (5.51 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 88 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 513


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-638 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030SHE 2-port 40GBASE-X ET1D2L02QSC0


interface card (SC, QSFP+)

7.13.2 EH1D2L02QFC0-2-Port 40GBASE-X Interface Card (FC,


QSFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-639 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2L02QFC0 Supported in V200R002C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2L02QFC0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-289 Appearance of the EH1D2L02QFC0

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 514


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-640 Functions of the EH1D2L02QFC0


Function Description

Basic function l Provides two 40GE optical ports for data


transmission and line-rate switching.
l Allows a 40GE port to split into four
10GE ports.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Software feature Service port clustering

Hot swapping The EH1D2L02QFC0 is hot swappable.

Application
A 40GE network can be established by installing 40GE cards on aggregation switches and
core switches (S9700), as shown in Figure 7-290.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 515


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-290 40GE cards deployed on a campus network

Branch

Visitor Branch

Eth-trunk
Router
CSS

40GE line
Firewall

Data center

Core switch

DMZ
Aggregation
switch

AP
Access switch

A 40GE network with 40GE cards deployed has the following advantages:
l Provides higher bandwidth.
l Is compatible with 10GE networks because a 40GE interface can be split into four 10GE
interfaces. This feature enables customers to seamlessly upgrade their 10GE networks to
40GE networks.
l Has a higher efficiency and lower packet loss ratio than a 40GE network established by
bundling four 10GE lines for load balancing.
The 40GE cards are used on networks that need to provide high bandwidth, for example,
video surveillance bearer networks and high-definition (HD) video conference bearer
networks. The following uses an HD video conference bearer network as an example to
describe application of 40GE cards.
Transmission of HD video and voice flows consumes high bandwidth on a network,
especially on the aggregation layer and core layer. The bandwidth of aggregation and core
devices usually becomes a bottleneck on an HD video conference bearer network. As shown
in Figure 7-290, 40GE cards are deployed on the aggregation layer and core layer to transmit
HD video and voice flows faster, more efficiently, with fewer packets lost. This deployment
ensures sufficient bandwidth for the HD video conference bearer network and delivers high
quality HD images and voice.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 516


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Usage Constraints

When service ports on an EH1D2L02QFC0 card need to be used to set up a CSS, the card can
only be installed in the S9712 or S9706 chassis.
The EH1D2L02QFC0 can forward packets at line speed in any LPU slot on the S9703, S9706
and S9712.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-291 Indicators on the EH1D2L02QFC0 panel


1 3

RUN/ALM

TX 0 RX TX 1 RX
0 1
ACT ACT

LINK LINK

Table 7-641 Indicators on the EH1D2L02QFC0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


and receiving data.

2 LINK Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 517


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-292 Ports on the EH1D2L02QFC0 panel


1

RUN/ALM

TX 0 RX TX 1 RX
0 1
ACT ACT

LINK LINK

1 Two 40GE BASE-X optical ports

40GE BASE-X optical port

Table 7-642 lists the attributes of a 40GE BASE-X optical port.

Table 7-642 40GE BASE-X optical port attributes

Attribute Description

Connector type QSFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the QSFP+ optical module,


QSFP+ - QSFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3
m, 5 m), QSFP+ - 4*SFP+ high-speed
cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m) or QSFP+ AOC
cable used.
For details on optical modules supported by
the EH1D2L02QFC0 and their attributes,
see 9.16 40GE QSFP+ Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3ba

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-643 Specifications of the EH1D2L02QFC0

Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.50 kg (5.51 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 88 W

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 518


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Item Description

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-644 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03021RNK 2-port 40GBASE-X EH1D2L02QFC0


interface card (FC, QSFP+)

7.13.3 ET1D2L08QSC0-8-Port 40GBASE-X Interface Card (SC,


QSFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-645 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2L08QSC0 Supported only in V200R012C00 and


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2L08QSC0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-293 Appearance of the ET1D2L08QSC0

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 519


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-646 Functions of the ET1D2L08QSC0


Function Description

Basic function l Provides eight 40GE optical ports for


data transmission and line-rate
switching.
l Allows a 40GE port to split into four
10GE ports.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2L08QSC0 is hot swappable.

Application
A 40GE network can be established by installing 40GE cards on aggregation switches and
core switches, as shown in Figure 7-294.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 520


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-294 40GE cards deployed on a campus network

Branch

Visitor Branch

Eth-trunk
Router
CSS

40GE line
Firewall

Data center

Core switch

DMZ
Aggregation
switch

AP
Access switch

A 40GE network with 40GE cards deployed has the following advantages:
l Provides higher bandwidth.
l Is compatible with 10GE networks because a 40GE interface can be split into four 10GE
interfaces. This feature enables customers to seamlessly upgrade their 10GE networks to
40GE networks.
l Has a higher efficiency and lower packet loss ratio than a 40GE network established by
bundling four 10GE lines for load balancing.
The 40GE cards are used on networks that need to provide high bandwidth, for example,
video surveillance bearer networks and high-definition (HD) video conference bearer
networks. The following uses an HD video conference bearer network as an example to
describe application of 40GE cards.
Transmission of HD video and voice flows consumes high bandwidth on a network,
especially on the aggregation layer and core layer. The bandwidth of aggregation and core
devices usually becomes a bottleneck on an HD video conference bearer network. As shown
in Figure 7-294, 40GE cards are deployed on the aggregation layer and core layer to transmit
HD video and voice flows faster, more efficiently, with fewer packets lost. This deployment
ensures sufficient bandwidth for the HD video conference bearer network and delivers high
quality HD images and voice.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 521


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-295 Indicators on the ET1D2L08QSC0 panel


1 3
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 TX 0 RX TX 1 RX TX 2 RX TX 3 RX TX 4 RX TX 5 RX TX 6 RX TX 7 RX 4 5 6 7
ACT ACT

LINK LINK

Table 7-647 Indicators on the ET1D2L08QSC0


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


and receiving data.

2 LINK Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-296 Ports on the ET1D2L08QSC0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 TX 0 RX TX 1 RX TX 2 RX TX 3 RX TX 4 RX TX 5 RX TX 6 RX TX 7 RX 4 5 6 7
ACT ACT

LINK LINK

1 Eight 40GE BASE-X optical ports

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 522


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

NOTE

When multiple QSFP+ cables are connected to an ET1D2L08QSC0 card, divide all the cables on the
card into two bundles. Route the two bundles in two layers through the cable management frame to
ensure that the bend radius of the cables is in the allowed range.
40GE BASE-X optical port
Table 7-648 lists the attributes of a 40GE BASE-X optical port.

Table 7-648 40GE BASE-X optical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type QSFP+

Optical port attribute Depend on the QSFP+ optical module,


QSFP+ - QSFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3
m, 5 m), QSFP+ - 4*SFP+ high-speed
cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m) or QSFP+ AOC
cable used.
For details on optical modules supported by
the ET1D2L08QSC0 and their attributes,
see 9.16 40GE QSFP+ Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3ba

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-649 Specifications of the ET1D2L08QSC0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.80 kg (6.17 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 157.2 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 523


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-650 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030SHF 8-port 40GBASE-X ET1D2L08QSC0


interface card (SC, QSFP+)

7.13.4 EH1D2L08QFC0-8-Port 40GBASE-X Interface Card (FC,


QSFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-651 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2L08QFC0 Supported in V200R002C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2L08QFC0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-297 Appearance of the EH1D2L08QFC0

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 524


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-652 Functions of the EH1D2L08QFC0


Function Description

Basic function l Provides eight 40GE optical ports for


data transmission and switching.
l Allows a 40GE port to split into four
10GE ports.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Software feature Service port clustering

Hot swapping The EH1D2L08QFC0 is hot swappable.

Application
A 40GE network can be established by installing 40GE cards on aggregation switches and
core switches, as shown in Figure 7-298.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 525


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-298 40GE cards deployed on a campus network

Branch

Visitor Branch

Eth-trunk
Router
CSS

40GE line
Firewall

Data center

Core switch

DMZ
Aggregation
switch

AP
Access switch

A 40GE network with 40GE cards deployed has the following advantages:
l Provides higher bandwidth.
l Is compatible with 10GE networks because a 40GE interface can be split into four 10GE
interfaces. This feature enables customers to seamlessly upgrade their 10GE networks to
40GE networks.
l Has a higher efficiency and lower packet loss ratio than a 40GE network established by
bundling four 10GE lines for load balancing.
The 40GE cards are used on networks that need to provide high bandwidth, for example,
video surveillance bearer networks and high-definition (HD) video conference bearer
networks. The following uses an HD video conference bearer network as an example to
describe application of 40GE cards.
Transmission of HD video and voice flows consumes high bandwidth on a network,
especially on the aggregation layer and core layer. The bandwidth of aggregation and core
devices usually becomes a bottleneck on an HD video conference bearer network. As shown
in Figure 7-298, 40GE cards are deployed on the aggregation layer and core layer to transmit
HD video and voice flows faster, more efficiently, with fewer packets lost. This deployment
ensures sufficient bandwidth for the HD video conference bearer network and delivers high
quality HD images and voice.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 526


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Usage Constraints

When service ports on an EH1D2L08QFC0 card need to be used to set up a CSS, the card can
only be installed on the S9712 or S9706 chassis.
The EH1D2L08QFC0 can forward packets at line speed in any LPU slot on the S9703 or
S9706. When an EH1D2L08QFC0 card is installed in slot 6 or slot 7 of an S9712 chassis, you
can run the set fabric-mode turbo command to enable line-rate forwarding on this card.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-299 Indicators on the EH1D2L08QFC0 panel


1 3

RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 TX 0 RX TX 1 RX TX 2 RX TX 3 RX TX 4 RX TX 5 RX TX 6 RX TX 7 RX 4 5 6 7
ACT ACT

LINK LINK

Table 7-653 Indicators on the EH1D2L08QFC0


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


and receiving data.

2 LINK Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 527


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-300 Ports on the EH1D2L08QFC0 panel


1

RUN/ALM

0 1 2 3 TX 0 RX TX 1 RX TX 2 RX TX 3 RX TX 4 RX TX 5 RX TX 6 RX TX 7 RX 4 5 6 7
ACT ACT

LINK LINK

1 Eight 40GE BASE-X optical ports

NOTE

When multiple QSFP+ cables are connected to an EH1D2L08QFC0 card, divide all the cables on the
card into two bundles. Route the two bundles in two layers through the cable management frame to
ensure that the bend radius of the cables is in the allowed range.
40GE BASE-X optical port

Table 7-654 lists the attributes of a 40GE BASE-X optical port.

Table 7-654 40GE BASE-X optical port attributes

Attribute Description

Connector type QSFP+

Optical port attribute Depend on the QSFP+ optical module,


QSFP+ - QSFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3
m, 5 m), QSFP+ - 4*SFP+ high-speed
cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m) or QSFP+ AOC
cable used.
For details on optical modules supported by
the EH1D2L08QFC0 and their attributes,
see 9.16 40GE QSFP+ Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3ba

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 528


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-655 Specifications of the EH1D2L08QFC0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 2.80 kg (6.17 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 157.2 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-656 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03021PHM 8-port 40GBASE-X EH1D2L08QFC0


interface card (FC, QSFP+)

7.13.5 EH1D2L08QX2E-8-Port 40GBASE-X Interface Card (X2E,


QSFP+)

Version Mapping

Table 7-657 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2L08QX2E Supported in V200R010C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2L08QX2E can be installed in:

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 529


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.


l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-301 Appearance of the EH1D2L08QX2E

Functions

Table 7-658 Functions of the EH1D2L08QX2E


Function Description

Basic function l Provides eight 40GE Ethernet optical


ports for data access and switching.
l Allows a 40GE port to split into four
10GE ports.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping Supported

Application
A 40GE network can be established by installing 40GE cards on aggregation switches and
core switches, as shown in Figure 7-302.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 530


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-302 40GE cards deployed on a campus network

Branch

Visitor Branch

Eth-trunk
Router
CSS

40GE line
Firewall

Data center

Core switch

DMZ
Aggregation
switch

AP
Access switch

A 40GE network with 40GE cards deployed has the following advantages:
l Provides higher bandwidth.
l Is compatible with 10GE networks because a 40GE interface can be split into four 10GE
interfaces. This feature enables customers to seamlessly upgrade their 10GE networks to
40GE networks.
l Has a higher efficiency and lower packet loss ratio than a 40GE network established by
bundling four 10GE lines for load balancing.
The 40GE cards are used on networks that need to provide high bandwidth, for example,
video surveillance bearer networks and high-definition (HD) video conference bearer
networks. The following uses an HD video conference bearer network as an example to
describe application of 40GE cards.
Transmission of HD video and voice flows consumes high bandwidth on a network,
especially on the aggregation layer and core layer. The bandwidth of aggregation and core
devices usually becomes a bottleneck on an HD video conference bearer network. As shown
in Figure 7-302, 40GE cards are deployed on the aggregation layer and core layer to transmit
HD video and voice flows faster, more efficiently, with fewer packets lost. This deployment
ensures sufficient bandwidth for the HD video conference bearer network and delivers high
quality HD images and voice.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 531


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-303 Indicators on the EH1D2L08QX2E panel


1 3
RUN/ALM

TX 0 RX TX 1 RX TX 2 RX TX 3 RX TX 4 RX TX 5 RX TX 6 RX TX 7 RX
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
ACT ACT

LINK LINK

Table 7-659 Indicators on the EH1D2L08QX2E panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


and receiving data.

2 LINK Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-304 Ports on the EH1D2L08QX2E panel


1
RUN/ALM

TX 0 RX TX 1 RX TX 2 RX TX 3 RX TX 4 RX TX 5 RX TX 6 RX TX 7 RX
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
ACT ACT

LINK LINK

1 Eight 40GBASE-X ports to transmit and receive service data

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 532


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

NOTE

When multiple QSFP+ cables are connected to an EH1D2L08QX2E card, divide all the cables on the
card into two bundles. Route the two bundles in two layers through the cable management frame to
ensure that the bend radius of the cables is in the allowed range.
40GBASE-X port
Table 7-660 lists attributes of a 40GBASE-X port.

Table 7-660 40GBASE-X port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type QSFP+

Optical attributes Depend on the QSFP+ optical module,


QSFP+ - QSFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3
m, 5 m), QSFP+ - 4*SFP+ high-speed
cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m) or QSFP+ AOC
cable used.
For the optical modules supported by the
EH1D2L08QX2E and their attributes, see
9.16 40GE QSFP+ Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3ba

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Specifications

Table 7-661 Specifications of the EH1D2L08QX2E


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.0 kg (6.61 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 178.4 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 533


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-662 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03031WAS 8-port 40GBASE-X EH1D2L08QX2E


interface card (X2E, QSFP
+)

7.14 40GE/100GE Interface Cards

7.14.1 ET1D2H02QX2S-2-Port 100GE QSFP28 Interface and 2-Port


40GE QSFP+ Interface Card (X2S, QSFP28)

Version Mapping

Table 7-663 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2H02QX2S Supported in V200R010C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2H02QX2S can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-305 Appearance of the ET1D2H02QX2S

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 534


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-664 Functions of the ET1D2H02QX2S


Function Description

Basic functions Provides two 40GE optical ports and two


100GE optical ports for data transmission
and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping Supported

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-306 Indicators on the ET1D2H02QX2S panel


1 3
RUN/ALM

TX 0 RX TX 1 RX TX 0 RX TX 1 RX
ACT0 ACT1 ACT0 ACT1

LINK0 LINK1 LINK0 LINK1


100G 40G

Table 7-665 Indicators on the ET1D2H02QX2S panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


and receiving data.

2 LINK Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 535


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-307 Ports on the ET1D2H02QX2S panel


1 2
RUN/ALM

TX 0 RX TX 1 RX TX 0 RX TX 1 RX
ACT0 ACT1 ACT0 ACT1

LINK0 LINK1 LINK0 LINK1


100G 40G

1 Two 100GE optical ports to transmit and receive service traffic at 40


Gbit/s or 100 Gbit/s
2 Two 40GE BASE-X optical ports to transmit and receive service traffic at
40 Gbit/s

100GE optical port


Table 7-666 lists the attributes of a 100GE optical port.

Table 7-666 Attributes of a 100GE optical port


Attribute Description

Connector type QSFP28

Optical port attributes Depend on the QSFP28 - QSFP28 high-


speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m), QSFP+ -
QSFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
9.16 40GE QSFP+ Optical Modules, 9.19
100GE QSFP28 Optical Modules or
QSFP+ or QSFP28 AOC cable used.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 536


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Applicable cable QSFP+ optical module and LC optical fiber


QSFP+ optical module and MPO optical
fiber (MPO-MPO or MPO-4*DLC optical
fiber)
QSFP+ high-speed copper cable
QSFP+ AOC cable
QSFP28 optical module and LC optical
fiber
QSFP28 optical module and MPO optical
fiber (MPO-MPO)
QSFP28 high-speed copper cable
QSFP28 AOC cable

40GE BASE-X optical port


Table 7-667 lists the attributes of a 40GE BASE-X optical port.

Table 7-667 40GE BASE-X optical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type QSFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the QSFP+ optical module,


QSFP+ - QSFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3
m, 5 m), QSFP+ - 4*SFP+ high-speed
cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m) or QSFP+ AOC
cable used.
For details on optical modules supported by
the ET1D2H02QX2S and their attributes,
see 9.16 40GE QSFP+ Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3ba

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 537


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-668 Specifications of the ET1D2H02QX2S

Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.05 kg (6.72 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 143.5 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to 158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-669 Ordering information

Part Number Card Description Card Model

03031YGC 2-Port 100GE QSFP28 ET1D2H02QX2S


Interface and 2-Port 40GE
QSFP+ Interface Card (X2S,
QSFP28)

7.14.2 ET1D2H02QX2E-2-Port 100GE QSFP28 Interface and 2-Port


40GE QSFP+ Interface Card (X2E, QSFP28)

Version Mapping

Table 7-670 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2H02QX2E Supported in V200R010C00 to


V200R013C00

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 538


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Introduction
The ET1D2H02QX2E can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-308 Appearance of the ET1D2H02QX2E

Functions

Table 7-671 Functions of the ET1D2H02QX2E


Function Description

Basic functions Provides two 40GE optical ports and two


100GE optical ports for data transmission
and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping The ET1D2H02QX2E is hot swappable.

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-309 Indicators on the ET1D2H02QX2E panel


1 3
RUN/ALM

TX 0 RX TX 1 RX TX 0 RX TX 1 RX
ACT0 ACT1 ACT0 ACT1

LINK0 LINK1 LINK0 LINK1


100G 40G

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 539


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-672 Indicators on the ET1D2H02QX2E panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


and receiving data.

2 LINK Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-310 Ports on the ET1D2H02QX2E panel


1 2
RUN/ALM

TX 0 RX TX 1 RX TX 0 RX TX 1 RX
ACT0 ACT1 ACT0 ACT1

LINK0 LINK1 LINK0 LINK1


100G 40G

1 Two 100GE optical ports to transmit and receive service traffic at 40


Gbit/s or 100 Gbit/s
2 Two 40GE BASE-X optical ports to transmit and receive service traffic at
40 Gbit/s

100GE optical port


Table 7-673 lists the attributes of a 100GE optical port.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 540


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-673 Attributes of a 100GE optical port

Attribute Description

Connector type QSFP28

Optical port attributes Depend on the QSFP28 - QSFP28 high-


speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m), QSFP+ -
QSFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
9.16 40GE QSFP+ Optical Modules, 9.19
100GE QSFP28 Optical Modules or
QSFP+ or QSFP28 AOC cable used.

Applicable cable QSFP+ optical module and LC optical fiber


QSFP+ optical module and MPO optical
fiber (MPO-MPO or MPO-4*DLC optical
fiber)
QSFP+ high-speed copper cable
QSFP+ AOC cable
QSFP28 optical module and LC optical
fiber
QSFP28 optical module and MPO optical
fiber (MPO-MPO)
QSFP28 high-speed copper cable
QSFP28 AOC cable

40GE BASE-X optical port

Table 7-674 lists the attributes of a 40GE BASE-X optical port.

Table 7-674 40GE BASE-X optical port attributes

Attribute Description

Connector type QSFP+

Optical port attributes Depend on the QSFP+ optical module,


QSFP+ - QSFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3
m, 5 m), QSFP+ - 4*SFP+ high-speed
cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m) or QSFP+ AOC
cable used.
For details on optical modules supported by
the ET1D2H02QX2E and their attributes,
see 9.16 40GE QSFP+ Optical Modules.

Standards compliance IEEE802.3ba

Frame format Ethernet_II, Ethernet_SAP, Ethernet_SNAP

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 541


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-675 Specifications of the ET1D2H02QX2E


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.15 kg (6.94 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 153.1 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-676 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03031YGD 2-Port 100GE QSFP28 ET1D2H02QX2E


Interface and 2-Port 40GE
QSFP+ Interface Card
(X2E, QSFP28)

7.15 100GE Interface Cards

7.15.1 ET1D2C02FEE0-2-Port 100GBASE-X Interface Card (EE,


CFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-677 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2C02FEE0 Supported only in V200R012C00 and


V200R013C00

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 542


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Introduction
The ET1D2C02FEE0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-311 Appearance of the ET1D2C02FEE0

Functions

Table 7-678 Functions of the ET1D2C02FEE0


Function Description

Basic functions Provides two 100GE optical ports for data


transmission and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping Supported

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-312 Indicators on the ET1D2C02FEE0 panel


12 3 4
RUN/ALM

0 0 1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 2 3 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19

100G 40G 10G 100G 40G 10G

PORT0 CAUTION: CFP SURFACE MAY BE HOT PORT1

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 543


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-679 Indicators on the ET1D2C02FEE0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 When a 100GE Green Steady on: A link has been


port is not split, established on the 100GE port.
this indicator Blinking: The 100GE port is
shows the transmitting and receiving data.
status of the
100GE port.

2 When a 100GE Green When indicator 0 turns on, it shows


port is split the status of the first 40GE port
into two 40GE derived from the 100GE port.
ports, When indicator 1 turns on, it shows
indicators 0 the status of the second 40GE port.
and 1 show the Steady on: A link has been
status of the established on the 40GE port.
40GE ports.
Blinking: The 40GE port is
transmitting and receiving data.

3 When a 100GE Green When indicator 0 turns on, it shows


port is split the status of the first 10GE port
into ten 10GE derived from the 100GE port.
ports, Similarly, the other indicators turn
indicators 0 to on in sequence to show status of
9 show the the rest of 10GE ports.
status of the Steady on: A link has been
10GE ports. established on the 10GE port.
Blinking: The 10GE port is
transmitting and receiving data.

4 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 544


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-313 Ports on the ET1D2C02FEE0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 0 1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 2 3 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19

100G 40G 10G 100G 40G 10G

PORT0 CAUTION: CFP SURFACE MAY BE HOT PORT1

1 Two 100GE optical ports

100GE optical port

Table 7-680 lists the attributes of a 100GE optical port.

Table 7-680 Attributes of a 100GE optical port

Attribute Description

Connector type CFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the 9.17 40GE CFP Optical


Modules and 9.18 100GE CFP Optical
Modules used

Applicable cable CFP optical module and LC optical fiber


CFP optical module and MPO optical fiber
(MPO-MPO, MPO-2*MPO, or
MPO-10*DLC optical fiber)

Specifications

Table 7-681 Specifications of the ET1D2C02FEE0

Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 4.20 kg (9.26 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 339 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to 158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 545


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-682 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030WVE 2-port 100GBASE-X ET1D2C02FEE0


interface card (EE, CFP)

7.15.2 EH1D2C02FEE0-2-Port 100GBASE-X Interface Card (EE,


CFP)

Version Mapping

Table 7-683 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2C02FEE0 Supported in V200R008C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The EH1D2C02FEE0 can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-314 Appearance of the EH1D2C02FEE0

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 546


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-684 Functions of the EH1D2C02FEE0


Function Description

Basic functions Provides two 100GE optical ports for data


transmission and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping Supported

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-315 Indicators on the EH1D2C02FEE0 panel


12 3 4
RUN/ALM

0 0 1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 2 3 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19

100G 40G 10G 100G 40G 10G

PORT0 CAUTION: CFP SURFACE MAY BE HOT PORT1

Table 7-685 Indicators on the EH1D2C02FEE0 panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 When a 100GE Green Steady on: A link has been


port is not split, established on the 100GE port.
this indicator Blinking: The 100GE port is
shows the transmitting and receiving data.
status of the
100GE port.

2 When a 100GE Green When indicator 0 turns on, it shows


port is split the status of the first 40GE port
into two 40GE derived from the 100GE port.
ports, When indicator 1 turns on, it shows
indicators 0 the status of the second 40GE port.
and 1 show the Steady on: A link has been
status of the established on the 40GE port.
40GE ports.
Blinking: The 40GE port is
transmitting and receiving data.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 547


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

3 When a 100GE Green When indicator 0 turns on, it shows


port is split the status of the first 10GE port
into ten 10GE derived from the 100GE port.
ports, Similarly, the other indicators turn
indicators 0 to on in sequence to show status of
9 show the the rest of 10GE ports.
status of the Steady on: A link has been
10GE ports. established on the 10GE port.
Blinking: The 10GE port is
transmitting and receiving data.

4 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-316 Ports on the EH1D2C02FEE0 panel


1
RUN/ALM

0 0 1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 2 3 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19

100G 40G 10G 100G 40G 10G

PORT0 CAUTION: CFP SURFACE MAY BE HOT PORT1

1 Two 100GE optical ports

100GE optical port


Table 7-686 lists the attributes of a 100GE optical port.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 548


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-686 Attributes of a 100GE optical port


Attribute Description

Connector type CFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the 9.17 40GE CFP Optical


Modules and 9.18 100GE CFP Optical
Modules used

Applicable cable CFP optical module and LC optical fiber


CFP optical module and MPO optical fiber
(MPO-MPO, MPO-2*MPO, or
MPO-10*DLC optical fiber)

Specifications

Table 7-687 Specifications of the EH1D2C02FEE0


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 4.20 kg (9.26 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 339 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to 158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-688 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03030RYF 2-port 100GBASE-X EH1D2C02FEE0


interface card (EE, CFP)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 549


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

7.15.3 ET1D2C04HX2E-4-Port 100GE QSFP28 Interface Card (X2E,


QSFP28)

Version Mapping

Table 7-689 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2C04HX2E Supported in V200R010C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2C04HX2E can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-317 Appearance of the ET1D2C04HX2E

Functions

Table 7-690 Functions of the ET1D2C04HX2E


Function Description

Basic functions Provides four 100GE optical ports for data


transmission and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping Supported

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 550


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-318 Indicators on the ET1D2C04HX2E panel


1 3
RUN/ALM

TX 0 RX TX 1 RX TX 2 RX TX 3 RX
ACT0 ACT1 ACT2 ACT3

LINK0 LINK1 LINK2 LINK3

Table 7-691 Indicators on the ET1D2C04HX2E panel

Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


and receiving data.

2 LINK Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-319 Ports on the ET1D2C04HX2E panel


1
RUN/ALM

TX 0 RX TX 1 RX TX 2 RX TX 3 RX
ACT0 ACT1 ACT2 ACT3

LINK0 LINK1 LINK2 LINK3

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 551


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

1 Four 100GE optical ports to transmit and receive service traffic at 40


Gbit/s or 100 Gbit/s

100GE optical port


Table 7-692 lists the attributes of a 100GE optical port.

Table 7-692 Attributes of a 100GE optical port


Attribute Description

Connector type QSFP28

Optical port attributes Depend on the QSFP28 - QSFP28 high-


speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m), QSFP+ -
QSFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
9.16 40GE QSFP+ Optical Modules, 9.19
100GE QSFP28 Optical Modules or
QSFP+ or QSFP28 AOC cable used.

Applicable cable QSFP+ optical module and LC optical fiber


QSFP+ optical module and MPO optical
fiber (MPO-MPO or MPO-4*DLC optical
fiber)
QSFP+ high-speed copper cable
QSFP+ AOC cable
QSFP28 optical module and LC optical
fiber
QSFP28 optical module and MPO optical
fiber (MPO-MPO)
QSFP28 high-speed copper cable
QSFP28 AOC cable

Specifications

Table 7-693 Specifications of the ET1D2C04HX2E


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.15 kg (6.94 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 164.8 W

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 552


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Item Description

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-694 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03031YET 4-Port 100GE QSFP28 ET1D2C04HX2E


Interface Card (X2E,
QSFP28)

7.15.4 ET1D2C04HX2S-4-Port 100GE QSFP28 Interface Card (X2S,


QSFP28)

Version Mapping

Table 7-695 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

ET1D2C04HX2S Supported in V200R010C00 to


V200R013C00

Introduction
The ET1D2C04HX2S can be installed in:
l Slots 01 to 03 in an S9703 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 06 in an S9706 chassis.
l Slots 01 to 12 in an S9712 chassis.

Figure 7-320 Appearance of the ET1D2C04HX2S

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 553


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-696 Functions of the ET1D2C04HX2S


Function Description

Basic functions Provides four 100GE optical ports for data


transmission and switching.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Hot swapping Supported

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-321 Indicators on the ET1D2C04HX2S panel


1 3
RUN/ALM

TX 0 RX TX 1 RX TX 2 RX TX 3 RX
ACT0 ACT1 ACT2 ACT3

LINK0 LINK1 LINK2 LINK3

Table 7-697 Indicators on the ET1D2C04HX2S panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 ACT Yellow Blinking: The port is transmitting


and receiving data.

2 LINK Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.

3 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 554


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Number Indicator Color Description

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-322 Ports on the ET1D2C04HX2S panel


1
RUN/ALM

TX 0 RX TX 1 RX TX 2 RX TX 3 RX
ACT0 ACT1 ACT2 ACT3

LINK0 LINK1 LINK2 LINK3

1 Four 100GE optical ports to transmit and receive service traffic at 40


Gbit/s or 100 Gbit/s

100GE optical port


Table 7-698 lists the attributes of a 100GE optical port.

Table 7-698 Attributes of a 100GE optical port


Attribute Description

Connector type QSFP28

Optical port attributes Depend on the QSFP28 - QSFP28 high-


speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m), QSFP+ -
QSFP+ high-speed cable (1 m, 3 m, 5 m),
9.16 40GE QSFP+ Optical Modules, 9.19
100GE QSFP28 Optical Modules or
QSFP+ or QSFP28 AOC cable used.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 555


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Attribute Description

Applicable cable QSFP+ optical module and LC optical fiber


QSFP+ optical module and MPO optical
fiber (MPO-MPO or MPO-4*DLC optical
fiber)
QSFP+ high-speed copper cable
QSFP+ AOC cable
QSFP28 optical module and LC optical
fiber
QSFP28 optical module and MPO optical
fiber (MPO-MPO)
QSFP28 high-speed copper cable
QSFP28 AOC cable

Specifications

Table 7-699 Specifications of the ET1D2C04HX2S


Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.05 kg (6.72 lb)
l Maximum power consumption: 154.7 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-700 Ordering information


Part Number Card Description Card Model

03031WHR 4-Port 100GE QSFP28 ET1D2C04HX2S


Interface Card (X2S,
QSFP28)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 556


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

7.16 POS Interface Card

7.16.1 EH1D2WM00000 - WAN Interface Service Process Card

Version Mapping

Table 7-701 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card
Card Name S9700 Chassis

EH1D2WM00000 Supported only in V200R001C00,


V200R002C00, and V200R003C00

Introduction
The EH1D2WM00000 can be installed in any LPU slot on the S9712, S9706, or S9703
chassis.
The EH1D2WM00000 has two subcard slots and allows different types of subcards to be
installed in the slots at the same time. Table 7-702 lists the subcards for EH1D2WM00000
and the number and type of ports provided by each subcard.

Table 7-702 Subcard list


Subcard Name Ports

P1UF One OC-48c POS-SFP port

P4HF Four OC-12c POS-SFP ports

P4CF Four OC-3c POS-SFP ports

Figure 7-323 Appearance of the EH1D2WM00000

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 557


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Functions

Table 7-703 Functions of the EH1D2WM00000


Function Description

Basic function Provides 10 Gbit/s line-rate forwarding and


switching and supports the following
subcards:
l P1UF: provides one 2.5GE POS port.
l P4HF: provides four 622M POS ports.
l P4CF: provides four 155M POS ports.
Any two types of the subcards can be used
together.

Distributed forwarding Performs concurrent data forwarding using


a distributed data plane.

Queue Eight queues on each port

Traffic scheduling PQ+WFQ (PQ in queues 5, 6, and 7, and


WFQ in the other queues)

Software feature WAN features

Hot swapping The EH1D2WM00000 is hot swappable.

Usage Constraints

l When using the EH1D2WM00000, install an LE0D00CKMA00 daughter card on the


MPU. If the S9700 uses two MPUs, both MPUs must have an LE0D00CKMA00 daughter
card installed.
l When using an EH1D2WM00000 card, insert one or two subcards on the card; otherwise,
the EH1D2WM00000 card cannot work.
l The EH1D2WM00000 does not support hot swap of subcards.

Indicators and Slots

Figure 7-324 Indicators on the EH1D2WM00000 panel


1

RUN/ALM

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 558


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Table 7-704 Indicator on the EH1D2WM00000


Number Indicator Color Description

1 RUN/ALM: Green Steady on: The card has been


running status powered on, but the software is not
indicator running.
Slow blinking: The card software is
running properly.
Fast blinking: The card software is
starting.

Red Steady on: The card has failed and


the fault requires manual
intervention.

Yellow Steady on: The card is powered off.


(For example, the card has been
forcibly powered off using the
power off command or is about to
start.)

Figure 7-325 Slots on the EH1D2WM00000 panel

1. Two subcard slots. Subcards can be installed in the slots to provide POS optical ports.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 559


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-705 Specifications of the EH1D2WM00000

Item Description

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 394.7 mm x 426.8 mm x 35.1 mm (15.5


specifications in. x 16.8 in. x 1.4 in.)
l Weight: 3.80 kg (8.38 lb) (with a fireproof panel and two P1UF
subcards)
l Maximum power consumption:
Two P1UF subcards: 84 W
Two P4HF subcards: 91 W
Two P4CF subcards: 86 W

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-706 Ordering information

Card Description Card Model

WAN interface service processing card EH1D2WM00000

7.16.2 P1UF-1-Port OC-48c/STM-16c POS-SFP Flexible Card

Version Mapping

Table 7-707 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

P1UF Supported only in V200R001C00,


V200R002C00, and V200R003C00

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 560


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Introduction
The P1UF is an optional subcard that can be installed in a subcard slot on the
EH1D2WM00000.
You can choose to install this subcard based on service requirements. This subcard improves
service flexibility and facilitates service expansion.

Figure 7-326 Appearance of P1UF

Functions

Table 7-708 Functions of the P1UF


Function Description

Basic function Provides a 2.5 Gbit/s optical port and can be


used on the aggregation layer of an MPLS
backbone network.

Protocol and service PPP and HDLC

Port type SFP

Reliability and availability Hot swapping

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 561


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-327 Indicators on the P1UF panel

FPIC-4×OC 48-POS
TUS
STA
0 1
2
CT
K/A
LIN

Table 7-709 Indicators on the P1UF panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 STATUS Green Slow blinking: The card software is


running properly.
Fast blinking: The system is in the
alarm state.

2 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.
Blinking: The port is transmitting
and receiving data.
Off: No link is established on the
port.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 562


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-328 Ports on the P1UF panel

FPIC-4×OC 48-POS
TUS
STA

0
CT
K/A
LIN

1. One OC-3c/STM-1c POS-SFP optical port (2.5 Gbit/s)

OC-3c/STM-1c POS-SFP optical port


Table 7-710 lists the attributes of an OC-3c/STM-1c POS-SFP optical port.

Table 7-710 OC-3c/STM-1c POS-SFP optical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details on the optical modules supported
by the P1UF and their attributes, see 9.6
POS eSFP Optical Modules.

Duplex mode Full-duplex

Frame format PPP and HDLC

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 563


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-711 Specifications of the P1UF

Item Description

Network Enhanced command-line management interface


management SNMP and MIB

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 145 mm x 185 mm x 20 mm (5.7 in. x


specifications 7.3 in. x 0.8 in.)
l Weight: 0.50 kg (1.10 lb)
l Typical power consumption: 12 W
l Heat dissipation: 49 BTU/hour

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-712 Ordering information

Card Description Card Model

1-port OC-48c/STM-16c POS-SFP flexible P1UF


card

7.16.3 P4HF-4-Port OC-12c/STM-4c POS-SFP Flexible Card

Version Mapping

Table 7-713 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

P4HF Supported only in V200R001C00,


V200R002C00, and V200R003C00

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 564


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Introduction
The P4HF is an optional subcard that can be installed in a subcard slot on the
EH1D2WM00000.
You can choose to install this subcard based on service requirements. This subcard improves
service flexibility and facilitates service expansion.

Figure 7-329 Appearance of P4HF

Functions

Table 7-714 Functions of the P4HF


Function Description

Basic function Provides 622 Mbit/s optical ports and can be


used on the aggregation layer of an MPLS
backbone network.

Protocol and service PPP and HDLC

Port type SFP

Reliability and availability Hot swappable

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 565


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-330 Indicators on the P4HF panel

FPIC-4×OC 12-POS
TUS
STA
0 1
2
L/A
1

L/A
2

L/A
3

L/A

Table 7-715 Indicators on the P4HF panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 STATUS Green Slow blinking: The card software is


running properly.
Fast blinking: The system is in the
alarm state.

2 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.
Blinking: The port is transmitting
and receiving data.
Off: The link is disconnected.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 566


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-331 Ports on the P4HF panel

FPIC-4×OC 12-POS
TUS
STA

0
L/A

1
1 L/A

2
L/A
3

L/A

1. Four OC-12c/STM-4c POS-SFP FPIC optical ports (622 Mbit/s)

OC-12c/STM-4c POS-SFP FPIC optical port


Table 7-716 lists the attributes of an OC-12c/STM-4c POS-SFP FPIC optical port.

Table 7-716 Attributes of an OC-12c/STM-4c POS-SFP FPIC optical port


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details on the optical modules supported
by the P4HF and their attributes, see 9.6
POS eSFP Optical Modules.

Duplex mode Full-duplex

Frame format PPP and HDLC

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 567


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-717 Specifications of the P4HF

Item Description

Network Enhanced command-line management interface


management SNMP and MIB

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 145 mm x 185 mm x 20 mm (5.7 in. x


specifications 7.3 in. x 0.8 in.)
l Weight: 0.50 kg (1.10 lb)
l Typical power consumption: 15 W
l Heat dissipation: 65 BTU/hour

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-718 Ordering information

Card Description Card Model

4-port OC-12c/STM-4c POS-SFP flexible P4HF


card

7.16.4 P4CF-4-Port OC-3c/STM-1c POS-SFP Flexible Card

Version Mapping

Table 7-719 Switch chassis and software versions matching the card

Card Name S9700 Chassis

P4CF Supported only in V200R001C00,


V200R002C00, and V200R003C00

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 568


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Introduction
The P4CF is an optional subcard that can be installed in a subcard slot on the
EH1D2WM00000.
You can choose to install this subcard based on service requirements. This subcard improves
service flexibility and facilitates service expansion.

Figure 7-332 Appearance of P4CF

Functions

Table 7-720 Functions of the P4CF


Function Description

Basic function Provides 155 Mbit/s optical ports and can be


used on the aggregation layer of an MPLS
backbone network.

Protocol and service PPP and HDLC

Port type SFP

Reliability and availability Hot swapping

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 569


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Indicators and Ports

Figure 7-333 Indicators on the P4CF panel

FPIC-4×OC3-POS
TUS
STA
0 1
2
L/A
1

L/A
2

L/A
3

L/A

Table 7-721 Indicators on the P4CF panel


Number Indicator Color Description

1 STATUS Green Slow blinking: The card software is


running properly.
Fast blinking: The system is in the
alarm state.

2 LINK/ACT Green Steady on: A link has been


established on the port.
Blinking: The port is transmitting
and receiving data.
Off: No link is established on the
port.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 570


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Figure 7-334 Ports on the P4CF panel

FPIC-4×OC3-POS
TUS
STA

0
L/A

1
1 L/A

L/A2
3

L/A

1. Four OC-3c/STM-1c POS-SFP optical ports (155 Mbit/s)

OC-3c/STM-1c POS-SFP optical ports


Table 7-722 lists the attributes of an OC-3c/STM-1c POS-SFP optical port.

Table 7-722 OC-3c/STM-1c POS-SFP optical port attributes


Attribute Description

Connector type SFP

Optical port attributes Depend on the SFP optical module used.


For details on the optical modules supported
by the P4CF and their attributes, see 9.6
POS eSFP Optical Modules.

Duplex mode Full-duplex

Frame format PPP and HDLC

Network protocol IP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 571


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

Specifications

Table 7-723 Specifications of the P4CF


Item Description

Network Enhanced command-line management interface


management SNMP and MIB

Physical l Dimensions (W x D x H): 145 mm x 185 mm x 20 mm (5.7 in. x


specifications 7.3 in. x 0.8 in.)
l Weight: 0.50 kg (1.10 lb)
l Typical power consumption: 14 W
l Heat dissipation: 58 BTU/hour

Environment l Operating temperature: 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F)


specifications l Operating relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)
l Storage temperature: -40°C to +70°C (-40°F to +158°F)
l Storage relative humidity: 5% RH to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ordering Information
Card ordering information is subject to updates with product version upgrades. The ordering
information provided in this manual is for reference only. To obtain the latest ordering
information, contact Huawei switch distributors or Huawei local office.

Table 7-724 Ordering information


Card Description Card Model

4-port OC-3c/STM-1c POS-SFP flexible P4CF


card

7.17 User Manuals For ACU2, NGFW Module, and IPS


Module (S9700)
The S9700 supports service cards, including ACU2, Intrusion Protection System (IPS)
module, and Next-Generation Firewall (NGFW) module.
Each service card connects to a switch through two internal 20GE Ethernet links.
Services need to be configured on both the switch and service card; otherwise, the service
card cannot work normally.
For the commands and configuration procedures used on the switch, see the Command
Reference and Configuration Guide of switch products. Unless otherwise specified, the
commands and configuration procedures used on the Ethernet ports of switches and service
cards are identical.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 572


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

For the commands and configuration procedures used on the service card, see the user
manuals of the service card.

Table 7-725 lists the minimum software versions of the ACU2, NGFW module, and IPS
module matching the S9700. The minimum switch version matching the ACU2, NGFW
module, and IPS module is V200R005C00.

Table 7-725 Minimum version of the ACU2, NGFW module, and IPS module matching the
S9700

Service Card Minimum Version

ACU2 V200R005C00

NGFW module V100R001C10

IPS module V100R001C10

ACU2
The Access Controller Unit (ACU2) is supported by the S9700. An ACU2 is a card installed
on a switch, and can be used as an independent wireless access controller (AC).

For the hardware description and service configuration of the ACU2, see ACU2 Product
Documentation of the related version.

l For hardware information about the ACU2, see Installation - Hardware Installation and
Maintenance Guide - Access Controllers - Hardware Installation and Maintenance
Guide (ACU2).
l For the traffic import configuration and service configuration of the ACU2, see
Configuration - CLI-based Configuration - ACU2 Configuration Guide. In "ACU2
Configuration Guide", read "Configuring Communication Between ACU2 and a Switch"
and "Example for Configuring WLAN Services on a Small-Scale Network (ACU2)."

NGFW Module
The NGFW module is available for the S9700. After an NGFW module is installed on a
switch, the switch provides the firewall, NAT, and VPN functions.

The NGFW module models include ET1D2FW00S00, ET1D2FW00S01, and


ET1D2FW00S02.

For details about the NGFW module, see the NGFW Module Product Documentation of
the required version.
l For hardware information about the NGFW module, see Hardware Guide (NGFW
Module).
l For initial deployment (such as login and traffic import) of the NGFW module on the
switch, see Deployment Guide (NGFW Module).
l For service configuration of the NGFW module, see Administrator Guide.
l For typical configuration examples of the NGFW module, see Typical NGFW Module
Configuration.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 573


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 7 Cards

IPS Module
The IPS module available for the S9700 provides the intrusion defense function. After an IPS
module is installed on a switch, the switch provides the intrusion defense, antivirus, and anti-
DDoS functions.
The IPS module model is ET1D2IPS0S00.
For details about the IPS module, see IPS Module Product Documentation of the required
version.
l For hardware information about the IPS module, see Hardware Guide.
l For initial deployment (such as login and traffic import) of the IPS module on the switch,
see Deployment Guide.
l For service configuration of the IPS module, see Administrator Guide.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 574


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

8 Cables

About This Chapter

8.1 DC Power Cable


8.2 AC Power Cable
8.3 Ground Cable
8.4 Console Cable
8.5 Clock Cable
8.6 Ethernet Cable
8.7 High-Speed Cable
8.8 Optical Fiber

8.1 DC Power Cable

Connectors and power capacity of a power cable must match the device on which the cable is
used. Therefore, a device must use the power cables delivered with it.

Types of DC Power Cables


DC power cables of fixed lengths (integer number of meters) are delivered with switches. Cut
the DC power cables into appropriate lengths based on actual situations in your site.
DC power cables include -48 V power cables and RTN ground cables. The lengths and
terminal types of DC power cables used between power distribution boxes and power
distribution frames are determined by the site survey results. DC power cables with OT
terminals are connected to power modules, as shown in Figure 8-1.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 575


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

Figure 8-1 DC power cable with an OT terminal

1 2

1. Cord end terminal 2. OT terminal

Connection
The cord end terminal is connected to a power distribution box or power distribution frame,
whereas the OT terminal can be connected to terminals on a 2200 W DC power module.

8.2 AC Power Cable

Connectors and power capacity of a power cable must match the device on which the cable is
used. Therefore, a device must use the power cables delivered with it.

NOTE
If country-specific power cables are required, ensure that the power cables used on a device comply with
standards of the destination country or region. This document uses the China-specific power cables as an
example.

Types of AC Power Cables


Select AC power cables based on the power supply system in your equipment room. The
lengths and terminal types of AC power cables used between power distribution boxes and
power distribution frames are determined by the site survey results. Standard and country-
specific AC power cables can be directly connected to power modules.
l Standard power cables: used to transmit power from a PDU. Figure 8-2 shows the
structure of a C14 straight male to C13 straight female AC power cable, and Figure 8-3
shows the structure of a C20 straight male to C19 straight female AC power cable.
l Country-specific power cables: used to transmit power from a country-specific power
strip. The cables are delivered in compliance with standards of the destination country or
region. For example, PI straight male to C13 straight female AC power cables (Figure
8-4) and PI angle male to C19 straight female AC power cables (Figure 8-5) are used in
China.
l The AC power cables connected to a power distribution box must have cord end
terminals. Figure 8-6 shows the structure of a cord end to C13 straight female AC power

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 576


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

cable. Figure 8-7 shows the structure of a cord end to C19 straight female AC power
cable.

Figure 8-2 Structure of a C14 straight male to C13 straight female AC power cable
C14 straighe male C13 straight female

Figure 8-3 Structure of a C20 straight male to C19 straight female AC power cable

Figure 8-4 Structure of a PI straight male to C13 straight female AC power cable (used in
China)
E PI angle male C13straight female

L N
X1
X2

Figure 8-5 Structure of a PI angle male to C19 straight female AC power cable (used in
China)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 577


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

Figure 8-6 Structure of a Cord end to C13 straight female AC power cable (used in China)
Cord end terminal C13straight female
Blue
X1
Yellow/Green
X2
Brown
X3
X4

Figure 8-7 Structure of a Cord end to C19 straight female AC power cable (used in China)
Cord end terminal C19straight female
Blue
X1
Yellow/Green
X2
Brown
X3
X4

Connection
Table 8-1 shows connections of various AC power cables.

Table 8-1 Connections of AC power cables

Power Cable Type Connector Type and Connection

C14 straight male to C13 C14 straight male C13 straight female
straight female AC power connector: connected to a connector: connected to the
cable PDU power socket of an 800 W
AC power module.
PI straight male to C13 PI straight male connector:
straight female AC power connected to a country- The current rating of the
cable (used in China) specific power strip power cable is 10 A.

Cord end to C13 straight Cord end terminal:


female AC power cable connected to a power
(used in China) distribution box or power
distribution frame.
Connect the brown wire to
the L terminal, blue wire to
the N terminal, and the
yellow/green wire to the
ground terminal. Different
AC power cables may be
delivered in compliance
with local regulations or
customer requirements.

C20 straight male to C19 C20 straight male C19 straight female
straight female AC power connector: connected to a connector: connected to the
cable PDU power socket of a 2200 W

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 578


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

Power Cable Type Connector Type and Connection

PI angle male to C19 PI angle male connector: AC or a 3000 W AC power


straight female AC power connected to a country- module.
cable (used in China) specific power strip The current rating of the
power cable is 16 A.
Cord end to C19 straight Cord end terminal:
female AC power cable connected to a power When the 3000 W AC
(used in China) distribution box or power power module uses 240 V
distribution frame. high-voltage DC input, use
the C19 straight female AC
Connect the brown wire to
power cable.
the L terminal, blue wire to
the N terminal, and the
yellow/green wire to the
ground terminal. Different
AC power cables may be
delivered in compliance
with local regulations or
customer requirements.

8.3 Ground Cable

Appearance and Structure


Ground cables connect the chassis and cabinet to the ground. The ground cables are connected
on the front door, rear door, and side panels of a cabinet before delivery.
Figure 8-8 shows the structure of a ground cable.

Figure 8-8 Structure of a ground cable


Label

X1 X2

Pin Assignments
Table 8-2 lists the pin assignments of a ground cable.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 579


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

Table 8-2 Pin assignments of a ground cable

X1 X2 Wire Color Conductor Length


Cross-
Sectional Area

OT-6 OT-6 Green-yellow 6 mm2 1m

8.4 Console Cable

Types of Console Cables


A console cable connects the switch console port to the serial port of a configuration terminal
to transmit configuration data.

Appearance and Structure


Figure 8-9 shows the structure of a console cable.

Figure 8-9 Structure of a console cable


D-type connector
˄9-pin, female˅
Serial port connector
Pos.9 Pos.5 Label ˄8-pin, RJ-45˅

X2 1 8

Pos.6 Pos.1 X1

Pin Assignments
Table 8-3 lists the pin assignments of console cable connectors.

Table 8-3 Pin assignments of console cable connectors

Connector X1 (DB9) X2 (RJ45)

Pin assignment 2 3

3 6

5 5

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 580


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

Connection
A console cable has an RJ45 connector on one end and a DB9 connector on the other end. The
RJ45 connector is connected to the console port of the main processing unit, and the DB9
connector is connected to the serial port of a computer.

8.5 Clock Cable

Introduction
The external clock ports of a switch are used for clock and time synchronization.

A clock cable connects a switch to an external clock source or a time source device.

When a switch connects to external devices through clock cables, it provides the following
functions:

l Receives 2-channel 2.048 MHz or 2.048 Mbit/s clock signals from the upstream device
and delivers 2-channel 2.048 MHz or 2.048 Mbit/s clock signals to the downstream
device.
l Receives 2-channel ToD or DCLS time signals from the upstream device and delivers 2-
channel ToD or DCLS time signals to the downstream device.

Appearance and Structure


RJ48 Cable

RJ48 cables applicable to the switch are 120-ohm trunk cables (shielded cables), as shown in
Figure 8-10.

Figure 8-10 Structure of a 120-ohm trunk cable

NOTE

To connect a switch to a clock source that has an RJ45 interface, use an RJ48 cable.
RJ45 Cable

RJ45 cables applicable to the switch are straight-through cables (shielded cables), as shown in
Figure 8-11.

Figure 8-11 Structure of a straight-through cable

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 581


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

NOTE

To connect a switch to a time source providing an RJ45 interface, use an RJ45 cable.
To connect a switch to a clock source that has a sub-miniature B (SMB) or bayonet-neill-concelman
(BNC) interface, use an RJ45 cable and a transmultiplexer.
SMB/SMB Trunk Cable
An SMB/SMB trunk cable is a 75-ohm trunk cable with SMB connectors at both ends, as
shown in Figure 8-12.

Figure 8-12 SMB/SMB trunk cable

SMB/BNC Trunk Cable


An SMB/BNC trunk cable is a 75-ohm trunk cable with an SMB connector at one end and a
BNC connector at the other end, as shown in Figure 8-13.

Figure 8-13 SMB/BNC trunk cable

Connection
One end of a clock cable is an RJ45 connector that is connected to the BITS interface on the
Main Control Unit of the switch. The other end of the clock cable is connected to an external
clock device. The connector type depends on the type of the external clock device. The
external clock device can be a clock source that has an SMB, BNC, or RJ45 interface or a
time source providing an RJ45 interface.

Figure 8-14 Clock cable connections


Cable 2
Clock Cable 1 External clock
Transmultiplexer
interface device

SMB/BNC/RJ45
RJ45 interface SMB interface
interface

Based on the functions and interface types of the external clock device connected to the
switch, the following cables can be selected:
l When the connected device is a clock source with an RJ45 interface:
Cable 1 can be an RJ48 cable. No transmultiplexer or cable 2 is required.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 582


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

l When the connected device is a time source with an RJ45 interface:


Cable 1 can be an RJ45 cable. No transmultiplexer or cable 2 is required.
l When the connected device is a clock source with an SMB interface:
Cable 1 can be an RJ45 cable, and cable 2 can be an SMB/SMB trunk cable. A
transmultiplexer is required.
l When the connected device is a clock source with a BNC interface:
Cable 1 can be an RJ45 cable, and cable 2 can be an SMB/BNC trunk cable. A
transmultiplexer is required.

8.6 Ethernet Cable

Types of Ethernet Cables


Ethernet cables include straight-through cables and crossover cables.

Structure
Straight-through cables and crossover cables are standard unshielded Ethernet cables with
RJ45 connectors, as shown in Figure 8-15.

Figure 8-15 Structure of an Ethernet cable


Main label

X1 X2

8
1

Pin Assignments
Table 8-4 lists pin assignments of a straight-through cable.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 583


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

Table 8-4 Pin assignments of a straight-through cable


Connector Connector X2 Color Relationship
X1

X1.2 X2.2 Orange Twisted pair

X1.1 X2.1 White/Orange

X1.6 X2.6 Green Twisted pair

X1.3 X2.3 White/Green

X1.4 X2.4 Blue Twisted pair

X1.5 X2.5 White/Blue

X1.8 X2.8 Brown Twisted pair

X1.7 X2.7 White/Brown

Table 8-5 lists pin assignments of a crossover cable.

Table 8-5 Pin assignments of a crossover cable


Connector Connector X2 Color Relationship
X1

X1.6 X2.2 Orange Twisted pair

X1.3 X2.1 White/Orange

X1.2 X2.6 Green Twisted pair

X1.1 X2.3 White/Green

X1.4 X2.4 Blue Twisted pair

X1.5 X2.5 White/Blue

X1.8 X2.8 Brown Twisted pair

X1.7 X2.7 White/Brown

Connection
A straight-through cable connects Ethernet ports between the following devices:
l A router and a hub
l A router and an Ethernet switch
l A computer and an Ethernet switch
l A computer and a hub
A crossover cable connects Ethernet ports between the following devices:

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 584


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

l Two routers
l A router and a computer
l Two hubs
l A hub and a switch
l Two switches
l Two computers

8.7 High-Speed Cable

Types of High-Speed Cable


Table 8-6 describes different types of high-speed cables.

Table 8-6 Types of high-speed cables


Cable Type Model Length Electric Bend Connec Part
al Radius tor number
attribut Type
e

SFP+ - 1 m SFP SFP-10 1m Passive 25 mm SFP+ to 02310M


SFP+ + high- G- SFP+ UN
high- speed CU1M
speed cable
cable
3 m SFP SFP-10 3m Passive 25 mm SFP+ to 02310M
+ high- G- SFP+ UP
speed CU3M
cable

5 m SFP SFP-10 5m Passive 30 mm SFP+ to 02310Q


+ high- G- SFP+ PR
speed CU5M
cable

10 m SFP-10 10 m Active 25 mm SFP+ to 02310M


SFP+ G- SFP+ UQ
active AC10M
high-
speed
cable

QSFP+ - 1m QSFP-4 1m Passive 25 mm QSFP+ 02310M


4*SFP+ QSFP+ - SFP10G to 4*SFP UK
high- 4*SFP+ -CU1M +
speed high-
cable speed
cable

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 585


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

Cable Type Model Length Electric Bend Connec Part


al Radius tor number
attribut Type
e

3m QSFP-4 3m Passive 25 mm QSFP+ 02310M


QSFP+ - SFP10G to 4*SFP UL
4*SFP+ -CU3M +
high-
speed
cable

5m QSFP-4 5m Passive 30 mm QSFP+ 02310M


QSFP+ - SFP10G to 4*SFP UM
4*SFP+ -CU5M +
high-
speed
cable

QSFP+ - 1m QSFP-4 1m Passive 35 mm QSFP+ 02310M


QSFP+ QSFP+ - 0G- to QSFP UG
high- QSFP+ CU1M +
speed high-
cable speed
cable

3m QSFP-4 3m Passive 40 mm QSFP+ 02310M


QSFP+ - 0G- to QSFP UH
QSFP+ CU3M +
high-
speed
cable

5m QSFP-4 5m Passive 45 mm QSFP+ 02310M


QSFP+ - 0G- to QSFP UJ
QSFP+ CU5M +
high-
speed
cable

QSFP28 1m QSFP28 1m Passive 70 mm QSFP28 02311K


- QSFP28 -100G- to NW
QSFP28 - CU1M QSFP28
high- QSFP28
speed high-
cable speed
cable

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 586


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

Cable Type Model Length Electric Bend Connec Part


al Radius tor number
attribut Type
e

3m QSFP28 3m Passive 70 mm QSFP28 02311K


QSFP28 -100G- to NX
- CU3M QSFP28
QSFP28
high-
speed
cable

5m QSFP28 5m Passive 70 mm QSFP28 02311K


QSFP28 -100G- to NY
- CU5M QSFP28
QSFP28
high-
speed
cable

Do not reversely insert the QSFP+ cable plugs. The side with an L-shaped groove is the top of
a QSFP+ cable plug, as shown in Figure 8-16. Keep the top side up when inserting the QSFP
+ cable plug into a port.
Both ends of a QSFP+ high-speed cable must be covered by ESD caps.
If a port of an S series modular switch uses a high-speed copper cable, the port can only be
connected to another S series modular switch.

Figure 8-16 QSFP+ cable plug

Appearance and Structure


Figure 8-17 shows an SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed cable.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 587


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

Figure 8-17 SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed cable

Figure 8-18 shows a QSFP+ - QSFP+ and QSFP28 - QSFP28 high-speed cable.

Figure 8-18 QSFP+ - QSFP+ and QSFP28 - QSFP28 high-speed cable

Figure 8-19 shows a QSFP+ - 4*SFP+ high-speed cable.

Figure 8-19 QSFP+ - 4*SFP+ high-speed cable

Figure 8-20 shows the structure of an SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed cable.

Figure 8-20 Structure of an SFP+ - SFP+ high-speed cable

X2 X1

Figure 8-21 shows the structure of a QSFP+ - QSFP+ and QSFP28 - QSFP28 high-speed
cable.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 588


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

Figure 8-21 Structure of a QSFP+ - QSFP+ and QSFP28 - QSFP28 high-speed cable
Front view:

Rear view:

Figure 8-22 shows the structure of a QSFP+ - 4*SFP+ high-speed cable.

Figure 8-22 Structure of a QSFP+ - 4*SFP+ high-speed cable

X1

X2 C

8.8 Optical Fiber

Active Optical Cable


An active optical cable (AOC) is an optical fiber with optical modules at both ends, making it
easy to use. Figure 8-23, Figure 8-24, and Figure 8-25 show the appearance of AOC cables.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 589


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

Figure 8-23 SFP+ to SFP+ AOC cable

Figure 8-24 QSFP+ to QSFP+ or QSFP28 to QSFP28 AOC cable

Figure 8-25 QSFP+ to 4*SFP+ AOC cable

Table 8-7 lists the models and attributes of AOC cables.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 590


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

Table 8-7 Attributes of AOC cables


Model Length Bend Connector Part Operating
Radius Type Number Temperatu
re

SFP-10G- 3m 30 mm SFP+ 02310QWG 0°C to 70°C


AOC3M connectors
at both ends

SFP-10G- 10 m 30 mm SFP+ 02310QWH 0°C to 70°C


AOC10M connectors
at both ends

QSFP- 10 m 25 mm QSFP+ 02310SSH 0°C to 70°C


H40G- connectors
AOC10M at both ends

QSFP-4SFP 10 m 25 mm QSFP+ 02310SSJ 0°C to 70°C


10- connector at
AOC10M one end and
four SFP+
connectors
at the other
end

QSFP-100G- 10 m 25 mm QSFP28 02311KNQ 0°C to 70°C


AOC-10M connectors
at both ends

Fiber Jumper
A fiber jumper consists of one or more fibers of a certain length and the optical connectors at
both ends. A fiber jumper connects an optical module to a fiber terminal box.

NOTE

l The MPO-MPO and MPO-2*MPO fibers have similar appearances except for the number of MPO
connectors at the other end. The following figures show an MPO-MPO fiber for example.
l The MPO-4*DLC and MPO-10*DLC fibers have similar appearances except for the number of
DLC connectors at the other end.
l The MPO-MPO fibers for S series switches use type B connectors (key Up/key Up).

Figure 8-26 shows a single-mode LC/PC fiber jumper.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 591


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

Figure 8-26 Single-mode LC/PC fiber jumper

Figure 8-27 shows a multimode LC/PC fiber jumper.

Figure 8-27 Multimode LC/PC fiber jumper

Figure 8-28 shows a single-mode SC/PC fiber jumper.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 592


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

Figure 8-28 Single-mode SC/PC fiber jumper

Figure 8-29 shows an MPO-MPO fiber jumper.

Figure 8-29 MPO-MPO fiber jumper

Figure 8-30 shows an MPO-4*DLC fiber jumper.

Figure 8-30 MPO-4*DLC fiber jumper

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 593


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

Figure 8-31 shows an MPO-10*DLC fiber jumper.

Figure 8-31 MPO-10*DLC fiber jumper

Comply with the following rules when selecting fiber jumpers:


1. Determine the length of fiber jumpers based on the onsite cabling distance.
2. Determine the fiber type based on the optical module type.
– Use a multimode fiber jumper for a multimode optical module.
– Use a single-mode fiber jumper for a single-mode optical module.
3. Determine the optical connector type based on the interface type.
Ensure that the optical connector at each end of a fiber jumper is the same type as the
interface to which it will be connected.
Figure 8-32 shows the structure of an 8-strand MPO-MPO fiber jumper.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 594


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

Figure 8-32 Structure of an 8-strand MPO-MPO fiber jumper

X2 X1

1 1
2 2
3 3
4 4
NA NA
NA NA
NA NA
NA NA
9 9
10 10
11 11
12 12

Figure 8-33 shows the structure of a 12-strand MPO-MPO fiber jumper.

Figure 8-33 Structure of a 12-strand MPO-MPO fiber jumper

X1 X2

1 1
2 2
3 3
4 4
5 5
6 6
7 7
8 8
9 9
10 10
11 11
12 12

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 595


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

Figure 8-34 shows the structure of a 24-strand MPO-MPO fiber jumper.

Figure 8-34 Structure of a 24-strand MPO-MPO fiber jumper

X1 X2

1 13 1 13
2 X1 14 2 X2 14
3 15 3 15
4 16 4 16
5 17 5 17
6 18 6 18
7 19 7 19
8 20 8 20
9 21 9 21
10 22 10 22
11 23 11 23
12 24 12 24

Figure 8-35 shows the structure of an MPO-4*DLC fiber jumper.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 596


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

Figure 8-35 Structure of an MPO-4*DLC fiber jumper

X1
1A
X2 1B
2A
2B

4A
1 4B
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12

Figure 8-36 shows the structure of an MPO-2*MPO fiber jumper.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 597


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

Figure 8-36 Structure of an MPO-2*MPO fiber jumper


X2

X1

X3

13 1 1
X1 X2/X3
14 2 2
15 3 3
16 4 4
17 5 5
18 6 6
19 7 7
20 8 8
21 9 9
22 10 10
23 11 11
24 12 12

Figure 8-37 shows the structure of an MPO-10*DLC fiber jumper.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 598


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

Figure 8-37 Structure of an MPO-10*DLC fiber jumper

X2
1B
X1 1A
2B
2A

10B
1 13 10A
2 14
3 15
4 16
5 17
6 18
7 19
8 20
9 21
10 22
11 23
12 24

Table 8-8 lists the pin assignments of an 8-strand MPO-MPO fiber jumper.

Table 8-8 Pin assignments of an 8-strand MPO-MPO fiber jumper

X1 Pin X2 Pin

1 12

2 11

3 10

4 9

NA NA

NA NA

NA NA

NA NA

9 4

10 3

11 2

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 599


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

X1 Pin X2 Pin

12 1

Table 8-9 lists the pin assignments of a 12-strand MPO-MPO fiber jumper.

Table 8-9 Pin assignments of a 12-strand MPO-MPO fiber jumper

X1 Pin X2 Pin

1 12

2 11

3 10

4 9

5 8

6 7

7 6

8 5

9 4

10 3

11 2

12 1

Table 8-10 lists the pin assignments of a 24-strand MPO-MPO fiber jumper.

Table 8-10 Pin assignments of a 24-strand MPO-MPO fiber jumper

X1 Pin X2 Pin X1 Pin X2 Pin

1 24 13 12

2 23 14 11

3 22 15 10

4 21 16 9

5 20 17 8

6 19 18 7

7 18 19 6

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 600


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

X1 Pin X2 Pin X1 Pin X2 Pin

8 17 20 5

9 16 21 4

10 15 22 3

11 14 23 2

12 13 24 1

Table 8-11 lists the pin assignments of an MPO-4*DLC fiber jumper.

Table 8-11 Pin assignments of an MPO-4*DLC fiber jumper

X2 Pin X1 Pin

1 1A

2 2A

3 3A

4 4A

9 4B

10 3B

11 2B

12 1B

Table 8-12 lists the pin assignments of an MPO-2*MPO fiber jumper.

Table 8-12 Pin assignments of an MPO-2*MPO fiber jumper

X1 Pin X2 Pin X3 Pin

2 12 NA

3 11 NA

4 10 NA

5 9 NA

7 NA 12

8 NA 11

9 NA 10

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 601


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

X1 Pin X2 Pin X3 Pin

10 NA 9

14 1 NA

15 2 NA

16 3 NA

17 4 NA

19 NA 1

20 NA 2

21 NA 3

22 NA 4

Table 8-13 lists the pin assignments of an MPO-10*DLC fiber jumper.

Table 8-13 Pin assignments of an MPO-10*DLC fiber jumper


X1 Pin X2 Pin X1 Pin X2 Pin

2 1A 14 1B

3 2A 15 2B

4 3A 16 3B

5 4A 17 4B

6 5A 18 5B

7 6A 19 6B

8 7A 20 7B

9 8A 21 8B

10 9A 22 9B

11 10A 23 10B

Fiber Pigtail
A fiber pigtail is an optical fiber that has an optical connector on one end and a piece of
exposed fiber at the other end. The exposed fiber can be fused to another optical fiber. Fiber
pigtails are commonly used to connect optical fibers to optical modules in fiber terminal
boxes (couplers and jumpers are also used). Figure 8-38 shows the structure of a fiber pigtail.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 602


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

Figure 8-38 Structure of a fiber pigtail

Fiber pigtails are classified into single-mode and multimode fiber pigtails and are used for
short-distance connections.

Optical Fiber, Optical Connector, and Fiber Adapter


Optical Fibers

Optical fibers are classified into single-mode fibers and multimode fibers.

l Single-mode fibers have a diameter of 5-10 μm and transmit laser in one mode under a
specified wavelength. These fibers support a wide frequency band and a large
transmission capacity, so they are used for long-distance transmission. Most single-mode
fibers are yellow, as shown in Figure 8-26.
l Multimode fibers have a diameter of 50 μm or 62.5 μm and transmit laser light in
multiple modes with a specified wavelength. These fibers have a lower transmission
capacity than single-mode fibers and are used for short-distance transmission. Model
dispersion occurs during transmission over multimode fibers.
In the latest cabling infrastructure of ISO/IEC 11801, multimode fibers are classified into
four categories: OM1, OM2, OM3, and OM4.
– OM1: traditional 62.5/125 μm multimode fibers. OM1 fibers have a large core
diameter and numerical aperture, and provide high light gathering ability and
bending resistance.
– OM2: traditional 50/125 μm multimode fibers. OM2 fibers have a small core
diameter and numerical aperture. Compared with OM1 fibers, OM2 fibers provide
higher bandwidth because they significantly reduce the modal dispersion. When
transmitting data at 1 Gbit/s with 850 nm wavelength, OM1 and OM2 fibers
support maximum link lengths of 220 m and 550 m, respectively. OM1 and OM2
fibers can provide sufficient bandwidth within a distance of 300 m. Generally, OM1
and OM2 fibers are orange, as shown in Figure 8-27.
– OM3: new-generation multimode fibers, with longer transmission distances than
OM1 and OM2 fibers.
– OM4: laser optimized multimode fibers with 50 μm core diameter. OM4 is an
improvement to OM3 and only increases the modal bandwidth. OM4 fibers provide
4700 MHz*km of modal bandwidth, whereas OM3 fibers provide only 2000
MHz*km of modal bandwidth. Generally, OM3 and OM4 fibers are light green, as
shown in Figure 8-29. You can identify OM3 and OM4 fibers by their labels or
printed marks.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 603


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

MPO fibers are used for 40G and 100G optical modules. An MPO fiber consists of multiple
multi-mode fiber strands, and each multi-mode fiber strand provides one laser transmission
channel. Some fiber suppliers produce 8-strand MPO optical fibers, while some suppliers
produce 12-strand or 24-strand MPO fibers.
l A 40G optical module uses four channels to transmit laser and four channels to receive
laser. That is, a total of eight channels are required for a 40G optical module. 8-strand
and 12-strand MPO fibers use the same definition of fiber channels. Therefore, they are
equivalent in functionality when connecting to 40G optical modules.
l When 100G optical modules are used, choose MPO fibers according to the following
rules:
– For CFP optical modules, choose 24-strand fibers for the CFP-100G-SR10 module
and 8-strand or 12-strand fibers for other modules.
– Choose 8-strand or 12-strand fibers for QSFP28 modules.

Optical Connector

Optical connectors are used to connect optical fibers of the same type. Table 8-14 lists
common optical connectors.

Table 8-14 Common optical connectors

Connector Optical Connector


Type

Square SC/PC LC/PC MTRJ/PC MPO connector


connector connector connector connector

Round FC/PC ST/PC - -


connector connector connector

Figure 8-39 shows an LC/PC optical connector.

Figure 8-39 LC/PC optical connector

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 604


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 8 Cables

When connecting or removing an LC/PC optical connector, align the connector with the
optical port and do not rotate the fiber. Pay attention to the following points:
l To connect a fiber, align the optical connector with the optical port and gently insert the
optical fiber into the port.
l To remove a fiber, press the clip on the connector and pull the fiber out.

Fiber Adapter
A fiber adapter (also called a flange) is a fiber connection component. Two fiber connectors
need to be connected using a fiber adapter. Fiber adapters are widely used in optical
distribution frames (ODFs), fiber transmission equipment, and optical instruments.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 605


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

About This Chapter

9.1 Important Notes About Using Optical Modules Certified for Huawei Switches
9.2 Understanding Optical Modules
9.3 Understanding Copper Modules
9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules
9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules
9.6 POS eSFP Optical Modules
9.7 GE-CWDM eSFP Optical Modules
9.8 GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules
9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules
9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules
9.11 10GE-CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules
9.12 10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical Modules
9.13 10GE XFP Optical Modules
9.14 10GE-CWDM XFP Optical Modules
9.15 10GE-DWDM XFP Optical Modules
9.16 40GE QSFP+ Optical Modules
9.17 40GE CFP Optical Modules
9.18 100GE CFP Optical Modules
9.19 100GE QSFP28 Optical Modules

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 606


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

9.1 Important Notes About Using Optical Modules


Certified for Huawei Switches

9.1.1 How to Identify Huawei-Certified Switch Optical Modules

l A switch must use optical or copper modules that have been certified for use on Huawei
switches. Non-certified optical or copper modules cannot ensure transmission reliability
and may affect service stability. Huawei is not liable for any problem caused by the use of
non-certified optical or copper modules and will not fix such problems.
l The methods provided here are only for reference. To confirm whether optical modules
you are using have been certified for use on Huawei switches, contact Huawei technical
support.

10GE or Lower Speed Optical Modules


Huawei started certification on 10GE or lower speed optical modules for switch products on
July 1, 2013.

To determine whether optical modules delivered for Huawei switches before July 1, 2013 are
certified ones, contact Huawei technical support.

If your optical modules are delivered after July 1, 2013, use either of the following methods to
determine whether they have been certified by Huawei.

Method 1: Check for "HUAWEI" on the label

If an optical module has been certified by Huawei, its label contains "HUAWEI", as shown in
Figure 9-1.

Figure 9-1 "HUAWEI" on the label of a Huawei-certified switch optical module

Method 2: Run the display transceiver command

An optical module has received Huawei switch certification if it meets the following
conditions:

l In the display elabel command output, the Manufactured field displays a date later than
2013-07-01.
l In the display version command output, the displayed version is V200R001C00 or later.
l In the display transceiver command output, the Vendor Name field displays HUAWEI.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 607


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

NOTE

The SFP-FE-SX-MM1310 (part number: 02315233) is a Huawei-certified 100M optical module.


However, the Vendor Name field displays the original manufacturer name, instead of HUAWEI.
For copper modules, the Vendor Name field also displays the original manufacturer name, instead of
HUAWEI.

40GE and 100GE Optical Modules


Huawei started certification on 40GE and 100GE optical modules for switch products on
January 1, 2016.

To determine whether optical modules delivered for Huawei switches before January 1, 2016
are certified ones, contact Huawei technical support.

If your optical modules are delivered after January 1, 2016, use either of the following
methods to determine whether they have been certified by Huawei.

Method 1: Check for "HUAWEI" on the label

If an optical module has been certified by Huawei, its label contains "HUAWEI", as shown in
Figure 9-1.

Method 2: Run the display transceiver command

A 40GE or 100GE optical module has received Huawei switch certification if it meets the
following conditions:

l In the display elabel command output, the Manufactured field displays a date later than
2016-01-01.
l In the display version command output, the displayed version is V200R008 or later.
l In the display transceiver command output, the Vendor Name field displays HUAWEI.
NOTE

For the optical modules connected to high-speed cables or AOC cables, the Vendor Name field displays
the original manufacturer name, instead of HUAWEI. For the methods of checking whether such an
optical module has been certified by Huawei, contact technical support personnel.

9.1.2 Risks of Using Non-Huawei-Certified Switch Optical


Modules

During certification of optical modules for Huawei switches, Huawei completes


comprehensive functionality verification to ensure quality of optical modules. The verified
items include optical module plug/unplug, transmit optical power, receive optical power,
signal transmission quality, data reading, error tolerance, compatibility, electromagnetic
compatibility (EMC), and environmental parameters.

Non-Huawei-certified switch optical modules may cause the following problems:

l Non-standard structure and size cause failures to install optical modules on adjacent
optical interfaces.
Structures or sizes of some non-Huawei-certified optical modules do not comply with the
Multi-Source Agreement (MSA). When such an optical module is installed on an optical
interface, the size of this optical module hinders optical module installation on adjacent
optical interfaces.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 608


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

l Data bus defects cause suspension of a switch's data bus.


Some non-Huawei-certified optical modules have defects in data bus designs. Using such
an optical module on a switch causes suspension of the connected data bus on the switch.
As a result, data on the suspended bus cannot be read.
l Improper edge connector size damages electronic devices of optical interfaces.
If a non-Huawei-certified switch optical module with improper edge connector size is
used on an optical interface, electronic devices of the optical interface will be damaged
by short circuits.
l Unnormalized temperature monitoring causes incorrect alarms.
The temperature monitoring systems of some non-Huawei-certified switch optical
modules do not comply with industry standards and report temperature values higher
than the real temperature. When such optical modules are used on a switch, the system
will report incorrect temperature alarms.
l Improper register settings cause errors or failures in reading parameters or diagnostic
information.
Some non-Huawei-certified switch optical modules have improper register values on
page A0, which can cause errors or failures when the system attempts to read parameters
or diagnostic information from a data bus.
l Some non-Huawei-certified switch optical modules are not designed in compliance with
EMC standards and have low anti-interference capability. Additionally, they bring
electromagnetic interference to nearby devices.
l The operating temperature ranges of non-Huawei-certified switch optical modules
cannot meet service requirements. When they are used under relatively high temperature,
the optical power decreases, resulting in service interruption.

9.2 Understanding Optical Modules

9.2.1 What Is an Optical Module


On an optical network, a sender needs to convert electrical signals into optical signals before
sending them to a receiver, and the receiver needs to convert received optical signals into
electrical signals. An optical module is a component that completes electrical/optical
conversion on an optical network. Figure 9-2 shows the structure of an optical module.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 609


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Figure 9-2 Structure of an optical module (using an SFP/eSFP optical module as an example)

1. Handle 2. Receiver 3. Transmitter


4. Shell 5. Label 6. Dust plug
7. Spring 8. Connector -

Figure 9-3 shows an SFP/eSFP optical module.

Figure 9-3 SFP/eSFP optical module

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 610


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Figure 9-4 shows the appearance of an SFP+ optical module.

Figure 9-4 Appearance of an SFP+ optical module

Figure 9-5 and Figure 9-6 show the appearance of a QSFP+ optical module.

Figure 9-5 Appearance of a QSFP+ optical module (for LC optical fibers)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 611


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Figure 9-6 Appearance of a QSFP+ optical module (for MPO optical fibers)

The side with an L-shaped notch close to the connector is the top of a QSFP+ optical module,
as shown in Figure 9-5. When connecting a QSFP+ optical module to a port, keep the top
side upward. Do not insert the QSFP+ optical module upside down.
Currently, there is no formal standard for 40G Ethernet. Therefore, a device may not display
complete diagnostic information about 40GE optical modules. This is an acceptable fact in the
telecommunications industry and does not affect functions of 40GE optical modules.

Figure 9-7 shows the appearance of a CSFP optical module.

Figure 9-7 Appearance of a CSFP optical module

Figure 9-8 shows the appearance of an XFP module.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 612


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Figure 9-8 Appearance of an XFP optical module

NOTE
The SFP+ and XFP optical modules are 10GE hot-pluggable optical modules. Compared with the SFP+
optical modules, the XFP optical modules have a larger caliber.

Figure 9-9 and Figure 9-10 show CFP optical modules for different optical fibers.

Figure 9-9 CFP 100GE optical module (for LC optical fibers)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 613


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Figure 9-10 CFP 100GE optical module (for MPO optical fibers)

Figure 9-11 and Figure 9-12 show the appearance of a QSFP28 optical module.

Figure 9-11 Appearance of a QSFP28 optical module (for MPO optical fibers)

Figure 9-12 Appearance of a QSFP28 optical module (for LC optical fibers)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 614


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

9.2.2 Types of Optical Modules

Optical modules are available in various types to meet diversified requirements.

l Classified by transmission rates


Depending on transmission rates, optical modules are classified into 100GE, 40GE,
10GE, FE, and GE optical modules.
l Classified by encapsulation types
The higher transmission rate an optical module provides, the more complex structure it
has. Optical modules are encapsulated in different modes to provide different structures.
Huawei switches support optical modules of the following encapsulation types: CFP,
QSFP+, QSFP28, XFP, SFP, eSFP, and SFP+. All optical modules are hot swappable.
– SFP: small form-factor pluggable. SFP optical modules support LC fiber
connectors.
– eSFP: enhanced small form-factor pluggable. An eSFP module is an SFP module
that supports monitoring of voltage, temperature, bias current, transmit optical
power, and receive optical power. Therefore, eSFP is also called SFP sometimes.
– SFP+: small form-factor pluggable plus, SFP with a higher rate. SFP+ optical
modules are more sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) because they
have a higher rate. To reduce EMI, SFP+ optical modules have more springs than
SFP optical modules and the cages for SFP+ modules on a card are tighter.
– XFP: 10 Gigabit small form-factor pluggable. X is the Roman numeral 10, meaning
that all XFP optical modules provide a 10 Gbit/s transmission rate. XFP optical
modules support LC fiber connectors. They are wider and longer than SFP+ optical
modules.
– QSFP+: quad small form-factor pluggable. QSFP+ optical modules support MPO
fiber connectors and are larger than SFP+ optical modules.
– CFP: centum form-factor pluggable. The dimensions of a CFP optical module are
144.75 mm x 82 mm x 13.6 mm (L x W x H). CFP is a new optical module
standard that can be used in data communication and telecommunications fields.
– QSFP28: with the same interface size as a QSFP+ module. A QSFP28 interface can
use a 100GE QSFP28 optical module or a 40GE QSFP+ optical module.
l Classified by physical layer standards
Different physical layer standards are defined to allow data transmission in different
modes. Therefore, different types of optical modules are produced to comply with these
standards. For details, see Standards compliance of the specific optical module.
l Classified by modes
Optical fibers are classified into single-mode and multimode fibers. Therefore, optical
modules are also classified into single-mode and multimode modules to support different
optical fibers.
– Single-mode optical modules are used with single-mode fibers. Single-mode fibers
support a wide band and large transmission capacity, and are used for long-distance
transmission.
– Multimode optical modules are used with multimode fibers. Multimode fibers have
lower transmission performance than single-mode fibers because of modal
dispersion, but their costs are also lower. They are used for small-capacity, short-
distance transmission.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 615


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Wavelength division multiplexing modules differ from other optical modules in center
wavelengths. A common optical module has a center wavelength of 850 nm, 1310 nm, or
1550 nm, whereas a wavelength division multiplexing module transmits lights with different
center wavelengths. Wavelength division multiplexing modules are classified into two types:
coarse wavelength division multiplexing (CWDM) and dense wavelength division
multiplexing (DWDM). Within the same band, DWDM modules are available in more types
and use wavelength resources more efficiently than CWDM modules. DWDM and CWDM
modules allow lights with different center wavelengths to be transmitted on one fiber without
interfering each other. Therefore, a passive multiplexer can be used to combine the lights into
one channel, which is then split into multiple channels by a demultiplexer on the remote end.
This reduces the optical fibers required. DWDM and CWDM modules are used for long-
distance transmission.
The transmit power of a long-distance optical module is often larger than its overload power.
Therefore, when using such optical modules, select optical fibers of an appropriate length to
ensure that the actual receive power is smaller than the overload power. If the optical fibers
connected to a long-distance optical module are too short, use an optical attenuator to reduce
the receive power on the remote optical module. Otherwise, the remote optical module may
be burnt. Generally, an optical attenuator is required if an optical module supporting a
transmission distance longer than 10 km is used together with short optical fibers.

9.2.3 Parameter Description

Transmit optical power Output optical power of an optical module when it is working properly. When two
optical modules are connected, the transmit optical power of one end must be within
the range of receive optical power on the other end.

Receive optical power Average input optical power that the receiver of an optical module can receive within
a range of bit error rate (BER = 10-12). The upper limit of this parameter is the
overload optical power and the lower limit is the maximum receiver sensitivity. When
two optical modules are connected, the receive optical power on one end determines
the range of transmit optical power on the other end.

Maximum receiver Minimum average input optical power that the receiver of an optical module can
sensitivity receive within a range of bit error rate (BER = 10-12). When two optical modules are
connected, the maximum receiver sensitivity on one end determines the minimum
value of transmit optical power on the other end.

Overload optical Maximum average input optical power that the receiver of an optical module can
power receive within a range of bit error rate (BER = 10-12). When two optical modules are
connected, the overload optical power on one end determines the maximum transmit
optical power on the other end.

Extinction ratio Minimum ratio of the average optical power with signals transmitted against the
average optical power without signals transmitted in complete modulation mode. The
extinction ratio indicates the capability of an optical module to identify signal 0 and
signal 1. This parameter is a quality indicator for optical modules. Optical modules
with a large extinction ratio may not have good quality. Qualified optical modules
should have an extinction ratio complying with IEEE 802.3.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 616


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Fiber mode Mode of optical fibers defined based on core diameters and features of optical fibers.
Optical fibers are classified into single-mode and multimode fibers. Generally,
multimode fibers have large core diameters and severe dispersion, so they transmit
optical signals over short distances. Single-mode fibers have low dispersion and can
transmit optical signals over long distances.

Modal bandwidth Bandwidth measured at a point with transmit power several dB lower than that of the
point with the peak center wavelength. Modal bandwidth reflects spectrum
characteristics of multimode fibers. The higher modal bandwidth a multimode fiber
has, the longer transmission distance the fiber supports.

Fiber diameter Diameter of the core of a fiber. According to international standards for optical fibers,
the diameter of a multimode fiber is 62.5 um or 50 um, and the diameter of a single-
mode fiber is 9 um. Select optical fibers with diameters supported by the optical
modules.

Fiber class Optical signals with different wavelengths have their best working windows in
different optical fibers. To help efficiently adjust wavelengths or dispersion features of
optical fibers and change their refractive indexes, the following fiber classes are
defined: multimode fiber (G.651), common single-mode fiber (G.652), shifted
dispersion fiber (G.653), and non-zero shifted dispersion fiber (G.655). G.651 and G.
652 are commonly used fiber classes. Optical fibers of higher classes support longer
transmission distances. When selecting optical fibers for optical modules, determine
the classes of fibers based on the required transmission distances.

Connector type Type of the interface on an optical module to accommodate a fiber. Commonly used
connector types are LC (applicable to all the SFP, SFP+, and XFP modules), SC, and
MPO (applicable to 150 m QSFP+ and CXP modules). Select optical fibers with
connectors supported by the optical modules.

Transmission distance Maximum distance over which optical signals can transmit. Optical signals sent from
different types of sources can transmit over different distances due to negative effects
of optical fibers, such as dispersion and attenuation. When connecting optical
interfaces, select optical modules and fibers based on the maximum signal
transmission distance.

Interface rate Maximum rate of electrical signals that an optical component can transmit without bit
errors. The interface rates defined in Ethernet standards include 125 Mbit/s, 1.25
Gbit/s, 10.3125 Gbit/s, and 41.25 Gbit/s. When connecting optical interfaces, select
optical modules and fibers based on the maximum signal transmission rate.

Center wavelength Wavelength measured at the midpoint of the half-amplitude line in the transmit
spectrum. Two connected optical modules must have the same center wavelength.

MSA Multi-Source Agreement, a non-profit organization jointly established by optical


module manufacturers. This agreement defines the structure and dimensions of optical
transceivers by referring to Optical Internetworking Forum (OIF) and International
Telecommunication Union (ITU) standards.

9.2.4 How to View Optical Module Parameters

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 617


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Viewing the Hardware Description


If you know the model or type of an optical module, you can view the section "Pluggable
Modules for Interfaces" in the Hardware Description to look up parameters of the optical
module, including the center wavelength, transmission distance, fiber types supported, receive
optical power, and transmit optical power.

Using a Command
If an optical module is installed in a running switch, you can run the display transceiver
command to view parameters of the optical module, including the center wavelength,
transmission distance, fiber types supported, receive optical power, and transmit optical
power.

9.2.5 Rules for Optical Module Interoperation

Interoperation Rules
Optical modules with the same standards can interoperate with each other. The standards
define the rate, wavelength, and transmission distance of optical modules, but not their
encapsulation modes (two interoperated optical modules can have different encapsulation
modes).

If you need to achieve interoperability between optical modules with different standards,
contact technical support personnel.

When Huawei switches are connected to other products such as routers, comply with the
preceding optical module interoperation rules.

Standards Description
The following describes the standards, using 1000BASE-LX10 as an example:

l 1000 indicates the rate (1000 Mbit/s, in this case). Other rates include 10 Mbit/s, 100
Mbit/s, 10 Gbit/s, 40 Gbit/s, and 100 Gbit/s.
l BASE indicates baseband transmission.
l L represents a center wavelength of the laser. Currently, the following center
wavelengths are available: S (short wavelength: 850 nm), L (long wavelength: 1310 nm),
E (extra long wavelength: 1550 nm), and B (single-fiber bidirectional long wavelength).
l X represents the encoding format. The encoding formats include T (twisted pair), X (8B/
10B), R (64B/66B), and W (WIS).
l 10 indicates the number of channels. Currently, the value can be 4 or 10. If there is no
number, the value is 1.
NOTE

This example provides the definitions in IEEE standards, which are not applicable to all optical
modules, for example, non-standard optical modules.
The following organizations or agreements define standards related to optical modules:
l IEEE 802.3, which defines MAC and PHY standards
l Small Form Factor (SFF) committee or Multi-Source Agreements (MSAs), which define optical
module hardware, software, and structure standards

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 618


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Interoperability of 40GE and 100GE Optical Modules


Huawei S series switches support the following types of 40GE and 100GE optical modules:

l 40GE QSFP+ optical modules


l 40GE CFP optical modules
l 100GE CFP optical modules
l 100GE QSFP28 optical modules

Figure 9-13 Interoperability of 40GE optical modules in different encapsulation modes


40GE QSFP+ 40GE CFP

40GBASE-SR4 40GBASE-SR4

40GBASE-iSR4

40GBASE-eSR4

40GBASE-BIDI

40GBASE-PAM4

Standards 40GBASE-ePAM4

40GBASE-LX4

40GBASE-iSM4

40GBASE-eSM4

40GBASE-LR4 40GBASE-LR4

40GBASE-ER4 40GBASE-ER4

40GBASE-ZR4

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 619


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Figure 9-14 Interoperability of 100GE optical modules in different encapsulation modes


100GE QSFP28 100GE CFP

100GBASE-SR4

100GBASE-SR10

100GBASE-eSR4

100GBASE-PSM4

Standards 100GBASE-CLR4

100GBASE-CWDM4

100GBASE-LR4 100GBASE-LR4

100GBASE-ER4-lite

100GBASE-ER4

NOTE

Optical modules complying with the standards connected in the preceding figures can interoperate with
each other.
iSR4 and eSR4 are non-standard formats derived from SR4, and support interoperation with SR4.
A 40GBASE-PAM4 optical module can interoperate with a 40GBASE-ePAM4 optical module.
A 100GBASE-CLR4 optical module can interoperate with a 100GBASE-CWDM4 optical module.
A 100GBASE-ER4-lite optical module can interoperate with a 100GBASE-ER4 optical module, at a
maximum distance of 30 km.

9.3 Understanding Copper Modules


Copper modules are also called RJ45 modules. Unlike optical modules, copper modules do
not perform electrical-optical conversion. When two optical interfaces have copper modules
installed, the interfaces can be connected using a copper cable. Currently, Huawei offers only
GE copper modules with RJ45 interfaces. GE copper modules work with Category 5 network
cables, comply with 1000BASE-T (IEEE 802.3ab), and support a maximum transmission
distance of 100 m.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 620


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Figure 9-15 shows a GE SFP copper module.

Figure 9-15 Appearance of a GE SFP copper module

9.4 FE SFP/eSFP Optical Modules

9.4.1 SFP-FE-SX-MM1310

Table 9-1 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor SFP

Transmission speed FE

Center wavelength (nm) 1310

Standards compliance 100BASE-FX

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Multimode fiber (50 μm or 62.5 μm diameter): 2 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -19.0 to -14.0

Maximum receiver -30.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -14.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 10

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 621


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02315233

9.4.2 eSFP-FE-LX-SM1310

Table 9-2 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor eSFP

Transmission speed FE

Center wavelength (nm) 1310

Standards compliance Non-standard

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 15 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -15.0 to -8.0

Maximum receiver -28.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -8.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02315205

9.4.3 S-SFP-FE-LH40-SM1310

Table 9-3 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver type eSFP

Transmission speed FE

Center wavelength (nm) 1310

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 622


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Standards compliance Non-standard

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 40 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -5.0 to 0

Maximum receiver -37.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -10.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 10.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02317344

9.4.4 S-SFP-FE-LH80-SM1550

Table 9-4 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor eSFP

Transmission speed FE

Center wavelength (nm) 1550

Standards compliance Non-standard

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -5.0 to 0

Maximum receiver -37.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -10.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 10.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02317345

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 623


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

9.4.5 SFP-FE-LX-SM1310-BIDI (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional


Module)

Table 9-5 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor eSFP

Transmission speed FE

Center wavelength (nm) Rx: 1550/Tx: 1310

Standards compliance 100BASE-BX

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 15 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -15.0 to -8.0

Maximum receiver -32.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -8.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02315203

NOTE

BIDI optical modules must be used in pairs. For example, SFP-FE-LX-SM1310-BIDI must be used with
SFP-FE-LX-SM1550-BIDI.

9.4.6 SFP-FE-LX-SM1550-BIDI (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional


Module)

Table 9-6 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor eSFP

Transmission speed FE

Center wavelength (nm) Rx: 1310/Tx: 1550

Standards compliance 100BASE-BX

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 624


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 15 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -15.0 to -8.0

Maximum receiver -32.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -8.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02315202

NOTE

BIDI optical modules must be used in pairs. For example, SFP-FE-LX-SM1550-BIDI must be used with
SFP-FE-LX-SM1310-BIDI.

9.5 GE eSFP Optical Modules

9.5.1 eSFP-GE-SX-MM850

Table 9-7 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor eSFP

Transmission speed GE

Center wavelength (nm) 850

Standards compliance 1000BASE-SX

Connector type LC

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 625


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Applicable cable and l Multimode fiber (with modal bandwidth of 160 MHz*km
maximum transmission and diameter of 62.5 μm): 0.22 km
distance l Multimode fiber (OM1): 0.275 km
l Multimode fiber (with modal bandwidth of 400 MHz*km
and diameter of 50 μm): 0.5 km
l Multimode fiber (OM2): 0.55 km
l Multimode fiber (OM3): 1 km

Transmit power (dBm) -9.5 to -2.5

Maximum receiver -17.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 0

Extinction ratio (dB) 9

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02315204

9.5.2 SFP-GE-LX-SM1310

Table 9-8 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor eSFP

Transmission speed GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1310

Standards compliance 1000BASE-LX10/LH

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 10 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -9.0 to -3.0

Maximum receiver -20.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -3.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 9

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 626


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Part number 02315200

9.5.3 S-SFP-GE-LH40-SM1310

Table 9-9 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver type eSFP

Transmission speed GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1310

Standards compliance 1000BASE-EX (non-standard)

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 40 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -5.0 to 0

Maximum receiver -23


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -3.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 9

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02317346

9.5.4 S-SFP-GE-LH40-SM1550

Table 9-10 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver type eSFP

Transmission speed GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1550

Standards compliance Non-standard

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 627


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 40 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -5.0 to 0

Maximum receiver -22


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -3.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 9

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02317347

9.5.5 S-SFP-GE-LH80-SM1550

Table 9-11 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver type eSFP

Transmission speed GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1550

Standards compliance 1000BASE-ZX

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -2.0 to +5.0

Maximum receiver -23


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -3.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 9

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02317348

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 628


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

9.5.6 eSFP-GE-ZX100-SM1550

Table 9-12 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor eSFP

Transmission speed GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1550

Standards compliance 1000BASE-ZX

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 100 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 5

Maximum receiver -30.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 9.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02315206

9.5.7 SFP-GE-LX-SM1310-BIDI (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional


Module)

Table 9-13 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver type eSFP

Transmission speed GE

Center wavelength (nm) Rx: 1490/Tx: 1310

Standards compliance 1000BASE-BX10

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 10 km


maximum transmission
distance

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 629


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Transmit power (dBm) -9.0 to -3.0

Maximum receiver -19.5


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -3.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 6

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02315285

NOTE

Single-fiber bidirectional (BIDI) optical modules must be used in pairs. For example, SFP-GE-LX-
SM1310-BIDI must be used with SFP-GE-LX-SM1490-BIDI.

9.5.8 SFP-GE-LX-SM1490-BIDI (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional


Module)

Table 9-14 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver type eSFP

Transmission speed GE

Center wavelength (nm) Rx: 1310/Tx: 1490

Standards compliance 1000BASE-BX10

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 10 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -9.0 to -3.0

Maximum receiver -19.5


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -3.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 6

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02315286

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 630


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

NOTE

Single-fiber bidirectional (BIDI) optical modules must be used in pairs. For example, SFP-GE-LX-
SM1490-BIDI must be used with SFP-GE-LX-SM1310-BIDI.

9.5.9 LE2MGSC40DE0 (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional Module)

Table 9-15 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor eSFP

Transmission speed GE

Center wavelength (nm) Rx: 1490/Tx: 1310

Standards compliance 1000BASE-BX

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 40 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -2.0 to +3.0

Maximum receiver -23


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -3.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 9

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310KVV

NOTE

Single-fiber bidirectional (BIDI) optical modules must be used in pairs. For example, LE2MGSC40DE0
must be used with LE2MGSC40ED0.

9.5.10 LE2MGSC40ED0 (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional Module)

Table 9-16 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor eSFP

Transmission speed GE

Center wavelength (nm) Rx: 1310/Tx: 1490

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 631


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Standards compliance 1000BASE-BX

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 40 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -2.0 to +3.0

Maximum receiver -23


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -3.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 9

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310KVU

NOTE

Single-fiber bidirectional (BIDI) optical modules must be used in pairs. For example, LE2MGSC40ED0
must be used with LE2MGSC40DE0.

9.5.11 SFP-GE-ZBXD1 (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional Module)

Table 9-17 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver type eSFP

Transmission speed GE

Center wavelength (nm) Rx: 1490/Tx: 1570

Standards compliance Non-standard

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -2.0 to +4.0

Maximum receiver -26


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -3.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 9

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 632


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02311DDB

NOTE
This module can only be used on a switch running V200R008C00 or a later version. A switch running
an earlier version may fail to obtain information about this module.
Single-fiber bidirectional (BIDI) optical modules must be used in pairs. For example, SFP-GE-ZBXD1
must be used with SFP-GE-ZBXU1.

9.5.12 SFP-GE-ZBXU1 (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional Module)

Table 9-18 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver type eSFP

Transmission speed GE

Center wavelength (nm) Rx: 1570/Tx: 1490

Standards compliance Non-standard

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -2.0 to +4.0

Maximum receiver -26


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -3.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 9

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02311DDC

NOTE
This module can only be used on a switch running V200R008C00 or a later version. A switch running
an earlier version may fail to obtain information about this module.
Single-fiber bidirectional (BIDI) optical modules must be used in pairs. For example, SFP-GE-ZBXU1
must be used with SFP-GE-ZBXD1.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 633


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

9.5.13 SFP-GE-BXU1-SC (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional Module)

Table 9-19 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor eSFP

Transmission speed GE

Center wavelength (nm) Rx: 1310/Tx: 1490

Standards compliance Non-standard

Connector type SC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 10 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -9.0 to -3.0

Maximum receiver -19.5


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -3.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 9

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310TQH

9.6 POS eSFP Optical Modules

9.6.1 eSFP-SM1310-155M-2.5G-15km

Table 9-20 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor eSFP

Transmission speed l 2.5 Gbit/s


l 622 Mbit/s
l 155 Mbit/s

Center wavelength (nm) 1310

Connector type LC

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 634


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 15 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) l -5.0 to 0 (2.5 Gbit/s)


l -15.0 to -8.0 (622 Mbit/s)
l -15.0 to -8.0 (155 Mbit/s)

Maximum receiver l -21.0 (2.5 Gbit/s)


sensitivity (dBm) l -31.0 (622 Mbit/s)
l -31.0 (155 Mbit/s)

Overload power (dBm) l 0 (2.5 Gbit/s)


l -8.0 (622 Mbit/s)
l -8.0 (155 Mbit/s)

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310CQV

9.6.2 eSFP-1310nm-L-16.1

Table 9-21 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor eSFP

Transmission speed l 2.5 Gbit/s


l 622 Mbit/s
l 155 Mbit/s

Center wavelength (nm) 1310

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 40 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) l -2.0 to +3.0 (2.5 Gbit/s)


l -3.0 to +2.0 (622 Mbit/s)
l -5.0 to 0 (155 Mbit/s)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 635


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Maximum receiver l -30.0 (2.5 Gbit/s)


sensitivity (dBm) l -30.0 (622 Mbit/s)
l -37.0 (155 Mbit/s)

Overload power (dBm) l -9.0 (2.5 Gbit/s)


l -8.0 (622 Mbit/s)
l -10.0 (155 Mbit/s)

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310CRH

9.6.3 eSFP-1550nm-L-16.2

Table 9-22 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor eSFP

Transmission speed l 2.5 Gbit/s


l 622 Mbit/s
l 155 Mbit/s

Center wavelength (nm) 1550

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) l -2.0 to +3.0 (2.5 Gbit/s)


l -3.0 to +2.0 (622 Mbit/s)
l -5.0 to 0 (155 Mbit/s)

Maximum receiver l -30.0 (2.5 Gbit/s)


sensitivity (dBm) l -30.0 (622 Mbit/s)
l -37.0 (155 Mbit/s)

Overload power (dBm) l -9.0 (2.5 Gbit/s)


l -8.0 (622 Mbit/s)
l -10.0 (155 Mbit/s)

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 636


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310CRL

9.7 GE-CWDM eSFP Optical Modules

9.7.1 CWDM-SFPGE-1471

Table 9-23 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor eSFP

Transmission speed GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1471

Standards compliance GE-CWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 5.0

Maximum receiver -28.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LPN

9.7.2 CWDM-SFPGE-1491

Table 9-24 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor eSFP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 637


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Transmission speed GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1491

Standards compliance GE-CWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 5.0

Maximum receiver -28.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LPK

9.7.3 CWDM-SFPGE-1511

Table 9-25 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor eSFP

Transmission speed GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1511

Standards compliance GE-CWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 5.0

Maximum receiver -28.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.5

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 638


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LPH

9.7.4 CWDM-SFPGE-1531

Table 9-26 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor eSFP

Transmission speed GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1531

Standards compliance GE-CWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 5.0

Maximum receiver -28.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LPL

9.7.5 CWDM-SFPGE-1551

Table 9-27 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor eSFP

Transmission speed GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1551

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 639


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Standards compliance GE-CWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 5.0

Maximum receiver -28.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02312AXN

9.7.6 CWDM-SFPGE-1571

Table 9-28 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor eSFP

Transmission speed GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1571

Standards compliance GE-CWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 5.0

Maximum receiver -28.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02312AXM

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 640


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

9.7.7 CWDM-SFPGE-1591

Table 9-29 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor eSFP

Transmission speed GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1591

Standards compliance GE-CWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 5.0

Maximum receiver -28.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02312AXK

9.7.8 CWDM-SFPGE-1611

Table 9-30 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor eSFP

Transmission speed GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1611

Standards compliance GE-CWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 5.0

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 641


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Maximum receiver -28.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LPJ

9.8 GE-DWDM eSFP Optical Modules

9.8.1 DWDM-SFPGE-1560-61

Table 9-31 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor eSFP

Transmission speed GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1560.61

Standards compliance GE-DWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 120 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 4.0

Maximum receiver -28.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -8.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LLE

9.9 GE SFP Copper Modules

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 642


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

9.9.1 SFP-1000BaseT

Table 9-32 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor SFP

Transmission speed The transmission speed varies depending on the port where
the copper transceiver module is used.

Standards compliance 1000BASE-T

Connector type RJ45

Surge protection Common mode: ±1 kV

Applicable cable and Ethernet cable: 0.1 km


maximum transmission
distance

Part number 02314171

9.10 10GE SFP+ Optical Modules

9.10.1 SFP-10G-USR

Table 9-33 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor SFP+

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 850

Standards compliance 10GBASE-USR (non-standard)

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Multimode fiber (OM3): 0.1 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -7.3 to -1.0

Maximum receiver -10.7


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 0.5

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 643


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Extinction ratio (dB) 3.0

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310MNW

9.10.2 OSXD22N00

Table 9-34 Technical Specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor SFP+

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1310

Standards compliance 10GBASE-LRM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and l Multimode fiber (with modal bandwidth of 400 MHz*km
maximum transmission and diameter of 50 μm): 0.1 km
distance l Multimode fiber (with modal bandwidth of 500 MHz*km
and diameter of 62.5 μm): 0.22 km
l Multimode fiber (OM1, OM2, OM3): 0.22 km

Transmit power (dBm) -6.5 to +0.5

Maximum receiver -6.5


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 1.5

Extinction ratio (dB) 3.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310CRM

9.10.3 OMXD30000

Table 9-35 Technical Specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor SFP+

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 644


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 850

Standards compliance 10GBASE-SR

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and l Multimode fiber (with modal bandwidth of 160 MHz*km
maximum transmission and diameter of 62.5 μm): 0.026 km
distance l Multimode fiber (OM1): 0.033 km
l Multimode fiber (with modal bandwidth of 400 MHz*km
and diameter of 50 μm): 0.066 km
l Multimode fiber (OM2): 0.082 km
l Multimode fiber (OM3): 0.3 km
l Multimode fiber (OM4): 0.4 km

Transmit power (dBm) -7.3 to -1.0

Maximum receiver -11.1


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -1.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 3.0

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02318169

9.10.4 SFP-10G-iLR

Table 9-36 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor SFP+

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1310

Standards compliance 10GBASE-iLR (non-standard)

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 1.4 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -8.2 to +0.5

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 645


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Maximum receiver -14.4


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 0.5

Extinction ratio (dB) 3.5

Operating temperature -40°C to +85°C (-40°F to +185°F)

Part number 02311BJJ

NOTE
This module can only be used on a switch running V200R008C00 or a later version. A switch running
an earlier version may fail to obtain information about this module.

9.10.5 OSX010000

Table 9-37 Technical Specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor SFP+

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1310

Standards compliance 10GBASE-LR

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 10 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -8.2 to +0.5

Maximum receiver -12.6


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 0.5

Extinction ratio (dB) 3.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02318170

9.10.6 OSX040N01

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 646


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Table 9-38 Technical Specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor SFP+

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1550

Standards compliance 10GBASE-ER

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 40 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -4.7 to +4.0

Maximum receiver -14.1


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -1.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 3.0

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310CNF

9.10.7 SFP-10G-ER-1310

Table 9-39 Technical Specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor SFP+

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1310

Standards compliance Non-standard and compatible with the 10Gbase-ER

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 40 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -2.0 to +4.0

Maximum receiver -20


sensitivity (dBm)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 647


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Overload power (dBm) -7.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 3.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02311RLX

NOTE

If the SFP-10G-ER-1310 is connected to a 10Gbase-ER standard optical module (1550nm, 10GE, 40km), the
maximum transmission distance is only 20km due to different specifications such as wavelength and
receiving sensitivity.
This module can only be used on a switch running V200R010C00 or a later version.

9.10.8 SFP-10G-ZR

Table 9-40 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor SFP+

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1550

Standards compliance 10GBASE-ZR

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 4.0

Maximum receiver -24.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -7.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 9

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310SNN

9.10.9 SFP-10G-BXU1 (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional Module)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 648


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Table 9-41 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor SFP+

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) Rx: 1330/Tx: 1270

Standards compliance 10GBASE-BX

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 10 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -8.2 to +0.5

Maximum receiver -14.4


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 0.5

Extinction ratio (dB) 3.5

Operating temperature -40°C to +85°C (-40°F to +185°F)

Part number 02310QBJ

NOTE

Single-fiber bidirectional (BIDI) optical modules must be used in pairs. For example, SFP-10G-BXU1
must be used with SFP-10G-BXD1.

9.10.10 SFP-10G-BXD1 (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional Module)

Table 9-42 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor SFP+

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) Rx: 1270/Tx: 1330

Standards compliance 10GBASE-BX

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 10 km


maximum transmission
distance

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 649


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Transmit power (dBm) -8.2 to +0.5

Maximum receiver -14.4


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 0.5

Extinction ratio (dB) 3.5

Operating temperature -40°C to +85°C (-40°F to +185°F)

Part number 02310QDT

NOTE

Single-fiber bidirectional (BIDI) optical modules must be used in pairs. For example, SFP-10G-BXD1
must be used with SFP-10G-BXU1.

9.10.11 SFP-10G-ER-SM1330-BIDI (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional


Module)

Table 9-43 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor SFP+

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) Rx: 1270/Tx: 1330

Standards compliance 10GBASE-BX

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 40 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 5

Maximum receiver -18


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 3.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02311BJB

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 650


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

NOTE
This module can only be used on a switch running V200R009C00 or a later version. A switch running
an earlier version may fail to obtain information about this module.
Single-fiber bidirectional (BIDI) optical modules must be used in pairs. For example, SFP-10G-ER-
SM1330-BIDI must be used with SFP-10G-ER-SM1270-BIDI.

9.10.12 SFP-10G-ER-SM1270-BIDI (Single-Fiber-Bidirectional


Module)

Table 9-44 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor SFP+

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) Rx: 1330/Tx: 1270

Standards compliance 10GBASE-BX

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 40 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 5

Maximum receiver -18


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 3.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02311BJC

NOTE
This module can only be used on a switch running V200R009C00 or a later version. A switch running
an earlier version may fail to obtain information about this module.
Single-fiber bidirectional (BIDI) optical modules must be used in pairs. For example, SFP-10G-ER-
SM1270-BIDI must be used with SFP-10G-ER-SM1330-BIDI.

9.11 10GE-CWDM SFP+ Optical Modules

9.11.1 SFP-10G-ZCW1471

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 651


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Table 9-45 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor SFP+

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1471

Standards compliance 10G-CWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 70 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 4.0

Maximum receiver -23.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -7.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310SSG

9.11.2 SFP-10G-ZCW1491

Table 9-46 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor SFP+

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1491

Standards compliance 10G-CWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 70 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 4.0

Maximum receiver -23.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 652


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Overload power (dBm) -7.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310SSF

9.11.3 SFP-10G-ZCW1511

Table 9-47 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor SFP+

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1511

Standards compliance 10G-CWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 70 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 4.0

Maximum receiver -23.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -7.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310SSE

9.11.4 SFP-10G-ZCW1531

Table 9-48 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor SFP+

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 653


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1531

Standards compliance 10G-CWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 70 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 4.0

Maximum receiver -23.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -7.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310SSD

9.11.5 SFP-10G-ZCW1551

Table 9-49 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor SFP+

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1551

Standards compliance 10G-CWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 70 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 4.0

Maximum receiver -23.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -7.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 654


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310SSC

9.11.6 SFP-10G-ZCW1571

Table 9-50 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor SFP+

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1571

Standards compliance 10G-CWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 70 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 4.0

Maximum receiver -23.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -7.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310SSB

9.11.7 SFP-10G-ZCW1591

Table 9-51 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor SFP+

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1591

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 655


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Standards compliance 10G-CWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 70 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 4.0

Maximum receiver -23.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -7.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310SSA

9.11.8 SFP-10G-ZCW1611

Table 9-52 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor SFP+

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1611

Standards compliance 10G-CWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 70 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 4.0

Maximum receiver -23.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -7.0

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310SRY

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 656


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

9.12 10GE-DWDM SFP+ Optical Modules

9.12.1 SFP-10G-ZDWT

Table 9-53 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor SFP+

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1529.16 to 1560.61

Standards compliance 10GBASE-DWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 60 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -1 to +3

Maximum receiver -24


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -1

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310YUT

NOTE
This module can only be used on a switch running V200R009C00 or a later version. A switch running
an earlier version may fail to obtain information about this module.
The optical module takes a long time to start. Therefore, a low optical power alarm may be generated
when such an optical module is installed on a switch.

9.13 10GE XFP Optical Modules

9.13.1 XFP-SX-MM850

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 657


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Table 9-54 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver type XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 850

Standards compliance 10GBASE-SR

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and l Multimode fiber (with modal bandwidth of 160 MHz*km
maximum transmission and diameter of 62.5 μm): 0.026 km
distance l Multimode fiber (OM1): 0.033 km
l Multimode fiber (with modal bandwidth of 400 MHz*km
and diameter of 50 μm): 0.066 km
l Multimode fiber (OM2): 0.082 km
l Multimode fiber (OM3): 0.3 km
l Multimode fiber (OM4): 0.4 km

Transmit power (dBm) -7.3 to -1.3

Maximum receiver -7.5


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -1

Extinction ratio (dB) 3

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02315176

9.13.2 XFP-STM64-LX-SM1310

Table 9-55 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver type XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1310

Standards compliance 10GBASE-LR

Connector type LC

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 658


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 10 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -6.0 to -1.0

Maximum receiver -14.4


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 0.5

Extinction ratio (dB) 6

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02315208

9.13.3 XFP-STM64-LH40-SM1550

Table 9-56 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver type XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1550

Standards compliance 10GBASE-ER

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 40 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -1 to +2

Maximum receiver -15


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -1

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02315209

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 659


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

9.13.4 XFP-STM64-SM1550-80km

Table 9-57 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver type XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1550

Standards compliance 10GBASE-ZR

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 4

Maximum receiver -24


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -7

Extinction ratio (dB) 9

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02315143

9.14 10GE-CWDM XFP Optical Modules

9.14.1 CWDM-XFP10G-1471

Table 9-58 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1471

Standards compliance 10G-CWDM

Connector type LC

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 660


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 70 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 3

Maximum receiver -21


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LQS

9.14.2 CWDM-XFP10G-1491

Table 9-59 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1491

Standards compliance 10G-CWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 70 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 3

Maximum receiver -21


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LQU

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 661


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

9.14.3 CWDM-XFP10G-1511

Table 9-60 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1511

Standards compliance 10G-CWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 70 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 3

Maximum receiver -21


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LQV

9.14.4 CWDM-XFP10G-1531

Table 9-61 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1531

Standards compliance 10G-CWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 70 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 3

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 662


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Maximum receiver -21


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LQX

9.14.5 CWDM-XFP10G-1551

Table 9-62 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1551

Standards compliance 10G-CWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 70 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 3

Maximum receiver -21


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LQY

9.14.6 CWDM-XFP10G-1571

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 663


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Table 9-63 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1571

Standards compliance 10G-CWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 70 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 3

Maximum receiver -21


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LRB

9.14.7 CWDM-XFP10G-1591

Table 9-64 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1591

Standards compliance 10G-CWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 70 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 3

Maximum receiver -21


sensitivity (dBm)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 664


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LRC

9.14.8 CWDM-XFP10G-1611

Table 9-65 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1611

Standards compliance 10G-CWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 70 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to 3

Maximum receiver -21


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LRE

9.15 10GE-DWDM XFP Optical Modules

9.15.1 DWDM-XFP10G-1533-47

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 665


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Table 9-66 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1533.47

Standards compliance 10G-DWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -1 to +3

Maximum receiver -24


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LRN

9.15.2 DWDM-XFP10G-1534-25

Table 9-67 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1534.25

Standards compliance 10G-DWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -1 to +3

Maximum receiver -24


sensitivity (dBm)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 666


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LRM

9.15.3 DWDM-XFP10G-1535-04

Table 9-68 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1535.04

Standards compliance 10G-DWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -1 to +3

Maximum receiver -24


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LRL

9.15.4 DWDM-XFP10G-1552-52

Table 9-69 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 667


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1552.52

Standards compliance 10G-DWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -1 to +3

Maximum receiver -24


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LRK

9.15.5 DWDM-XFP10G-1553-33

Table 9-70 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1553.33

Standards compliance 10G-DWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -1 to +3

Maximum receiver -24


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 668


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LRJ

9.15.6 DWDM-XFP10G-1554-13

Table 9-71 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1554.13

Standards compliance 10G-DWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -1 to +3

Maximum receiver -24


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LRH

9.15.7 DWDM-XFP10G-1530-33

Table 9-72 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1530.33

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 669


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Standards compliance 10G-DWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -1 to +3

Maximum receiver -24


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LPW

9.15.8 DWDM-XFP10G-1549-32

Table 9-73 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1549.32

Standards compliance 10G-DWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -1 to +3

Maximum receiver -24


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LPV

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 670


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

9.15.9 DWDM-XFP10G-1531-12

Table 9-74 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1531.12

Standards compliance 10G-DWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -1 to +3

Maximum receiver -24


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LPU

9.15.10 DWDM-XFP10G-1531-90

Table 9-75 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1531.90

Standards compliance 10G-DWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -1 to +3

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 671


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Maximum receiver -24


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LPS

9.15.11 DWDM-XFP10G-1550-12

Table 9-76 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1550.12

Standards compliance 10G-DWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -1 to +3

Maximum receiver -24


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LPQ

9.15.12 DWDM-XFP10G-1550-92

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 672


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Table 9-77 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1550.92

Standards compliance 10G-DWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -1 to +3

Maximum receiver -24


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LPP

9.15.13 DWDM-XFP10G-1532-68

Table 9-78 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1532.68

Standards compliance 10G-DWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -1 to +3

Maximum receiver -24


sensitivity (dBm)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 673


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LQP

9.15.14 DWDM-XFP10G-1551-72

Table 9-79 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1551.72

Standards compliance 10G-DWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -1 to +3

Maximum receiver -24


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LQN

9.15.15 DWDM-XFP10G-1529-55

Table 9-80 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 674


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1529.55

Standards compliance 10G-DWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -1 to +3

Maximum receiver -24


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LQL

9.15.16 DWDM-XFP10G-1548-51

Table 9-81 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor XFP

Transmission speed 10GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1548.51

Standards compliance 10G-DWDM

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -1 to +3

Maximum receiver -24


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -9

Extinction ratio (dB) 8.2

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 675


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310LQK

9.16 40GE QSFP+ Optical Modules

9.16.1 QSFP-40G-SR4

Table 9-82 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor QSFP+

Transmission speed 40GE

Center wavelength (nm) 850

Standards compliance 40GBASE-SR4

Connector type MPO/PC (8-strand or 12-strand, type B, female connector)

Applicable cable and l Multimode fiber (OM3): 0.1 km


maximum transmission l Multimode fiber (OM4): 0.15 km
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -7.6 to +2.4

Maximum receiver -5.4


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 2.4

Extinction ratio (dB) 3.0

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310MHQ

9.16.2 QSFP-40G-iSR4

Table 9-83 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor QSFP+

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 676


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Transmission speed 40GE

Center wavelength (nm) 850

Standards compliance 40GBASE-SR4


40GBASE-iSR4 (non-standard)

Connector type MPO/PC (8-strand or 12-strand, type B, female connector)

Applicable cable and l Multimode fiber (OM3): 0.1 km


maximum transmission l Multimode fiber (OM4): 0.15 km
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -7.6 to +0.5

Maximum receiver -9.5


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 2.4

Extinction ratio (dB) 3.0

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310MHR

NOTE
This module can connect a 40GE port to four 10GE ports using a 1-to-4 cable.

9.16.3 QSFP-40G-eSR4

Table 9-84 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor QSFP+

Transmission speed 40GE

Center wavelength (nm) 850

Standards compliance 40GBASE-eSR4 (non-standard)

Connector type MPO/PC (8-strand or 12-strand, type B, female connector)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 677


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Applicable cable and l Multimode fiber (with modal bandwidth of 160 MHz*km
maximum transmission and diameter of 62.5 μm): 0.026 km
distance l Multimode fiber (OM1): 0.033 km
l Multimode fiber (with modal bandwidth of 400 MHz*km
and diameter of 50 μm): 0.066 km
l Multimode fiber (OM2): 0.082 km
l Multimode fiber (OM3): 0.3 km
l Multimode fiber (OM4): 0.4 km

Transmit power (dBm) -7.6 to +0.5

Maximum receiver -5.4


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 2.4

Extinction ratio (dB) 3.0

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310RMB

NOTE
This module can connect a 40GE port to four 10GE ports using a 1-to-4 cable.

9.16.4 QSFP-40G-iSM4

Table 9-85 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor QSFP+

Transmission speed 40GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1310

Standards compliance 40GBASE-iSM4 (non-standard)

Connector type MPO/APC (8-strand or 12-strand, type B, female connector)

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 1.4 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -8.2 to +0.5

Maximum receiver -11.5


sensitivity (dBm)

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 678


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Overload power (dBm) 0.5

Extinction ratio (dB) 3.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02311DRW

NOTE

This module can connect a 40GE port to four 10GE ports using a 1-to-4 cable.
This module can only be used on a switch running V200R009C00 or a later version. A switch running
an earlier version may fail to obtain information about this module.

9.16.5 QSFP-40G-eSM4

Table 9-86 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor QSFP+

Transmission speed 40GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1310

Standards compliance 40GBASE-eSM4 (non-standard)

Connector type MPO/APC (8-strand or 12-strand, type B, female connector)

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 10 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -8.2 to +0.5

Maximum receiver -12.6


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 0.5

Extinction ratio (dB) 3.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C

Part number 02311DTR

NOTE

This module can connect a 40GE port to four 10GE ports using a 1-to-4 cable.
This module can only be used on a switch running V200R010C00 or a later version. A switch running
an earlier version may fail to obtain information about this module.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 679


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

9.16.6 QSFP-40G-LX4

Table 9-87 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor QSFP+

Transmission speed 40GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1271, 1291, 1311, 1331

Standards compliance 40GBASE-LX4

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 2 km


maximum transmission Multimode fiber (OM3): 0.15 km
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -7.0 to +2.3

Maximum receiver -11.5


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 2.3

Extinction ratio (dB) 3.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02311HNP

NOTE

When QSFP-40G-LX4 optical modules use multimode fibers, the fibers cannot be connected through
multiple optical distribution frames (ODFs).
This module can only be used on a switch running V200R009C00 or a later version. A switch running
an earlier version may fail to obtain information about this module.

9.16.7 QSFP-40G-LR4

Table 9-88 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor QSFP+

Transmission speed 40GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1271, 1291, 1311, 1331

Standards compliance 40GBASE-LR4

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 680


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 10 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -7.0 to +2.3

Maximum receiver -11.5


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 3.3

Extinction ratio (dB) 3.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310MHS

9.16.8 QSFP-40G-ER4

Table 9-89 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor QSFP+

Transmission speed 40GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1271, 1291, 1311, 1331

Standards compliance 40GBASE-ER4

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 40 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -2.7 to +4.5

Maximum receiver -19.5


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -4.5

Extinction ratio (dB) 5.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02311BKT

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 681


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

NOTE
This module can only be used on a switch running V200R008C00 or a later version. A switch running
an earlier version may fail to obtain information about this module.

9.16.9 QSFP-40G-SR-BD

Table 9-90 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor QSFP+

Transmission speed 40GE

Center wavelength (nm) 850, 900

Standards compliance 40GBASE-BIDI (non-standard)

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and l Multimode fiber (OM3): 0.1 km


maximum transmission l Multimode fiber (OM4): 0.15 km
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -4 to +5

Maximum receiver -4.5


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 5

Extinction ratio (dB) 4.5

Operating temperature 10°C to 70°C (50°F to 158°F)


NOTICE
Temporary interruption or packet loss may occur on ports of the
switch if the operating temperature is below 10°C (50°F).

Part number 02311FPA

NOTE

QSFP-40G-SR-BD optical modules cannot be used for CSS or stack connection and do not support
some digital diagnostic monitoring (DDM) function.
This module can only be used on a switch running V200R009C00 or a later version. A switch running
an earlier version may fail to obtain information about this module.

9.16.10 QSFP-40G-SDLC-PAM

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 682


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Table 9-91 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor QSFP+

Transmission speed 40GE

Center wavelength (nm) 850

Standards compliance 40GBASE-PAM4 (non-standard)

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and l Multimode fiber (OM3): 100 m


maximum transmission l Multimode fiber (OM4): 150 m
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -2.5 to +2.4

Maximum receiver -8.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 2.4

Extinction ratio (dB) 3

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02311PUU

NOTE

This module can only be used on a switch running V200R011C10 or a later version.

9.16.11 QSFP-40G-eSDLC-PAM

Table 9-92 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor QSFP+

Transmission speed 40GE

Center wavelength (nm) 850

Standards compliance 40GBASE-ePAM4 (non-standard)

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and l Multimode fiber (OM3): 100 m


maximum transmission l Multimode fiber (OM4): 300 m
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -2 to +2.4

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 683


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Maximum receiver -8.0


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 2.4

Extinction ratio (dB) 3

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02311QTR

NOTE

This module can only be used on a switch running V200R011C10 or a later version.

9.17 40GE CFP Optical Modules

9.17.1 CFP-40G-SR4

Table 9-93 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor CFP

Transmission speed 40GE

Center wavelength (nm) 850

Standards compliance 40GBASE-SR4

Connector type MPO/PC (8-strand or 12-strand, type B, female connector)

Applicable cable and l Multimode fiber (OM3): 0.1 km


maximum transmission l Multimode fiber (OM4): 0.15 km
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -7.6 to +2.4

Maximum receiver -9.5


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 2.4

Extinction ratio (dB) 3

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02311CXC

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 684


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

NOTE

This module can connect a 40GE port to four 10GE ports using a 1-to-4 cable.

9.17.2 CFP-40G-LR4

Table 9-94 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor CFP

Transmission speed 40GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1271, 1291, 1311, 1331

Standards compliance 40GBASE-LR4

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 10 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -4 to +3.5

Maximum receiver -11.5


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 3.5

Extinction ratio (dB) 3.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310YTF

9.17.3 CFP-40G-ER4

Table 9-95 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor CFP

Transmission speed 40GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1271, 1291, 1311, 1331

Standards compliance 40GBASE-ER4

Connector type LC

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 685


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 40 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -1.1 to +3.8

Maximum receiver -18


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 3.8

Extinction ratio (dB) 7

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310YTH

9.17.4 CFP-40G-ZR4

Table 9-96 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor CFP

Transmission speed 40GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1531.12, 1537.4, 1543.73, 1550.12

Standards compliance 40GBASE-ZR4

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 80 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) 0 to +4.5

Maximum receiver -22


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -7

Extinction ratio (dB) 9

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02311KAH

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 686


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

NOTE
This module can only be used on a switch running V200R009C00 or a later version. A switch running
an earlier version may fail to obtain information about this module.

9.18 100GE CFP Optical Modules

9.18.1 CFP-100G-SR10

Table 9-97 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor CFP

Transmission speed 100GE

Center wavelength (nm) 850

Standards compliance 100GBASE-SR10

Connector type MPO/PC (24-strand, type B, female connector)

Applicable cable and l Multimode fiber (OM2): 0.03 km


maximum transmission l Multimode fiber (OM3): 0.1 km
distance
l Multimode fiber (OM4): 0.15 km

Transmit power (dBm) -7.6 to +2.4

Maximum receiver -5.4


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 2.4

Extinction ratio (dB) 3

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310YTB

NOTE

This module can connect a 100GE port to two 40GE ports using a 1-to-2 cable or to ten 10GE ports using a 1-
to-10 cable.

9.18.2 CFP-100G-LR4

Table 9-98 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor CFP

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 687


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Transmission speed 100GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1295, 1300, 1304, 1309

Standards compliance 100GBASE-LR4

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 10 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -4.3 to +4.5

Maximum receiver -8.6


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 4.5

Extinction ratio (dB) 4

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310YTD

9.18.3 CFP-100G-ER4

Table 9-99 Technical specifications

Item Description

Transceiver form factor CFP

Transmission speed 100GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1295, 1300, 1304, 1309

Standards compliance 100GBASE-ER4

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber: 40 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -2.9 to +2.9

Maximum receiver -21.4


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 4.5

Extinction ratio (dB) 8

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 688


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02310YTE

NOTE

CFP-100G-ER4 optical modules are used in the following scenarios:


l When the transmission distance is less than 10 km, the optical power on the receive end is higher
than 1 dBm. In this case, use a 10 dB optical attenuator to reduce the receive optical power.
l When the transmission distance is longer than or equal to 10 km and less than 25 km, the optical
power on the receive end is higher than -4 dBm and lower than or equal to 1 dBm. In this case, use a
5 dB optical attenuator to reduce the receive optical power.
l When the transmission distance is in the range of 25 km and 40 km, the optical power on the receive
end is lower than or equal to -4 dBm. In this case, no optical attenuator is required.

9.19 100GE QSFP28 Optical Modules

9.19.1 QSFP28-100G-LR4

Table 9-100 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor QSFP28

Transmission speed 100GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1295, 1300, 1304, 1309

Standards compliance 100GBASE-LR4

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber (G.652): 10 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -4.3 to +4.5

Maximum receiver -8.6


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 4.5

Extinction ratio (dB) 4

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02311KNU

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 689


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

9.19.2 QSFP28-100G-10KM

Table 9-101 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor QSFP28

Transmission speed 100GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1295, 1300, 1304, 1309

Standards compliance 100GBASE-LR4

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber (G.652): 10 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -4.3 to +4.5

Maximum receiver -8.6


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 4.5

Extinction ratio (dB) 4

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02311SYT

9.19.3 QSFP28-100G-PSM4

Table 9-102 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor QSFP28

Transmission speed 100GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1310

Standards compliance 100GBASE-PSM4 (non-standard)

Connector type MPO/APC (8-strand or 12-strand, type B, female connector)

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber (G.652): 500 m


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -9.4 to +2

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 690


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Maximum receiver -11.35


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 2.2

Extinction ratio (dB) 3.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02311MNM

9.19.4 QSFP28-100G-SR4

Table 9-103 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor QSFP28

Transmission speed 100GE

Center wavelength (nm) 850

Standards compliance 100GBASE-SR4

Connector type MPO/PC (8-strand or 12-strand, type B, female connector)

Applicable cable and l Multimode fiber (OM3): 70 m


maximum transmission l Multimode fiber (OM4): 100 m
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -8.4 to +2.4

Maximum receiver -10.3


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 2.4

Extinction ratio (dB) 2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02311GBW

9.19.5 QSFP-100G-eSR4

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 691


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Table 9-104 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor QSFP28

Transmission speed 100GE

Center wavelength (nm) 850

Standards compliance 100GBase-eSR4 (non-standard)

Connector type MPO/PC (8-strand or 12-strand, type B, female connector)

Applicable cable and l Multimode fiber (OM3): 200 m


maximum transmission l Multimode fiber (OM4): 300 m
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -8.4 to +2.4

Maximum receiver -9.2


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 2.4

Extinction ratio (dB) ≥2

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02311PSH

NOTE
This module can only be used on a switch running V200R011C10 or a later version. A switch running
an earlier version may fail to obtain information about this module.

9.19.6 QSFP-100G-CLR4

Table 9-105 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor QSFP28

Transmission speed 100GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1271, 1291, 1311, 1331

Standards compliance 100GBASE-CLR4 (non-standard)

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber (G.652): 2 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -6.5 to +2.5

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 692


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Item Description

Maximum receiver -10.7


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 2.5

Extinction ratio (dB) 3.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02311MNP

9.19.7 QSFP-100G-CWDM4

Table 9-106 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor QSFP28

Transmission speed 100GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1271, 1291, 1311, 1331

Standards compliance 100GBASE-CWDM4 (non-standard)

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber (G.652): 2 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -6.5 to +2.5

Maximum receiver -9.8


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) 2.5

Extinction ratio (dB) 3.5

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02311MNN

9.19.8 QSFP-100G-ER4-Lite

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 693


S9700 Series Terabit Core Routing Switches
Hardware Description 9 Pluggable Modules for Interfaces

Table 9-107 Technical specifications


Item Description

Transceiver form factor QSFP28

Transmission speed 100GE

Center wavelength (nm) 1295, 1300, 1304, 1309

Standards compliance Non-standard and compatible with the 100GBASE-ER4

Connector type LC

Applicable cable and Single-mode fiber (G.652): 30 km


maximum transmission
distance

Transmit power (dBm) -2.5 to +2.9

Maximum receiver -18.4


sensitivity (dBm)

Overload power (dBm) -3.5

Extinction ratio (dB) 8

Operating temperature 0°C to 70°C (32°F to 158°F)

Part number 02311YXR

NOTE

This module can only be used on a switch running V200R012C00 or a later version.
FEC cannot be enabled on this module.

Issue 27 (2019-05-10) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 694

You might also like